Home
  By Author [ A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X  Y  Z |  Other Symbols ]
  By Title [ A  B  C  D  E  F  G  H  I  J  K  L  M  N  O  P  Q  R  S  T  U  V  W  X  Y  Z |  Other Symbols ]
  By Language
all Classics books content using ISYS

Download this book: [ ASCII | HTML | PDF ]

Look for this book on Amazon


We have new books nearly every day.
If you would like a news letter once a week or once a month
fill out this form and we will give you a summary of the books for that week or month by email.

Title: The Romance of War Inventions - A Description of Warships, Guns, Tanks, Rifles, Bombs, and Other Instruments and Munitions of Warfare, How They Were Invented & How They Are Employed
Author: Corbin, Thomas W.
Language: English
As this book started as an ASCII text book there are no pictures available.


*** Start of this LibraryBlog Digital Book "The Romance of War Inventions - A Description of Warships, Guns, Tanks, Rifles, Bombs, and Other Instruments and Munitions of Warfare, How They Were Invented & How They Are Employed" ***


available by Internet Archive (http://www.archive.org)



      Images of the original pages are available through
      Internet Archive. See
      http://www.archive.org/details/romanceofwarinve00corbiala


Transcriber's note:

      In this plain text version, underlined text in the original
      is surrounded by =equals symbols=; italic typeface is
      surrounded by _underscores_; bold typeface and small caps
      typeface are represented by UPPER CASE.

      The oe-ligature appears as [oe].

      Changes to the text (to correct typographical errors) are
      listed at the end of the book. A few cases of missing
      punctuation have been regularised in the advertisements
      without comment.

      All advertising material has been retained in the same
      position as it appears in the original book. There are
      extensive advertisements before and after the title page,
      following the index and in a sixteen page publisher's
      catalogue at the end of the book.



THE ROMANCE OF WAR INVENTIONS


       *       *       *       *       *

THE IAN HARDY SERIES

BY

COMMANDER E. HAMILTON CURREY, R.N.


_Each Volume with Illustrations in Colour. 5s. each_

Ian Hardy's career in H.M. Navy is told in four volumes, which are
described below. Each volume is complete in itself, and no knowledge of
the previous volumes is necessary, but few boys will read one of the
series without wishing to peruse the others.


IAN HARDY, NAVAL CADET

"A sound and wholesome story giving a lively picture of a naval cadet's
life."--_Birmingham Gazette_.

"A very wholesome book for boys, and the lurking danger of Ian's ill
deeds being imitated may be regarded as negligible in comparison with
the good likely to be done by the example of his manly, honest nature.
Ian was a boy whom his father might occasionally have reason to whip,
but never feel ashamed of."--_United Service Magazine_.


IAN HARDY, MIDSHIPMAN

"A jolly sequel to his last year's book."--_Christian World_.

"The 'real thing.' ... Certain to enthral boys of almost any age who
love stories of British pluck."--_Observer_.

"=Commander E. Hamilton Currey, R.N., is becoming a serious rival to
Kingston as a writer of sea stories.= Just as a former generation
revelled in Kingston's doings of his three heroes from their middy days
until they became admirals all, so will the present-day boys read with
interest the story of Ian Hardy. Last year we knew him as a cadet; this
year we get _Ian Hardy, Midshipman_. The present instalment of his
stirring history is breezily written."--_Yorkshire Observer_.


IAN HARDY, SENIOR MIDSHIPMAN

"Of those who are now writing stories of the sea, Commander Currey holds
perhaps the leading position. He has a gift of narrative, a keen sense
of humour, and above all he writes from a full stock of
knowledge."--_Saturday Review_.

"=It is no exaggeration to say that Commander Currey bears worthily the
mantle of Kingston and Captain Marryat.="--_Manchester Courier._

"The Ian Hardy Series is just splendid for boys to read, and the best of
it is that each book is complete in itself. But not many boys will read
one of the series without being keenly desirous of reading all the
others."--_Sheffield Telegraph_.


IAN HARDY FIGHTING THE MOORS

"By writing this series the author is doing national service, for he
writes of the Navy and the sea with knowledge and sound sense.... What a
welcome addition the whole series would make to a boy's
library."--_Daily Graphic._

"The right romantic stuff, full of fighting and hairbreadth escapes....
Commander Currey has the secret of making the men and ships seem
actual."--_Times_.

"By this time Ian Hardy has become a real friend and we consider him all
a hero should be."--Outlook.


SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


THE LIBRARY OF ROMANCE

_Each volume profusely illustrated. Ex. Crown 8vo. 5s._

"THE LIBRARY OF ROMANCE OFFERS A SPLENDID CHOICE."--_Globe._

    THE ROMANCE OF PIRACY

    BY E. KEBLE CHATTERTON, B.A.

    AUTHOR OF "THE ROMANCE OF THE SHIP"

    _With many illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF AERONAUTICS

    BY CHARLES C. TURNER

    "A VALUABLE CONTRIBUTION TO THE LITERATURE OF THIS MOST MARVELLOUS
    SUBJECT."--_British Weekly_

    _With forty illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ASTRONOMY

    BY HECTOR MACPHERSON, JUNR.

    _With thirty-seven illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF SAVAGE LIFE

    Describing the Habits, Customs, Everyday Life, Arts, Crafts, Games,
    Adventures and Sports of Primitive Man

    BY PROF. G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT M.A., B.SC., F.R.G.S., F.L.S., &c.

    _With forty illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN SIEGES

    BY THE REV. EDWARD GILLIAT

    _With sixteen illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF ANIMAL ARTS & CRAFTS

    H. COUPIN, D.Sc., & J. LEA, M.A.

    _With twenty-seven illustrations_

    "A CHARMING SUBJECT WELL SET FORTH."--_Athenæum_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN LOCOMOTION

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With twenty-five illustrations_

    "CRISPLY WRITTEN, BRIMFUL OF INCIDENT. TO INTELLIGENT LADS SHOULD BE
    AS WELCOME AS A BALLANTYNE STORY."--_Glasgow Herald_


    THE ROMANCE OF POLAR EXPLORATION

    BY G. FIRTH SCOTT

    _With twenty-four illustrations_

    _Extra Crown 8vo. 5s._

    "THRILLINGLY INTERESTING." _Liverpool Courier_


    THE ROMANCE OF SCIENTIFIC DISCOVERY

    BY C. R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    _With many illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF SUBMARINE ENGINEERING

    BY THOMAS W. CORBIN

    AUTHOR OF "MECHANICAL INVENTIONS OF TO-DAY"

    _With many illustrations & diagrams_


    THE ROMANCE OF THE SHIP

    BY E. KEBLE CHATTERTON, B.A.

    _With thirty-four illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF THE WORLD'S FISHERIES

    With descriptions of the Many and Curious Methods of Fishing in all
    parts of the world

    BY SIDNEY WRIGHT

    _With twenty-four illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN PHOTOGRAPHY

    BY CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    _With sixty-three illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ENGINEERING

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With many illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF MINING

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With twenty-four illustrations_

    "WE CANNOT PRAISE THIS BOOK TOO HIGHLY."--_British Weekly_


    THE ROMANCE OF THE MIGHTY DEEP

    BY AGNES GIBERNE

    _With illustrations_

    "MOST FASCINATING; ADMIRABLY ADAPTED FOR THE YOUNG." _Daily News_

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


THE LIBRARY OF ROMANCE

_Lavishly Illustrated. Ex. Crown 8vo. 5s. each volume_

"SPLENDID VOLUMES."--_The Outlook_

    THE ROMANCE OF THE SPANISH MAIN

    BY N. J. DAVIDSON, B.A. (Oxon.)

    _With many illustrations_


    _NEW & REVISED EDITION_

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ELECTRICITY

    BY CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    _With forty-five illustrations_

    "ADMIRABLE ... CLEAR AND CONCISE."--_The Graphic_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN EXPLORATION

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With twenty-six illustrations_

    "A MINE OF INFORMATION AND STIRRING INCIDENT."--_Scotsman_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MECHANISM

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With thirty illustrations_

    "A GENUINELY FASCINATING BOOK." _Liverpool Courier_


    THE ROMANCE OF INSECT LIFE

    BY EDMUND SELOUS

    _With twenty illustrations_

    "WELL MERITS ITS ALLURING TITLE." _Daily Telegraph_


    THE ROMANCE OF EARLY BRITISH LIFE

    PROF. G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A.

    "A MASTERPIECE OF SCIENTIFIC KNOWLEDGE, BRILLIANT INVENTION, AND
    GENUINE HUMOUR." _Liverpool Courier_


    THE ROMANCE OF BIRD LIFE

    BY JOHN LEA, M.A.

    _With thirty illustrations_

    "MOST FASCINATING, SUGGESTIVE, AND READABLE."--_Spectator_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN CHEMISTRY

    BY J. C. PHILIP, D.SC., PH.D.

    _With thirty illustrations_

    "A FASCINATING EXPOSITION IN POPULAR LANGUAGE."--_Illustrated London
    News_


    THE ROMANCE OF THE GREAT WAR

    BY N. J. DAVIDSON, B.A. (Oxon.)

    _With many illustrations_


    _NEW & REVISED EDITION_

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN INVENTION

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With twenty-five illustrations_


    THE ROMANCE OF EARLY EXPLORATION

    BY ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS B.A., F.R.G.S.

    _With sixteen illustrations_

    "VIVID AND VIGOROUS." _Glasgow Herald_


    THE ROMANCE OF MISSIONARY HEROISM

    BY J. C. LAMBERT, B.A., D.D.

    _With thirty-nine illustrations_

    "A MOST ENTRANCING VOLUME." _Expository Times_


    THE ROMANCE OF PLANT LIFE

    BY G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A.

    _With thirty-four illustrations_

    "INTENSELY INTERESTING." _Leeds Mercury_


    THE ROMANCE OF THE ANIMAL WORLD

    BY EDMUND SELOUS

    _With sixteen full-page illustrations_

    "A VERY FASCINATING BOOK." _Graphic_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN GEOLOGY

    BY E. S. GREW, M.A.

    _With twenty-five illustrations_

    "ABSORBINGLY INTERESTING." _Scotsman_


    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MANUFACTURE

    BY C. R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    _With forty illustrations_

    "WELL PLANNED, WELL WRITTEN, AND WELL ILLUSTRATED." _Pall Mall
    Gazette_

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


POPULAR SCIENCE FOR YOUNG PEOPLE

BY CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    "Among writers for boys on science, easily the most skilful is Mr.
    Charles Gibson. He writes so clearly, simply and charmingly about
    the most difficult things that his books are quite as entertaining
    as any ordinary book of adventure. Mr. Gibson has a first-rate
    scientific mind and considerable scientific attainments. He is never
    guilty of an inexact phrase--certainly, never an obscure one--or a
    misleading analogy. We could imagine him having a vogue among our
    young folk comparable with that of Jules Verne."--_The Nation._

    "Mr. Gibson has fairly made his mark as a populariser of scientific
    knowledge."--_Guardian._

_JUST PUBLISHED_

THE STARS & THEIR MYSTERIES (Vol. III. SCIENCE FOR CHILDREN SERIES).
With Coloured Frontisp. & other Illustrations. 3_s._ 6_d._

OUR GOOD SLAVE ELECTRICITY (Vol. I. SCIENCE FOR CHILDREN SERIES). With
Illustrations. 3_s._ 6_d._

    "An exquisitely clear book for childish beginners."--_The Nation._

    "Told in simple and remarkably clear language, and with such
    ingenuity that many pages of it read like a fairy tale."--_Glasgow
    Herald._

THE GREAT BALL ON WHICH WE LIVE (Vol. II. SCIENCE FOR CHILDREN SERIES).
With Coloured Frontispiece and other Illustrations. 3_s._ 6_d._

    "Capital."--_Field._

    "A most fascinating and suggestive story of the earth. Mr. Gibson
    not only knows his subject thoroughly, but has the capacity of
    conveying the knowledge to young folk."--_Church Family Newspaper._

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ELECTRICITY. Describing in Non-technical Language
what is known about Electricity and many of its interesting
applications. With 41 Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5_s._

    "Admirable, clear and concise."--_Graphic._

    "Very entertaining and instructive."--_Queen._

    "A book which the merest tyro, totally unacquainted with elementary
    principles, can understand."--_Electricity._

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN PHOTOGRAPHY. Its Discovery and its Applications.
With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5_s._

    "There is not a dry or uninteresting page throughout."--_Country
    Life._

    "The narration is everywhere remarkable for its fluency and clear
    style."--_Bystander._

THE ROMANCE OF SCIENTIFIC DISCOVERY. A Popular Account of the most
important Discoveries in Science. With 30 Illus. 5_s._

    "The most curious boy of mechanical bent would find such a book
    satisfying."--_Westminster Gazette._

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MANUFACTURE. A Popular Account of the Marvels of
Manufacturing. 5_s._

    "A popular and practical account of all kinds of
    manufacture."--_Scotsman._

    "Just the sort of book to put into the hands of senior boys as a
    school prize."--_Sheffield Telegraph._

HEROES OF THE SCIENTIFIC WORLD. An Account of the Lives, Sacrifices,
Successes, and Failures of some of the greatest Scientists in the
World's History. With 19 Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5_s._

    "The whole field of science is well covered.... Every one of the 300
    odd pages contains some interesting piece of
    information."--_Athenæum._

THE AUTOBIOGRAPHY OF AN ELECTRON. With 8 Illustrations. Long 8vo, 3_s._
6_d._ net.

    "A brilliant study."--_Daily Mail._

    "Quite a unique book in its way, at once attractive and
    illuminating."--_Record._

THE WONDERS OF MODERN ELECTRICITY. With 17 Illustrations and Diagrams.
Extra crown 8vo, 2_s._

THE WONDERS OF MODERN MANUFACTURE. With 22 Illustrations. Extra crown
8vo, 2_s._

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED


       *       *       *       *       *


THE ROMANCE OF WAR INVENTIONS

[Illustration: A TANK.

These weird-looking engines are literally moving forts, and are the
evolution of a peaceful agricultural machine fitted with "caterpillar"
wheels, that is, a broad band encircles the driving wheels, and so the
whole construction moves as it were on its own revolving platform and is
thus prevented from sinking into the soft ground. The principle itself
is not new, as it was adapted to transport carts during the Crimean
War.]


THE ROMANCE OF WAR INVENTIONS

A Description of Warships, Guns, Tanks,
Rifles, Bombs, and Other Instruments
and Munitions of Warfare, How
They Were Invented & How
They Are Employed

by

T. W. CORBIN

Author of "The Romance of Submarine Engineering,"
"Mechanical Inventions of To-Day,"
&c., &c., &c.

With many Illustrations



London
Seeley, Service & Co. Limited
38 Great Russell Street
1918

       *       *       *       *       *

THE LIBRARY OF ROMANCE

_Extra Crown 8vo. With many illustrations. 5s. each._

"Splendid Volumes."--_The Outlook._

"The Library of Romance offers a splendid choice."--_Globe._

"Gift Books whose value it would be difficult to over-estimate." _The
Standard._

"This series has now won a considerable & well deserved reputation."
_The Guardian._

"Each Volume treats its allotted theme with accuracy, but at the same
time with a charm that will commend itself to readers of all ages. The
root idea is excellent, and it is excellently carried out, with full
illustrations and very prettily designed covers."--_The Daily
Telegraph._

  By Prof. G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A., B.Sc.

  The Romance of Savage Life
  The Romance of Plant Life
  The Romance of Early British Life

          By EDWARD GILLIAT, M.A.

  The Romance of Modern Sieges

             By JOHN LEA, M.A.

  The Romance of Bird Life

    By JOHN LEA. M.A. & H. COUPIN, D.Sc.

  The Romance of Animal Arts and Crafts

              By SIDNEY WRIGHT

  The Romance of the World's Fisheries

   By the Rev. J. C. LAMBERT, M.A., D.D.

  The Romance of Missionary Heroism

             By G. FIRTH SCOTT

  The Romance of Polar Exploration

       By CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

  The Romance of Modern Photography
  The Romance of Modern Electricity
  The Romance of Modern Manufacture
  The Romance of Scientific Discovery

            By CHARLES C. TURNER

  The Romance of Aeronautics

        By HECTOR MACPHERSON, Junr.

  The Romance of Modern Astronomy

           By ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS,
           B.A. (Oxon.), F.R.G.S.

  The Romance of Early Exploration
  The Romance of Modern Exploration
  The Romance of Modern Mechanism
  The Romance of Modern Invention
  The Romance of Modern Engineering
  The Romance of Modern Locomotion
  The Romance of Modern Mining

              By EDMUND SELOUS

  The Romance of the Animal World
  The Romance of Insect Life

              By AGNES GIBERNE

  The Romance of the Mighty Deep

            By E. S. GREW, M.A.

  The Romance of Modern Geology

        By J. C. PHILIP, D.Sc., Ph.D.

  The Romance of Modern Chemistry

        By E. KEBLE CHATTERTON, B.A.

  The Romance of the Ship
  The Romance of Piracy

              By T. W. CORBIN

  The Romance of Submarine Engineering
  The Romance of War Inventions

    By NORMAN J. DAVIDSON, B.A. (Oxon.)

  The Romance of the Spanish Main


      SEELEY, SERVICE & CO., LIMITED.

       *       *       *       *       *


CONTENTS


  CHAPTER                                         PAGE

        I. HOW PEACEFUL ARTS HELP IN WAR           17

       II. GUNPOWDER AND ITS MODERN EQUIVALENTS    27

      III. RADIUM IN WAR                           39

       IV. A GOOD SERVANT, THOUGH A BAD MASTER     49

        V. MINES, SUBMARINE AND SUBTERRANEAN       61

       VI. MILITARY BRIDGES                        75

      VII. WHAT GUNS ARE MADE OF                   92

     VIII. MORE ABOUT GUNS                        108

       IX. THE GUNS THEY USE IN THE NAVY          120

        X. SHELLS AND HOW THEY ARE MADE           135

       XI. WHAT SHELLS ARE MADE OF                146

      XII. MEASURING THE VELOCITY OF A SHELL      159

     XIII. SOME ADJUNCTS IN THE ENGINE ROOM       164

      XIV. ENGINES OF WAR                         169

       XV. DESTROYERS                             184

      XVI. BATTLESHIPS                            191

     XVII. HOW A WARSHIP IS BUILT                 202

    XVIII. THE TORPEDO                            215

      XIX. WHAT A SUBMARINE IS LIKE               223

       XX. THE STORY OF WIRELESS TELEGRAPHY       240

      XXI. WIRELESS TELEGRAPHY IN WAR             252

     XXII. MILITARY TELEGRAPHY                    264

    XXIII. HOW WAR INVENTIONS GROW                276

     XXIV. AEROPLANES                             284

      XXV. THE AERIAL LIFEBOAT                    297

           INDEX                                  313



LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS


  A TANK                                       _Frontispiece_

                                                         PAGE

  MACHINE-GUN VERSUS RIFLE                                 32

  AN ITALIAN MINE-LAYER                                    64

  AN INCIDENT AT LOOS                                      80

  AN 18-POUNDER IN ACTION                                  96

  A GERMAN AUTOMATIC PISTOL                               112

  BOMB THROWING                                           136

  BOMB-THROWERS AT WORK                                   160

  THE TRIPOD MAST                                         208

  LISTENING FOR THE ENEMY                                 248

  DIAGRAM SHOWING THE PRINCIPLE BY WHICH THE AERIALS
  ARE CONNECTED TO THE APPARATUS                          251

  THE PARENT OF THE TANK                                  280

  THE "GUARDIAN ANGEL" PARACHUTE                          304



THE ROMANCE OF WAR INVENTIONS



CHAPTER I

HOW PEACEFUL ARTS HELP IN WAR


In the olden times warfare was supported by a single trade, that of the
armourer. Nowadays the whole resources of the greatest manufacturing
nations scarcely suffice to supply the needs of their armies. So much is
this the case that no nation can possibly hope to become powerful in a
military or naval sense unless they are either a great manufacturing
community or can rely upon the support of some great manufacturing ally
or neutral.

It is most astonishing to find how closely some of the most innocent and
harmless of the commodities of peace are related to the death-dealing
devices of war. Of these no two examples could be more striking than the
common salt with which we season our food and the soap with which we
wash. Yet the manufacture of soap furnishes the material for the most
furious of explosives and the chief agent in its manufacture is the
common salt of the table.

Common salt is a combination of the metal sodium and the gas chlorine.
There are many places, of which Cheshire is a notable example, where
vast quantities of this salt lie buried in the earth.

Fortunately it is very easily dissolved in water so that if wells be
sunk in a salt district the water pumped from them will have much salt
in solution in it. This is how the underground deposits are tapped. It
is not necessary for men to go down as they do after coal, for the water
excavates the salt and brings it to the surface.

To obtain the solid salt from the salt water, or brine as it is called,
it is only necessary to heat the liquid, when the water passes away as
steam leaving the salt behind.

Important though this salt is in connection with our food, it is perhaps
still more important as the source from which is derived chlorine and
caustic soda. How this is done can best be explained by means of a
simple experiment which my readers can try in imagination with me or,
better still, perform for themselves.

Take a tumbler and fill it with water with a little salt dissolved in
it. Next obtain two short pieces of wire and two pieces of pencil lead,
which with a pocket lamp battery will complete the apparatus. Connect
one piece of wire to each terminal of the battery and twist the other
end of it round a piece of pencil lead. Place these so that the ends of
the leads dip into the salt water. It is important to keep the wires
out of the solution, the leads alone dipping into the liquid, and the
two leads should be an inch or so apart.

In a few moments you will observe that tiny bubbles are collecting upon
the leads and these joining together into larger bubbles will soon
detach themselves and float up to the surface. Those which arise from
one of the leads will be formed of the gas chlorine and the others of
hydrogen.

It will be interesting just to enumerate the names of the different
parts of this apparatus. First let me say that the process by which
these gases are thus obtained is called electrolysis: the liquid is the
electrolyte: the two pieces of pencil lead are the electrodes. That
electrode by which the current enters the electrolyte is called the
an-ode, while the other is the cath-ode. In other words, the current
traverses them in alphabetical order.

Now it is familiar to everyone that all matter is supposed to consist of
tiny particles called Molecules. These are far too tiny for anyone to
see even with the finest microscope, so we do not know for certain that
they exist: we assume that they do, however, because the idea seems to
fit in with a large number of facts which we can observe and it enables
us to talk intelligibly about them. We may, accordingly, speak as if we
knew for a certainty that molecules really exist.

Now when we dissolve salt in water it seems as if each molecule splits
up into two things which we then call "ions." Salt is not peculiar in
this respect, for many other substances do the same when dissolved in
water. All such substances, since they can be "ionized," are called
"ionogens."

Now the peculiarity about ions is that they are always strongly
electrified or charged with electricity.

At this stage we must make a little excursion into the realm of
electricity. You probably know that if a rod of glass be rubbed with a
silk handkerchief it becomes able to attract little scraps of paper.
That is because the rubbing causes it to become charged with
electricity. In like manner a piece of resin if rubbed will become
charged and will also attract little pieces of paper. A piece of
electrified resin and an electrified glass rod will, moreover, attract
each other, but two pieces of resin or two pieces of glass, if
electrified, will repel each other. This leads us to believe that there
are two kinds of electrification or two kinds of electrical charge. At
first these two kinds were spoken of as vitreous or glass electricity
and resinous electricity, but after a while the idea arose that there
was really one kind of electricity and that everything possessed a
certain amount of it, the electrified glass having a little too much of
it and the electrified resin a shade too little of it. From this came
the idea of calling the charge on the glass a "positive" charge and that
on the resin a "negative" charge. Recent investigations seem to show
that we have got those two terms the wrong way round, but to avoid
confusion we still use them in the old way.

It will be sufficient for our purpose, therefore, if we assume that
every molecule of matter has a certain normal amount of electricity
associated with it and that under those conditions the presence of the
electricity is not in any way noticeable. When a molecule becomes
ionized, however, one ion always seems to run off with more than its
fair share of the electricity, the result being that one is electrified
positively, like rubbed glass, while the other is negatively charged,
like rubbed resin.

Thus, when the common salt is dissolved in water, two lots of ions are
formed, one lot positively charged and the other lot negatively. Each
molecule of salt consists of two atoms, one of sodium and one of
chlorine: consequently, one ion is a chlorine atom and the other is a
sodium atom, the latter being positive and the former negative.

Now the electrodes are also charged by the action of the battery. That
connected to the positive pole of the battery becomes positively charged
and the other negatively. The anode, therefore, is positive and the
cathode negative.

It has been pointed out that two similarly charged bodies, such as two
pieces of glass or two pieces of resin, repel each other, while either
of these attracts one of the other sort. Hence we arrive at a rule that
similarly charged bodies repel each other, while dissimilarly charged
bodies attract each other.

Acting upon this rule, therefore, the anode starts drawing to itself all
the negative ions, in this case the atoms of chlorine, while the cathode
gathers together the positive ions, the atoms of sodium. Thus the action
of the battery maintains a sorting out process by which the sodium is
gathered together around one of the electrodes and the chlorine round
the other. Those ions, by the way, which travel towards the _an_-ode
are called _an_-ions, while those which go to the cath-ode are termed
cat-ions.

Thus far, I think, you will have followed me: the chlorine is gathered
to one place and the sodium to the other. The former creates bubbles and
floats up to the surface and escapes. But where, you will ask, does the
hydrogen come from, which we found, in the experiment, was bubbling up
round the cathode. Moreover, what becomes of the sodium?

Both those questions can be answered together. The sodium ions, having
been drawn away from their old partners the chlorine ions, are unhappy,
and long for fresh partners. They therefore proceed to join up with
molecules of water. But water contains too much hydrogen for that. Every
molecule of water has two atoms of hydrogen linked up with one of
oxygen, but sodium does not like two atoms of hydrogen: it insists on
having one only. Accordingly the oxygen atom from the water, together
with one of the hydrogen atoms, join forces with the sodium atom into a
molecule of a new substance, a most valuable substance in many
manufactures, called Caustic Soda, while the odd atom of hydrogen,
deprived of its partners, has nothing left to do but to cling for a
while to the cathode and finally float up and away.

The sum-total of the operation therefore is this: when we pass an
electric current through salt water, between graphite electrodes,
chlorine goes to the anode and escapes, while caustic soda is formed
round the cathode and hydrogen escapes. Let us see now how this is
applied commercially.

For the production of Chlorine the apparatus need be little more than
our experimental apparatus made large. The anode can be covered in such
a way as to catch the gas as it bubbles upwards. In times of peace this
gas is chiefly used for making bleaching powder. It is led into chambers
where it comes into contact with lime, with which it combines into
chloride of lime, a powder which is sometimes used as a disinfectant,
but the chief use of which is for bleaching those cotton and woollen
fabrics for the manufacture of which this country is famous throughout
the world.

The Germans, however, have taught the world another use for chlorine.
Those gallant Canadians who were the first victims of the attack by
"poison gas" who suddenly found themselves fighting for breath, and a
few of whom, more fortunate than the rest, have reached their homes
shattered in health with permanent damage to their lungs, those brave
fellows suffered from poisoning by chlorine.

We cannot obtain the other product, the caustic soda, by the same simple
means. In our little experiment we succeeded in manufacturing some of it
in the region around the cathode, and had we drawn off some of the
liquid from there we would have been able to detect its presence. But it
would have been mixed up with much ordinary salt, and for commercial
purposes we need the caustic soda separate from the salt. The principle
is, however, just the same, as you will see.

Imagine a large oblong vat divided by vertical partitions into three
separate chambers. These partitions do not quite reach the bottom of
the vessel, so that there is a means of communication between all three
chambers. This is closed, however, by filling the lower part of the vat
with mercury up to a level a little higher than the lower ends of the
partitions.

Thus we have three separate chambers with communication between them but
that communication is sealed up by the mercury.

The two end chambers are filled with salt water, or brine, while the
centre one is filled with a solution of caustic soda. In each end
compartment is a stick of graphite, both being electrically joined
together and so connected up that they form anodes, while in the centre
compartment is the cathode.

When the current flows from the anodes it carries the sodium ions with
it, just as it did in our little experiment. But its course, this time,
is not straight, since in order to travel from anode to cathode it has
to pass through the openings in the partitions, in other words through
the mercury.

On arrival at or near the cathode the ions of sodium cause the caustic
soda to be formed just as in our experiment, but in this case, you will
notice, the formation takes place in a chamber from which the salt brine
is completely excluded by the mercury.

Brine is continually fed into the outer chambers and the solution of
caustic soda is drawn from the centre one, while the chlorine is
collected over the anodes.

And now we can go a step further on our progress from common salt to
explosive.

In the soap works there are enormous coppers in which are boiled various
kinds of fat. The source of the fat may be either animal or vegetable,
many kinds of beans, nuts and seeds furnishing fats practically
identical with that which can be got from the fat flesh of a sheep, for
instance. To this fat is added some caustic soda solution and the whole
is kept boiling for some considerable time. This protracted boiling is
to enable the soda thoroughly to attack the fat and combine with it,
whereby two entirely new substances are formed.

At first the two new substances are not apparent, for they remain
together in one liquid. The addition, however, of some brine causes the
change to become obvious for something in the liquid turns solid, so
that it can be easily taken away from the rest. That solid is nothing
else than soap. It remained dissolved in the water which forms part of
the liquid until the salt was put in, but as it will not dissolve in
salt water, as you will discover if you attempt to wash in sea water, it
separates out as soon as the salt is added.

But still a liquid remains: what can that be? It is mainly salt water
and glycerine, that sticky stuff which in peace times we put on our
hands if they get sore in winter, or take, in a little water, to soothe
a sore throat. That it has other and very different uses was brought
home to me when, during the war, I tried to buy some at a chemist's,
only to learn that it could not be sold except in cases of extreme need
under the orders of a doctor.

The mixed liquid is distilled with the result that the water is driven
off and the salt deposited, which with other minor purifying processes
gives the pure glycerine.

The next step takes us to the explosives factory, where the glycerine is
mixed with sulphuric and nitric acids. Now glycerine, as you will have
observed, comes from the animal or vegetable sources and therefore is
one of those substances known as "organic," and, like many other of the
organic compounds, it consists of carbon, hydrogen and oxygen. Nature
has a marvellous way of combining these same three things together in
many various ways to form many widely different substances and if, to
such a compound, we can add a little nitrogen, we usually get an
explosive. Thus, the glycerine, with some nitrogen from the nitric acid,
becomes nitro-glycerine, a most ferocious and excitable explosive, the
basis of several of those explosives without which warfare as we know it
to-day would be impossible.



CHAPTER II

GUNPOWDER AND ITS MODERN EQUIVALENTS


The origin of gunpowder appears to be lost in antiquity. At all events
it has been in use for many centuries and is still made in many
countries.

Most boys have tried to make it at some time or other and with varying
degrees of success. Such experiments generally lead to a glorious blaze,
a delightfully horrid smell and no harm to anyone, the experimenter
owing his safety to his invariable lack of complete success, for
although other and better explosives have superseded it for many
purposes it is capable of doing a lot of harm when it is well made.

It consists of a mixture of charcoal, sulphur and saltpetre ground up
very fine and mixed very intimately together. The mixture is wetted and
pressed into cakes and dried, after which it is broken up into small
pieces. The precise proportions of the various materials seem to vary a
great deal in different countries, but generally speaking there is about
75 per cent of saltpetre (or to give it its scientific name, nitrate of
potash), 15 per cent of charcoal and 10 per cent of sulphur.

Now gunpowder, like all explosives, is simply some thing or mixture of
things which is capable of burning very quickly. When we light the fire
we set going the process which we call combustion, or burning, and, as
we know from our own experience, that process causes heat to be
generated.

What takes place in the fire-grate is that the carbon of the coal enters
into combination with oxygen from the air, the two together forming a
new compound called "carbonic acid gas." There is nothing lost or
destroyed in this process, the carbon and oxygen simply changing into
the new substance, and could we weigh the gas produced we should find
that it agreed precisely with the weight of the carbon and oxygen
consumed. For the purpose for which we require the fire, namely, to heat
the room, the chief feature about this process is not what is formed in
the shape of gas, for that simply goes off up the chimney, but the heat
which is liberated. We believe that in some mysterious way the heat is
locked up in the coal. Latent is the term we use, which means hidden: in
other words we believe that the heat is hidden in the coal: we cannot
feel it or perceive it in any way, but it comes out when we let the
carbon combine with the oxygen.

Why these two things combine at all is one of those mysteries which may
never be solved. We have theories on the subject, but all we really know
is that under certain conditions if they be in contact with one another
they will combine, apparently for the simple reason that it is their
nature so to do.

When we apply the match to the fire all we do is to set up the
conditions under which the carbon and oxygen are able to follow their
natural instincts, so to speak.

A coal fire, as we all know, burns slowly, for the simple reason that it
is only at the surface of the lumps that carbon and oxygen are in
contact. If we grind up the coal into a fine powder and then blow it
into a cloud, so that every tiny particle is surrounded with air, a
spark will cause an explosion. That is how these terrible explosions in
coal-pits are caused.

This is sometimes seen on a small scale when one shakes the empty
fire-shovel after putting coal on the fire to get rid of the fine dust
adhering to it and to save making a mess in the fender. That little
cloud of fine dust will often burst into flame like a mild explosion.

We see from this that to make an explosion we require fuel, just as we
do to make a fire: but we need that it shall be very intimately mixed
with oxygen, so that all of it can burn up in practically a single
instant. Now in gunpowder we get these conditions fulfilled. We have the
carbon in the shape of charcoal, we also have some sulphur which
likewise burns readily, and we have saltpetre which contains oxygen.

Thus, you see, we do not need to go to the air for the oxygen, for the
gunpowder possesses it already, locked up in the saltpetre. Moreover, we
can see now why it is so important for all the materials to be ground up
very fine, for it is only by so doing that we can ensure that every
particle of charcoal or sulphur shall have particles of saltpetre close
by ready to furnish oxygen at a moment's notice.

Another thing to be observed, for it lets us into the great key to the
manufacture of nearly all explosives, is the scientific name of
saltpetre. It is "nitrate of potassium," and all substances whose names
begin with "nitr-" contain nitrogen: while the termination "ate"
signifies the presence of oxygen. We need the oxygen to make the
explosion but we do not need the nitrogen, yet the latter has to be
present for without it the oxygen would be too slow in getting to work.

Nitrogen is one of the strangest substances on earth. Extremely lazy
itself, it has the knack of hustling its companions, particularly
oxygen, and making them work with tremendous fury. Whenever we get the
lazy gas nitrogen to enter into a combination with other things we may
confidently look for extraordinary activity of some sort.

So when we put a light to a quantity of gunpowder we set up those
conditions under which the carbon and oxygen can combine, and at the
same moment our lazy friend the nitrogen turns out his partner oxygen
from the nitrate in which they were till then combined and a sudden
burning is the result. The solid gunpowder is suddenly changed into a
volume of hot gas 2500 times as great. That is to say, one cubic inch of
gunpowder changes suddenly into 2500 cubic inches of gas. That sudden
expansion to 2500 times its volume is what we term an explosion. If it
takes place in an enclosed space so that the gas formed wants to expand
but cannot, the result is a pressure of about forty tons per square
inch.

If that enclosed space were the interior of a gun, that force of forty
tons per square inch would be available for driving out the projectile.

Now, gunpowder is still used for sporting purposes and also for some
special purposes in warfare, but it has the great disadvantage that it
makes a lot of smoke, so that the enemy would be easily able to locate
the guns were it to be used in them. As we know so well, by the messages
from France, guns and rifles drop their shells and bullets apparently
from nowhere and are extremely difficult to locate. That is owing to the
use of improved powders one of the great features of which is their
smokelessness.

The reason why gunpowder makes a dense smoke, is because the burning
which takes place is very incomplete. Therefore, by some such means as a
more intimate mixture of the materials a better and more complete
burning must be brought about.

One of the best known of the new powders (they are all spoken of as
powders, whatever their form, since they have taken the place of the old
gunpowder) is nitro-glycerine, the basis of which is glycerine.

The way in which we obtain this useful material has already been
explained. It consists of carbon, a lot of hydrogen and some oxygen.
These are not merely mixed together but are in combination, just as
oxygen and hydrogen are combined in water. Carbon and hydrogen will both
combine with oxygen and will give off heat in the process, but in
glycerine they are already happily united together and so glycerine
itself is no use as an explosive. If, however, we bring nitric acid and
sulphuric acid into contact with it a pair of new partnerships is set
up, one being water and the other a compound containing carbon and
hydrogen, a lot of oxygen and, most important of all, some of that
disturbing, restless though lazy nitrogen.

This is nitro-glycerine, a particularly furious explosive, for that
curious nitrogen seems to be so uncomfortable in his new surroundings
that at the smallest provocation he will break up the whole combination
and then there will be a mass of free atoms of carbon, hydrogen and
oxygen, all seeking new partners, just right for a glorious explosion.

So furious and untamed is this stuff that it was almost useless until
the famous Nobel hit upon the idea of taming it down by mixing it with
an earth called Kieselguhr, which reduces its sensitiveness sufficiently
to make it a very safe explosive to use. To this mixture Nobel gave the
name of dynamite.

It is interesting at this point to compare the action of this typical
modern explosive with that of the older gunpowder. The latter is only a
mixture: the former is a chemical compound. The smallest particle of
material in the gunpowder is a little lump containing millions of
molecules and still more of atoms: when the nitrogen has broken up the
original nitro-glycerine, just before the explosion actually takes
place, we have a mixture of _single atoms_. Thus the mixture is far more
intimate in the latter case and the burning is therefore quicker and
more thorough.

[Illustration: MACHINE-GUN _versus_ RIFLE.

This illustrates the rapidity and accuracy with which the modern rifle
can be used. Sergeant O'Leary, V.C., tackled a gun crew of five and
killed them all before they had time to slew their gun round--a striking
contrast to the "Brown Bess" of a hundred years ago.]

Another well-known explosive is gun-cotton. Surely this must be a fancy
name, for what can harmless, simple cotton have to do in connection with
guns. It is a perfectly genuine descriptive name, however. It seems very
strange at first, but it is perfectly true that nitrogen, as it turned
glycerine into dynamite, can also turn cotton into gun-cotton. Cotton
consists mainly of cellulose, a compound of carbon, hydrogen and oxygen,
happily combined together and therefore showing, as we well know from
experience, no tendency whatever to change into anything else, least of
all to "go off bang." But that state of things is very much changed when
we have induced nitrogen to take a hand in the game.

In actual practice, cotton waste, pure and clean, is dipped into a
mixture of sulphuric and nitric acids whereby the cellulose becomes
changed into nitro-cellulose, just as a similar process changes
glycerine into nitro-glycerine. The whole process of manufacture is of
course far more than that simple dipping, but that is the fundamental
fact of it all. The rest is concerned with getting rid of the
superfluous acid, tearing the stuff into pulp and pressing it into
blocks. It is probably the safest of explosives, since it can be kept
wet, in which case the danger of an accidental explosion is practically
nil, provided reasonable care be taken. Even when dry, it behaves in a
very kindly way. If hit with a hammer, it only burns for a moment just
at the point struck. If ignited with a red-hot rod, it burns but does
not explode, unless it is enclosed. The burning, that is to say, is not
sufficiently rapid to constitute an explosion.

On the other hand, if it be exploded by a detonator, by which is meant a
small quantity of a very powerful explosive, such as fulminate of
mercury, fired close to it, it then goes off with a violence which
leaves little to be desired.

It would be better still could we persuade a little more oxygen to enter
into its composition, for as it is there is not quite enough to burn up
the other matters completely. That, however, does not cause smoke, since
the combustion is complete enough to change everything into invisible
gases. With more oxygen more heat might be generated and the power of
the explosion be made greater. Still, even as it is, the explosion of
gun-cotton has been estimated by a high authority to produce a pressure
of 160 tons per square inch, four times as much as gunpowder.
Nitro-glycerine has the advantage of a rather larger proportion of
oxygen to carbon, resulting in its being rather more energetic.

Yet another class of explosive is made from Coal Tar. This is a
by-product in the manufacture of gas for lighting and also in the
manufacture of coke for industrial purposes. It comes from the retorts
along with the gas in a gaseous form but condenses into a black liquid
in the pipes and more particularly in an arrangement of cooled pipes
called a condenser specially placed to intercept it.

In the chemist's eyes it is the most interesting of liquids, for it is
full of mysteries and possibilities. The most wonderful achievements of
chemistry have it for their raw material and there is still scope for
much more in the same direction.

If the tar be gently heated in a closed vessel it will evaporate and the
vapour can be led to another vessel, there cooled and converted back
into a liquid. This looks rather like doing work for nothing, but the
various liquids, of which tar is a mixture, evaporate at different
temperatures, so that this furnishes a means of separating them. The
first liquid thus procured is known as coal tar naphtha, and if it be
again distilled it can be subdivided further, the first liquid separated
from it being known as Benzine. This, again, is another of those almost
numberless things which consist of carbon and hydrogen. Also, like the
other similar substances which we have been discussing, it can, if
treated with nitric acid, be made to take into partnership a quantity of
oxygen and nitrogen.

Thus we get nitro-benzene. We can repeat the process, when it will take
more and become di-nitro-benzene. Again we can repeat it, thus producing
tri-nitro-benzene.

The second liquid separated from coal tar naphtha is called Toluene,
which again is composed of carbon and hydrogen in slightly different
proportions. Like its confrère benzene it, too, can be treated with
nitric acid, becoming nitro-toluene and then di-nitro-toluene and
finally tri-nitro-toluene, the deadly explosive of which we read in the
papers as T.N.T.

After the naphtha has been removed from the tar another substance is
obtained called Phenol, which in a prepared form is familiar to us all
as the disinfectant Carbolic Acid. It also can be treated with nitric
acid, to produce tri-nitro-phenol, otherwise known as Picric Acid, which
after a little further treatment becomes the famous "Lyddite."

Most of the actual explosives used in warfare are prepared from one or
more of the above-mentioned compounds. For example, nitro-glycerine and
gun-cotton, having been dissolved in acetone (another compound of
carbon, hydrogen and oxygen) and a little vaseline added, form a soft
gelatinous substance which on being squeezed through a fine hole comes
out looking like a cord or string, and hence is called Cordite.

Other explosives are finished in the form of sheets, the dissolved
gun-cotton or whatever it may be being rolled between hot rollers which
give it the convenient form of sheets and at the same time evaporate the
solvent.

By combining these various substances various characteristics can be
given to the finished explosive. For instance, the one which drives the
shell from the gun, known as the propellant, must not be too sudden in
its action. It must push steadily. Its purpose is to drive the shell not
to burst the gun, wherefore its action must be comparatively slow and
continuous so long as the shell is still in the gun. It must "follow
through" as the golf player would put it.

The charge in the shell, however, needs to go off with the greatest
possible violence so as to blow the shell to pieces and to scatter the
fragments so that they do the maximum of damage.

Those explosives, whose function is thus to burst with a sudden shock,
are called High Explosives, as distinguished from the propellants which
produce a more or less sustained push.

The great fundamental principle which enables large quantities of these
powerfully explosive substances to be handled with comparative safety
involves the use of two different substances in combination. That which
is used in quantity and which actually does the work is made
comparatively insensitive, indeed in some cases it is very insensitive,
so that it can safely travel by train, by ship and by road and also may
be handled by the soldiers and sailors with very little risk. Some of
these compounds can be struck or set on fire with impunity. They are
none the less violent, however, when, by the agency of a suitable
detonator they are caused to explode.

The detonator, of course, has to be very sensitive indeed, but it need
only be used in very small quantities, so that by itself it, too, is
comparatively safe. Fulminate of mercury is often employed for this
purpose--a compound based upon mercury but in which nitrogen of course
figures largely.

Thus, there are two things necessary for the successful explosion, one
of which is powerful but insensitive, while the other is highly
sensitive but relatively harmless since it is never allowed to exist in
large quantities, and as far as possible these are kept apart until the
last moment.

One other thing may be mentioned in regard to this matter which is of
the greatest importance. That is the necessity for the utmost uniformity
in these various compounds, so that when the gunners put a charge into a
gun they can rely upon it to throw the shell exactly as its predecessor
did. Modern artillery seeks to throw shell after shell within a small
area which would clearly be quite impossible if one charge were liable
to be stronger or weaker than another, for we can easily see that the
more powerful the impetus given the farther will the shell go.

To secure this uniformity the greatest care is taken at all stages of
the manufacture, and various batches of the same stuff are tested and
mixed, and any of them turning out a little too strong are placed with
some a little too weak, so that their faults may neutralize each other.
By such methods as these a remarkable degree of uniformity is attained,
the result of which we see when we read in the papers of the wonderfully
accurate gunnery of which our soldiers and sailors are capable.

In conclusion, a word of warning may be appropriate. Reference has been
made above to the safety of modern explosives in the absence of the
detonators, but do not let that lead anyone to take liberties. Should
any reader come into possession of any of these materials, even in the
smallest quantities, let him treat it with the utmost respect, for
although what has been said about safety is quite correct, it only means
comparative safety, there can be no absolute safety where these
substances are concerned.



CHAPTER III

RADIUM IN WAR


When we remember how all forms of scientific knowledge were called upon
to help in the great struggle, it is not surprising to hear that,
although in a comparatively humble way, Radium has had to do its share.

Now radium is one of the most, if not actually the most, remarkable
substance known. About a generation ago scientific men, or some of them
at all events, were getting rather cocksure. Of course they were quite
right when they realized how much was known about things and what great
strides had been made during the years through which they had lived.
They were proud of the achievements of their scientific friends, for I
am not imputing personal vanity to anyone, and they had reason to be
proud. They made the mistake, however, of thinking that in one direction
at least they had learnt all that there was to be known. The present
generation of scientific men seem to be almost too prone to go to the
other extreme and to dwell rather much on how little we know now and the
wonderful things which are going to be discovered in time.

But that is by the way. A generation ago men seem to have pretty well
made up their minds that they knew all about atoms. They said that
everything was made up of atoms, that the atoms could not be subdivided
nor changed into anything else except temporarily by combination with
other atoms, and that when these combinations were broken up the atoms
remained just as before, quite unchanged. They believed that the atoms
were unchangeable and everlasting. Professor Tyndall, in a famous
address, referred to this in somewhat flowery language, telling his
hearers that the atoms would be still the same when they and he had
"melted into the infinite azure of the past," which a wag translated
into the slang expression of the time, "till all is blue."

Now not very long after Professor Tyndall made this historic speech
Professor Henri Becquerel, of Paris, was trying some experiments with
phosphorescent materials, that is, materials which glow in the darkness.
In the course of these experiments he used some photographic plates upon
which, to his surprise, he found marks which he thought ought not to
have been there. Thinking at first that he had accidentally "fogged" his
plates, as every photographer has done at some time or other, he tried
his experiments again with special care but still he got the mysterious
marks.

Those marks were caused by some of those "unchangeable and everlasting"
atoms deliberately and of their own accord blowing themselves to bits.

For the celebrated Frenchman was not content to let the matter of those
mysterious marks rest: he wanted to know what caused them and he did not
desist until he was on the track of the secret. It appeared after
careful investigation that they were made by the action of something in
some of the ore of the metal "uranium" which he had been using.
Moreover, this something evidently had the power of penetrating through
the walls of the dark-slide to the plate within. Finally, it was tracked
down to the uranium itself which was unquestionably proved to be giving
off something in the nature of invisible light, or at all events
invisible rays, of strange penetrative power. A little later it was
observed that certain ores of uranium seemed to give off these rays more
freely than would be accounted for by the amount of uranium present,
from which fact it was inferred that there must be something else
present in the ore capable of giving off the rays much more powerfully
than uranium can. Madame Curie ultimately found out two such substances,
one of which she called, after her native land, Polonium (for she is a
Pole), and the other Radium. It is the latter which is responsible for
by far the greater part of the rays formed.

The rays are invisible, but they affect a photographic plate in the same
way that light does. They also make air into a conductor of electricity
and if allowed to impinge upon a surface coated with a suitable
substance they cause it to glow.

This spontaneous giving off of rays is now spoken of by the general term
of "radio-activity," and it has grown into an important branch of
science. A number of other substances have been found to exhibit the
same peculiar ray-forming powers, notably Thorium, one of the components
of the incandescent gas mantle by the prolonged application of a
fragment of which to a photographic plate an impression can be obtained
due to the rays.

What, then, are these rays? It is found that they are of three kinds,
not that they vary from time to time, but that they can be sorted out
into three different sorts of rays which are given off simultaneously
all the time.

The first sort are stopped by a sheet of paper, the second passing
easily through a thick metal plate, while the third appear to be
identical with X-rays.

For convenience the three sorts are termed Alpha, Beta and Gamma rays,
respectively, after the first three letters of the Greek alphabet.

Further, the Alpha rays prove to be a torrent of tiny particles about
the size of atoms, indeed if they be collected the gas Helium is
obtained, so that evidently they are helium atoms, and since that is one
of those substances whose molecules consist of a single atom each they
are also molecules of helium. No doubt the reason why they are so easily
stopped by a piece of paper is because being complete atoms they are
large, huge indeed, compared with the particles which form the Beta
rays, for they are apparently those same electrons which are found in
the X-ray tube, and which are at least 2000 times smaller than the
smallest atom.

When the electrons in the vacuum tube are suddenly brought to a
standstill X-rays are given off and in like manner X-rays no doubt would
be given off when they start on their journey, providing that they
started suddenly enough. Hence it is the starting or sudden
explosion-like ejection of the Beta particles which is believed to give
rise to the Gamma rays.

The strength or intensity of the rays can be measured very conveniently
by their action in making air conductive to electricity, for which
purpose a very beautiful but simple instrument called an Electroscope is
employed. It consists generally of a glass-sided box or else a bottle
with a large stopper, consisting of sulphur or some other particularly
good insulator. Through this a wire passes down into the inside of the
vessel terminating in a vertical flat strip to the upper end of which is
attached a similar strip of gold leaf or aluminium foil. Normally the
leaf hangs down close to the strip, but if the wire above the stopper be
electrified by touching it with a piece of sealing-wax rubbed lightly
against the coat sleeve the charge of electricity passes down into the
inside and causes both strip and leaf to become so electrified that they
repel each other.

Owing to the non-conductivity of the air in its normal condition the
leaf will, if the insulation of the stopper be good, remain projecting
almost horizontally for some time until, as it loses its charge by a
slow leakage, it gradually settles down close to the strip.

If, however, a piece of radium be brought near while it is sticking out,
the leaf will fall almost instantly. X-rays have a similar effect even
from several feet or yards away.

The intensity of the radio-activity of different substances can be
compared by noting the difference in the rate at which the leaf falls
under the influence of each.

What is happening, then, to the atoms of radium, which causes them to
show these curious effects and to give off these strange rays? To give
any intelligent answer to that question we are bound to assume that
which the older generation of scientists thought impossible, namely,
that atoms can be broken up. Then we are forced to believe that the
atoms of this particular substance radium are of a peculiarly flimsy
unstable sort, so that they cannot permanently hold their parts together
but are liable to break up, as far as we can see through their own
inherent weakness and under the influence of disruptive forces at work
within themselves.

We must remember, however, that the tiniest speck of matter which we can
see contains a number of atoms of such a size as to be quite beyond the
grasp of our minds. To give a rough idea of it in figures is useless as
no one can comprehend the real value of a figure or two followed by
probably from a dozen to twenty "noughts." It is best to content
ourselves with the general statement that a speck of matter only just
visible to the eye contains an exceedingly vast number of atoms. Of
course a speck of radium is no exception to this and we must remember,
too, that all of them do not break up at once. Indeed, the number
breaking up at any time are actually countable by means of a very simple
contrivance and a sensitive electrometer. Consequently, in view of the
enormous number present and the comparatively small number breaking up
at any moment, it is not surprising to hear that, so it is estimated,
the process can go on for an almost indefinite number of years,
certainly for hundreds. There are, moreover, certain facts which we need
not go into here from which the above fact can be clearly inferred,
quite apart from what has been said about the vast numbers of the atoms.

It seems as if the uranium atoms break up first, giving off helium atoms
and electrons and leaving an intermediate substance called Ionium which
in its turn breaks up giving off the same things again and leaving
radium. That in its turn goes through a complicated series of changes
still giving off the same alpha particles or atoms of helium and
electrons until, it is suggested, it finally settles down into the
simple commonplace metal lead of which we make bullets and water pipes
and such-like ordinary things.

We see then that all through its history--its radio-active history at
any rate--this stuff is throwing off atoms of helium at a very high
velocity (about 50,000 miles a second), and if it be enclosed in
anything this enclosing vessel or substance will be subjected to a
continual bombardment by the alpha particles. Now just as a piece of
iron gets hot if we hammer it, so the enclosing matter is heated by the
continual blows which it is receiving night and day, year in and year
out, from the alpha particles.

Consequently the immediate surroundings of a speck of radium are always
slightly raised in temperature.

Moreover, if a speck of radium be placed against a screen covered with
suitable materials each particle which strikes it will make a little
splash of light. At least that is what it looks like when seen through a
magnifying glass, but to the naked eye there only appears a beautiful
steady glow.

Suppose, then, that instead of putting the speck of radiant matter in
front of a screen we mix it up intimately with a fluorescent substance
such as sulphide of zinc, we then get the same conditions in a slightly
different form. Each particle of the substance serves as a tiny screen
which glows every time a particle hits it. Thus is produced a luminous
paint which glows by night, suitable for painting the dials of
instruments which have to be used in the dark.

No doubt some of my readers will have experienced the strangely mingled
delight and horror of seeing a Zeppelin in the night sky intent on
dropping murder and death on the sleeping civilians of a peaceful town
or city. Some too may have witnessed the later acts in that wonderful
drama, when, beside the silvery monster illuminated by the beams of the
searchlight there must have been, though quite invisible, a little
aeroplane manned by one man or at most two. That aeroplane was, no
doubt, fitted with instruments at which the pilot glanced now and then
and which he was able to see and read because of the tiny speck of
radium mixed into the paint. The little alpha particles gave him the
light by which to see, but they gave no help to the Germans on the
Zeppelin. Hence, in due time he did his work and the gigantic balloon,
the pride of the Kaiser and his hordes, fell to the ground, a blazing
wreck. How he did it I cannot tell, but of this I am sure, that most
probably radium helped him by making luminous and visible the
instruments which guided him.

But probably it has rendered and will still render us even greater
services in the way of helping to repair the damages to our injured
manhood. How many men came back from the war crippled with rheumatism
because of the hardships through which they went. That disease is
believed to be due to a substance which mingles with the blood and
which, although usually liquid and harmless sometimes changes into a
solid and settles in the joints. Now it is believed that radium properly
administered will act upon that solid and cause it to change back into
its liquid form again, thereby curing the disease. Certainly many of the
mineral springs at such places as Bath and Buxton give forth a water
which shows a certain amount of radio-activity and it may be that which
gives those waters their healing properties. If so, we may look forward
with confidence to the time when radio-activity will be induced to play
a still more successful part in meeting this painful and widespread
illness.

Then, of the other ills which will inevitably arise in our men through
the hardships which they have endured are sure to be some of the
cancerous type, many of which appear to succumb to treatment by radium.
If a very small quantity indeed be carried for a few days in a pocket it
will imprint itself upon the skin beneath as if it burnt the tissues. It
is never advisable, therefore, to carry radium in the pocket without
special precautions. One cannot help feeling, however, that in that
little fact is a hint of usefulness when the best modes of application
have been discovered, for as a means of safely and painlessly burning
away some undesirable growth it would seem to be without a rival. It is
said, too, that it has the strange power of discriminating between the
normal and the abnormal, attacking the latter but leaving the former, so
that when applied, say, to some abnormal growth like cancer it may be
able to remove it without harmful effect upon the surrounding tissues.

Of this, however, it is too soon to write with confidence. It has not
been known long enough for our doctors to find out the best modes of
use, but that will come with time: meanwhile there are indications that
in all probability it will render good service to mankind.



CHAPTER IV

A GOOD SERVANT, THOUGH A BAD MASTER


One morning during the war the whole British nation was startled to
learn that Mr. Lloyd George, then the Minister of Munitions, had taken
over a large number of distilleries. Could it be that he, a teetotaller
and temperance advocate, was going to supply all his workers with
whiskey? Or was he going to close the places so as to stop the supply of
that tempting drink?

Neither of these suggestions was his real reason. What he wanted the
distilleries for was to make alcohol for the war, not for drinking
purposes but for the very many uses which only alcohol can fulfil in
most important manufactures.

Probably alcohol is the next important liquid to water. For example,
certain parts of shells have to be varnished and the only satisfactory
way to make varnish is to dissolve certain gums in alcohol. The spirit
makes the solid gum for the time being into a liquid which we can spread
with a brush, yet, after being spread, it evaporates and passes off into
the air, leaving behind a beautiful coating of gum. That is how all
varnishing is done, the alcohol forming the vehicle in which the solid
gum is for the moment carried and by which it is applied. It is far and
away the most suitable liquid for the purpose, and without it varnishing
would be very difficult and unsatisfactory. Hence one need for alcohol,
to carry on the war.

Then again some of the most important explosives are solid or
semi-solid, and yet they require to be mixed in order to form the
various "powders" in use by our gunners. The best way to bring about
this mixture is to dissolve the two components in alcohol, thereby
forming them both into liquids which can be readily mixed. Afterwards
the alcohol evaporates; indeed, one of its great virtues for this and
similar purposes is that it quietly takes itself off when it has done
its work like a very well-drilled servant.

What then is this precious liquid and how is it produced? In order to
answer that question it is necessary first to state that there are a
whole family of substances called "alcohols," all of which are composed
of carbon, hydrogen and oxygen in certain proportions. There are also a
number of kindred substances also, not exactly brothers but first
cousins, so to speak, which because of their resemblance to this
important family have names terminating in "ol."

They owe their existence to the wonderful behaviour of the atoms of
carbon. In order to obtain some sort of system whereby the various
combinations of carbon can be simply explained chemists picture each
carbon atom as being armed with four little links or hooks with which it
is able to grapple, as it were, and hold on to other atoms. Each
hydrogen atom, likewise, has its hook, but only one instead of four.

Now it is easy to picture to ourselves an atom of carbon in the middle
with its hooks pointing out north, south, east and west with a hydrogen
atom linked on to each. That gives us a picture of the molecule of
Methane, the gas which forms the chief constituent of coal gas such as
we burn in our homes. Methane is also given off by petroleum and it is
the cause of the explosions in coal mines, being known to the miners as
"firedamp." It is the first of a long series of substances which the
chemist called paraffins. The first, as you see, consists of one of
carbon and four of hydrogen. Add another of carbon and two more of
hydrogen and you get the second "Ethane." Add the same again and you get
the third, Propane, and so on until you can reach a substance consisting
of thirty-five parts of carbon and seventy-two parts of hydrogen. All we
need trouble about, however, is the first two, Methane and Ethane.

We have pictured to ourselves the molecule of methane: let us do the
same with ethane. Imagine two carbon atoms side by side linked together
or hand in hand. Each will be using one of its hooks to grasp one hook
of its brother atom. Hence each will have three hooks to spare on to
which we can hook a hydrogen atom. Thus we get two of carbon and six of
hydrogen neatly and prettily linked up together. The atoms form an
interesting little pattern and to build up the various paraffin
molecules with a pencil and paper has all the attractions of a puzzle or
game. All you have to do is to add a fresh atom of carbon alongside the
others and then attach an atom of hydrogen to each available unused
hook. If you care to try this you will get the whole series, each one
having one atom of carbon and two of hydrogen more than its predecessor.

If you mix together a quantity of methane and an equal quantity of
chlorine, which I have shown you in another chapter how to get from
common salt, a change takes place, for in each molecule of methane one
hydrogen atom becomes detached and an atom of chlorine takes its place.
How or why this change occurs we do not know. It is a fact that the
chlorine has this power to oust the hydrogen and there we must leave it,
for the present at any rate. The substance so formed is called methyl
chloride.

In another chapter reference has been made to that substance which is
made from common salt and which is so important in so many manufactures
called caustic soda. If we bring some of it into contact with the methyl
chloride the chlorine is punished for its rudeness in displacing the
hydrogen; it is paid back in its own coin, for it is in turn displaced
not this time by a single atom but by a little partnership called
"hydroxyl" one atom of hydrogen and one of oxygen acting together. We
can again form a neat little picture of what happens. The oxygen atom
has two hooks, one of which it gives to its friend the hydrogen atom and
thus they go about hand-in-hand, the oxygen having one unused hook with
which to hook on to something else. In this case it hooks on to that
particular hook from which it pushes the chlorine.

We have thus seen two changes take place. First, the hydrogen is
displaced by the chlorine: then the chlorine is turned out and its place
taken by the hydroxyl. And during both these changes the central carbon
atom and its three hydrogen partners have remained unaffected. Those
four atoms are called the methyl group, and a methyl group combined with
a hydroxyl group forms _methyl alcohol_.

Similar changes can be brought about with Ethane as with Methane, and in
them the two carbon atoms and the five hydrogen remain unchanged, whence
they too are regarded as a group, the Ethyl group, and an ethyl group
hooked on to a hydroxyl group gives us a molecule of _ethyl alcohol_.

These groups of which we have been speaking never exist separately
except at the moment of change, but in the wonderful changes which the
chemist is able to bring about the atoms forming these groups seem to
have a fondness for keeping together and moving together from one
substance into another. In a word, they behave as if they were each a
single atom and they are called by the name of Radicles; the word simply
means a little root.

The methyl radicle and the ethyl radicle, since they form the basis of
two of the paraffin series, are called paraffin radicles, so that we can
describe this useful alcohol as a paraffin radicle with a hydroxyl
radicle hooked on to it. If we use the methyl radicle we get methyl
alcohol: if we use the ethyl radicle we get ethyl alcohol.

Now ethyl alcohol is the spirit which is contained in all strong drink.
Whiskey has as much as 40 per cent and brandy and rum about the same,
while ale has only about 6 per cent. All of them may be regarded as
impure forms of ethyl alcohol, the various impurities giving to each its
particular taste.

Ethyl alcohol, too, is what is sold at chemists' shops as "spirits of
wine," where also we can purchase that which is familiar as "methylated
spirits," whereby there hangs a tale.

All Governments regard alcohol for drinking as a fit subject for
taxation. When anyone buys a drink with alcohol in it a part of what he
pays goes to the Government in the form of duty. On the other hand, when
alcohol is used for trade purposes, for making varnish or something like
that, there is no reason whatever why it should be charged with duty.
But if the varnish manufacturer is to have alcohol duty-free what is to
prevent him from using some of it for drinking?

To get over the difficulty, that which is supplied to him or to anyone
else for trade purposes is deliberately adulterated so as to make it so
extremely nasty that no one is likely to want to put it in his mouth.

It so happens that methyl alcohol, while as good as the other for many
purposes, is horrible to the taste and so it forms a very convenient
adulterant for this purpose. Therefore, when methylated spirit is sold
to you for drying your photographs, the chemist gives you ethyl alcohol
with enough methyl alcohol in it to make sure that neither you nor
anyone else will ever want to drink it.

That, then, is alcohol: a near relative of paraffin oil and also of coal
gas, yet it is from neither of these that we get it. The changes
described above enable you to realize what it is, but they do not tell
how it is made in large quantities.

Ethyl alcohol is obtained from sugar by the employment of germs or
microbes. Any sort of sugar will do: it need not be sugar such as we
eat. In practice the sugar is usually obtained from starch, that very
common substance which forms the material of potatoes, grain of all
kinds, beans and so on. There is a kindly little germ which will quite
readily turn starch into sugar for us if we give it the chance.

The maltster starts the process. He gets some grain, and spreading it
out in a damp condition upon his floor sets it a-growing. As soon as it
has just started to grow, however, he transfers it to his kiln, where by
heating it he kills the young plants. As is well known, every seed
contains the food to nourish the little growing plant until it is strong
enough to draw its supplies from the soil and the food thus provided for
the young wheat plant is starch, which, when it is ready for it, it
turns into sugar. The little shoot lives on sugar and the maltster and
distiller conspire to steal that sugar intended for the baby plants and
turn it into alcohol.

So the little plant liberates by some wonderful means a material called
diastase, which has the power of changing starch into sugar. It does it,
of course, for the purpose of providing its own necessary food, but the
maltster does not want the process to go too far: he only wants to
produce the diastase, and that is why he kills the plants, after which
he has finished with the matter and hands the "malted" grain or "malt"
over to the distiller for the next process.

The distiller mixes the malt with warm water, whereupon the diastase
commences the conversion of the starch of the grain. At this stage fresh
grain may be added and potatoes, indeed almost anything composed largely
of starch for the diastase to work upon. The process goes on until, in
time, the liquid consists very largely of sugar dissolved in water,
which is strained away from what is left of the grain, etc.

Malt sugar is very similar to, but not quite the same as, cane sugar. It
consists of twelve parts of carbon, twenty-two of hydrogen and eleven of
oxygen. It is an interesting little puzzle to sketch those atoms out on
paper, each with its proper number of hooks, and see how they can be
combined together. Malt sugar, milk sugar and cane sugar all consist of
the same three elements in the same proportions and the difference
between them is no doubt due to the different ways in which the atoms
can be hooked up together.

Yeast is next added to the liquid, upon which the process of
fermentation is set up, the tiny living cells of the yeast plant
producing a substance which is able to change the sugar into alcohol.

The alcohol thus formed is, of course, combined with water, but it can
be separated from it by gentle heating since it passes off into vapour
at a lower temperature than does water. Thus the vapour first arising
from the mixture is caught and cooled whereby the liquid alcohol is
obtained. This operation, called fractional distillation, has to be
repeated if alcohol quite free from water is required, in addition to
which the attraction which quicklime has for water is called into play
to coax the last remnant of water from the other.

And now, how about the methyl alcohol? That is obtained in quite a
different way, by heating wood and collecting the vapours given off by
it. Hence it is often called "wood spirit."

As a matter of fact, at least two very valuable substances are obtained
by this operation, methyl alcohol and acetone.

The vapours given off by the wood are cooled, whereupon tar is formed
while upon it there floats a dark liquid which contains the wood spirit,
acetic acid and acetone.

To capture the acetic acid lime is added to the mixture, and since there
is a natural affinity between them, the acetic acid and lime combine
into a solid which remains behind when the whole mass is suitably
heated. What comes over in the form of vapour is a mixture of water,
acetone and wood spirit. The former is enticed away by the use of
quicklime, while the other two are separated by the process of
fractional distillation already referred to.

Now let me ask you to form another little picture, either in your mind
or with paper and pencil. Imagine two methyl radicles, each, let me
remind you, a carbon atom with three hydrogen atoms hooked on and one
spare hook. Also imagine one atom of oxygen with its two hooks
outstretched like two arms, and just link one radicle on to each. Then
you have the picture of methyl ether. All the ethers are formed by
taking two of the paraffin radicles and linking them together by means
of the two hooks of an oxygen atom. The ether which is so largely used
in hospitals for wounded soldiers is _ethyl_ ether, consisting of two
ethyl radicles joined by oxygen. How it is made we will come to in a
moment, but as you see already it is a close relative of alcohol.

Now from methyl ether take away the central oxygen and in its place put
carbon. This atom will have two hooks to spare which it can employ to
hold on to the two hooks of the oxygen. The result is a molecule of
acetone.

This is used as a solvent in a similar manner to alcohol for many
purposes, and there was a great demand for it no doubt during the war.

One interesting use of acetone is in connection with the gas acetylene.
Of great use both for lighting and also in conjunction with oxygen for
welding and cutting metals, this gas suffers from the disadvantage that
it cannot be compressed into cylinders and carried about as oxygen can.
It can, however, be dissolved in acetone. The cylinders in which it is
carried are therefore filled with coke saturated with acetone and then
when the acetylene is pressed in it dissolves, coming out of solution
again as soon as the pressure is released. In this dissolved condition
it is quite safe to carry about.

For a moment let us turn back to the commencement of the chapter to the
subject of methane. When mixed with chlorine, it will be remembered,
one hydrogen atom gave place to a chlorine atom. If the process be
repeated another hydrogen atom will be displaced in the same way, while
a further repetition will result in the removal of a third, when there
will be a carbon atom in the centre with three chlorine and one hydrogen
hooked on to it. With that picture in your mind's eye you will be
contemplating the molecule of that wonderful and beneficent substance,
chloroform. When we think of the numberless operations which have been
carried out by the surgeons in the course of this last war we realize a
little how great is the total sum of pain and suffering which has been
saved through the agency of this substance, this simple neat little
arrangement of five tiny atoms.

Now that again is obtained in manufacture from alcohol. Alcohol,
bleaching powder and water are mixed and then distilled, by which of
course is meant that the mixture is evaporated by heat and the vapour
collected and cooled back into liquid again. The liquid so obtained is
chloroform.

Hardly less important than this, in our military hospitals, is ether, to
which reference has already been made. It, too, is manufactured from
alcohol. The alcohol, together with sulphuric acid, is placed in a still
and heated, the vapour given off being led to another vessel and there
condensed. The liquid thus obtained is ether and so long as the supply
of fresh alcohol is kept up the production of ether goes on
continuously.

The sulphuric acid does not disappear and so does not need to be
replaced, from which it would appear as if it might just as well not be
there, but that is not the case. It plays the part of what is called a
"catalyst," one of the curiosities of chemistry. There are many
instances in which two things will combine only in the presence of a
third which appears to be itself unaffected. This third substance is a
catalyst. It reminds one of the clergyman at a wedding who unites others
but remains unchanged himself.

In conclusion, one may mention that many of the medicines with which our
injured men were coaxed back to health and strength owe their existence
to alcohol, for many drugs are obtained from vegetable substances by
dissolving out a part of the herb with alcohol.

Thus, as a drink, it is unquestionably very harmful. Indeed, in that way
it probably kills more people per year than its use in the manufacture
of explosives caused in the worst year of the war. Yet it also furnishes
chloroform, ether and medicinal drugs and performs a whole host of
useful services to mankind. Finally, if oil and coal should ever run
short it is quite prepared to run our engines for us. Truly it is a
wonderful substance.



CHAPTER V

MINES, SUBMARINE AND SUBTERRANEAN


The word mine in its military sense originally meant just the same as it
does in the ordinary way, but like many other words it has got twisted
into new uses the connection of which with the original meaning is very
obscure. One of the most striking of these verbal puzzles is the
submarine _mine_. There seems at first sight not the remotest connection
between the floating barrel of explosives concealed beneath the water
and what we ordinarily call a mine. The explanation of this is that the
term has acquired this meaning after passing through a series of stages.

When soldiers "mine" for the purpose of blowing up their enemies they
dig a hole in the ground, and conceal therein a quantity of explosives
so arranged that they blow up when the enemy pass over or near. The
operation of digging the hole in the earth is clearly akin to the work
of the miner and so such is quite appropriately called a "mine."

The hole may be dug from the surface downwards, the marks of excavation
being afterwards covered up and obliterated as much as possible. In
other cases the hole may be a tunnel starting from a trench and driving
towards the enemy's position. The idea, of course, is to burrow until
the end of the tunnel is just under some important part of the enemy's
works or fortifications. When the end of the tunnel has reached the
right spot explosives can be placed there, the tunnel partly stopped to
prevent the explosion from driving back upon those who make it and the
whole fired at the desired moment.

This tunnelling is also called "sapping" and the tunnel itself a sap.
Military engineers are often spoken of as "sappers and miners" as if the
two things were clearly different, but as a matter of fact both are
often used to describe the same thing. Roughly, we may say that a mine
which stays still in the hope that the enemy will walk upon it is a mine
proper, while a mine which itself progresses towards the enemy until it
ultimately goes off beneath him, is a "sap" and the making of such a
thing is "sapping." Or we might say that sapping is under-mining, in
which sense we use it in general conversation when we speak of something
sapping a man's strength. Soldiers speak of their engineering comrades
as "sappers" just as they term artillerymen "gunners," but the only
reason why they call them by that name instead of miners is because the
latter is a well-known term applied to those who work in coal mines.

A subterranean mine, then, is nothing more or less than a hole in the
ground, made in any way that may be convenient, filled with explosives
and fired at a suitable time to do damage to the enemy.

In other words, it is simply some explosive _concealed in the ground_
with means for firing it, and when the sailor _conceals explosives in
the sea_ so that they may blow up the enemy's ships, he borrows his
military comrades' term and calls it a "mine" too.

Counter-mining is the enemy's reply to mining. Suppose I was foolish
enough to wish to blow up my neighbour who lives in the house opposite
to mine. I might start from my cellar and dig a tunnel under the road
until I knew that I had arrived under his dwelling. But suppose that he
got to know of my little scheme: he could then try counter-mining. In
this case it would mean starting a tunnel of his own from his cellar
towards my tunnel: then, as soon as the two tunnels had come
sufficiently near to each other, he could let off his explosives thereby
wrecking my tunnel and putting an end to my operations while yet I was
only half-way across the road. Thus he would stop me before I had had
time to harm him, and since he need only tunnel just far enough to
render the necessary explosion harmless to his house, while I to succeed
would have to tunnel right across the road, the man who is
counter-mining always has a slight natural advantage over the man who is
doing the mining. If only he gets to know what is going on in time he
can always retaliate.

All forms of land mine are improvised on the spot according to
circumstances. Not so, however, with submarine mines on which much
ingenuity has been expended, the mines being made in workshops ashore
ready for laying and then laid by ships and sometimes by divers.

Of these there are two main kinds, those which are put in place in times
of peace for the protection of particular harbours and channels, and
those which are simply dropped overboard from a mine-laying ship during
the actual war.

They all consist essentially of a case of iron or steel plates riveted
together just as a steam boiler is made, in fact the cases are made in a
boiler shop. The charge is gun-cotton fired by a detonator, the latter
being excited by a stroke from a hammer, as in a rifle, or else by
electricity. In the latter case, a tiny filament of platinum wire is in
contact with the detonator, and the wire being heated by the current,
just as the filament of a lamp is, the detonator is fired by the heat.

Of the permanent mines whereby the entrances to important channels are
protected arrangements are often made for firing by observation, that is
to say, by the action of an observer ashore. Being laid by divers and
securely anchored to heavy weights laying on the bottom, wires are
carried from the mines to the observation station. The observer watches
and fires the mines at the right moment by simply pressing a key thereby
making the electrical circuit.

More often, however, mines are fired by contact. Observation mines have
the advantage that while they may be exploded under an enemy they will
allow a friendly ship to pass in perfect safety. Contact mines, on the
other hand, will afford protection against attacks by night when enemy
craft may attempt to creep in under cover of darkness.

[Illustration: AN ITALIAN MINE-LAYER.

This photograph was taken looking down upon the deck of the ship. The
mines run upon rails, and are pushed by the men towards the stern,
whence they are dropped one at a time into the water. The splash
indicates that one has just fallen.]

Contact mines are often fired electrically, sometimes by batteries of
their own inside their own cases, or else by current from the shore
through wires, the circuit being completed by an automatic device of
some sort actuated unwittingly by the unfortunate victim.

One of these contact devices will illustrate the general character of
them all. Imagine a little vessel with mercury in it: it is, generally
speaking, of some insulating material, but right at the bottom is a
metal stud with which the mercury makes contact. The rim may likewise be
of metal or a metal rod may project downwards into it: it matters not
which, for we can see at once that it is quite easy so to arrange things
that whereas, while upright, the mercury shall be well clear of the
upper contact, it shall when the vessel is tilted flow on to it, thereby
bridging from lower contact to upper contact and completing the circuit.

Of course, a mine must only go off when actually struck by a ship and
not when it is gently swung to and fro by the action of tide or current
in the water. That is easily arranged, for the vessel and contacts can
be so shaped that contact is not made until an angle of tilt is reached
which no tide or ordinary commotion of the water could bring about.

It is clearly possible, too, to combine the contact and observation
arrangements in such a way that contact mines can be made safe for
friendly ships during the daytime. It is only necessary to adopt the
shore battery arrangement already mentioned and disconnect the batteries
during the day or when no enemy is in sight, restoring the connection
during the darkness or in the event of hostile ships trying to rush the
passage.

Another interesting scheme for keeping mines safe until required is to
anchor them in what is termed a "dormant" condition. This means that a
loop is taken in the wire rope by which they are anchored, the loop
being fastened by means of a link. This link, however, contains a small
quantity of explosive which can be fired from the shore. This has the
effect of breaking the link, releasing the loop and allowing the mine to
float upwards to the full length of the rope. Thus the mine is down
deep, well below the bottom of the biggest ship until released for
action.

It is doubtful whether much use is made nowadays of permanent mines of
the types just described, for they have, no doubt, been largely
displaced by the temporary mine which can be laid in a moment by simply
being dropping overboard from a ship, but it is quite possible that some
of the defences of, say, the Dardanelles, were of the permanent nature.

So let us pass on to the temporary mines. These were used by the Germans
from the first few hours of the war. One of the first naval incidents
was when our ships discovered a small German excursion steamer which had
been converted into a mine-layer strewing these deadly things
surreptitiously in the North Sea in the hope that some of our vessels
would run upon them. Needless to say, that ship went on no more excursions.

Laid thus, it is evident that there can be no wires running ashore, so
that all mines of this class must be contact mines. What makes them of
extreme interest is the way they are laid. Just think for a moment what
is involved. From the very nature of things their laying must often be
done in secret. It is not the British practice to place them in the open
seas, except avowedly, after due notice, in certain specified areas,
where they are laid quite openly under the protection of adequate forces
to ensure against interruption. There is little doubt, however, that
they have laid many a mine field secretly in purely German waters, while
everyone knows that the Germans have not hesitated to sow the shipping
routes broadcast with these things, such work of course being done
secretly and largely at night.

The mine can therefore only be laid by dropping it into the water and
leaving it. Yet it must not float on the surface or it will be easily
seen and picked up; it must float below, so that the unsuspecting ship
may run upon it. And it is quite impossible to make a thing float in
water anywhere except upon the surface. If it does not float upon the
surface it sinks to the bottom: there is no "half-way house" between.
Many people are surprised to hear this, judging, no doubt, by the fact
that a balloon floats _in_, and not on, the air and expecting an object
floating in water to be able to do the same thing. The difference is due
to the fact that air is easily compressible, so that the air close to
the earth is denser, more compressed, and therefore heavier, than the
air higher up owing to its having the whole weight of the upper air
pressing downwards upon it. The density of the air diminishes, for this
reason, as one ascends, and a balloon which displaces more than its own
weight of air at the surface of the earth rises until it has reached
just that height when the air displaced exactly equals in weight the
balloon itself: then it goes no higher.

Precisely the same conditions exist in the sea except that water being
incompressible is no denser at the bottom of the sea than on the
surface. Therefore, if a thing sinks at all it sinks right to the
bottom.

There is one very ingenious device for overcoming this difficulty by
means of a motor and propeller. The mine has enclosed in its case a
motor driven by a store of compressed air which operates a propeller. In
this it is somewhat like a torpedo, but in this case the propeller is
set vertically so that its action lifts the mine up in the water. Now
the mine is so weighted that it just and only just sinks when dropped
in, but on reaching a certain depth the motor starts and by means of the
propeller raises it nearly to the surface again. On nearing the surface
the motor stops and the mine sinks once more, only to be raised again in
due course, so that the thing keeps on rising and falling; it never
rises above a certain depth nor falls below a certain depth, but
oscillates continually between its two limits.

The question then arises, what starts and stops the motor at precisely
the right moments to produce this result? It is done by means of a
hydrostatic valve. As just pointed out, the water at the bottom of the
sea is supporting the weight of all that water which is above it. The
water is not compressed by this, but the pressure is there all the same.
Obviously the degree of pressure at any point depends upon the weight of
the layer of water above, and since the weight of that layer will
obviously increase and diminish with its thickness it follows that,
starting from the surface, where the pressure is nil, we get a perfectly
steady and regular increase as we descend, until we reach the maximum at
the bottom. Now within the mine is a small watertight diaphragm, the
outer surface of which is in contact with the water and upon which,
therefore, the water presses. As the mine descends, therefore, this
diaphragm is bent inwards more and more by the pressure of water and
that is made to start the motor. Adjustments can easily be made so that
a certain degree of bending shall result in starting the motor, which is
the same as saying that the motor shall start automatically at a certain
depth. Likewise as the mine rises under the influence of the propeller
the pressure decreases, the diaphragm straightens out and at a certain
predetermined depth the motor is stopped.

When, finally, the store of motive power is exhausted the mine sinks to
the bottom and is lost, a very valuable feature from a humanitarian
point of view, since it means that the active life of the mine is short
and it cannot go straying about the oceans for weeks or even months,
finally blowing up some quite innocent passenger ship.

More often, however, this difficulty of depth is overcome by anchoring
the mine at the depth most suitable for striking the bottom of a passing
ship. But here again there seem to be insuperable difficulties, for the
depth of the sea varies and so the length of the anchor rope must be
varied with almost every mine that is laid. It has been found possible,
however, to make the mines automatically adjust the length of their own
anchor ropes so that the desired result is attained without difficulty
no matter how deep the sea may be. Let me describe how it is done in the
Elia mines used by Great Britain. The inventor, Captain Elia, was an
officer in the Italian Navy.

The mine consists of three parts: (1) the mine proper, a case containing
the explosive, gun-cotton and the firing mechanism; (2) the anchor; and
(3) the weight, all of which are connected together by suitable wire
ropes.

The mine is lighter than water and so floats: the anchor, which bears no
resemblance to the ordinary anchor but which is an iron case containing
mechanism, only able to act as an anchor by virtue of its weight, is
heavier than water and so sinks, while the weight of solid cast iron
sinks more readily still.

The anchor is often fitted with wheels so that it forms a truck upon
which the mine and the weight are placed, the whole running upon rails
laid on the deck of the mine-layer. As this ship steams ahead the men
push the mines along the rails, dropping them over the stern at regular
intervals.

When the thing reaches the water, the weight sinks the most rapidly,
thereby tugging at the chain whereby it is connected to the anchor. The
latter, being less compact, sinks more slowly so that the pull upon the
rope is maintained until at last the weight rests upon the bottom. _Then
and only then is the pull relaxed._ Now inside the anchor is a winch,
upon which is wound a length of flexible wire rope, the other end of
which is attached to the mine. The latter, it will be remembered, is
light enough to float and so, since it lies upon the surface while the
anchor sinks, the rope is drawn off the winch. But there is a spring
catch which is able to hold the winch and to prevent it from paying out
rope, and that catch is only held off by the pull of the weight.
Consequently, as soon as the weight touches the bottom and its pull upon
the anchor ceases, the winch is gripped by the catch, no more rope is
paid out, and from that moment, as the anchor descends, it drags the
mine down with it.

The result, then, is that the mine becomes anchored at a depth below the
surface roughly equal to the length of the rope connecting weight to
anchor.

Mines of this kind can, of course, be fired electrically by the tilting
of a cup of mercury or similar device as already described. Another
arrangement is to fit projecting horns upon the surface of the mine made
of soft metal so that they will be bent or crushed by a strong blow such
as a passing ship would give. This breaks a glass vessel inside,
liberating chemicals which cause detonation.

The method adopted in the Elia mines is to have a projecting arm pivoted
upon the top of the mine. The mine is spherical (they are nearly all
either spherical or cylindrical), with the rope attached to the South
Pole, so to speak, and the arm pivoted to the North Pole. As the mine
floats in the water the arm projects out horizontally. The effect of
this arrangement is that when a ship strikes the mine the latter rolls
along its side, but the arm being too long, simply trails along. Thus
the spherical case of the mine turns while the arm remains still and
that is made to unscrew and eventually release a hammer which, striking
the detonator, fires the mine.

In other words, this type of mine is exploded not by the ship giving it
a blow, but by its rubbing itself along in contact with the mine. The
great advantage of this is that it is only a ship that can do this. No
chance commotion in the water can do it: no chance blow from floating
wreckage can do it: only the rubbing action of a ship can accomplish it.
Such a mine, too, is less likely to be affected by counter-mining, of
which more presently.

Apparently the laying of these mines must be very dangerous work, for
since a blow will explode most of them, what is to prevent their
receiving that blow while on the deck of the mine-layer, or at all
events as they are dropped into the water.

In all cases, precautions are taken against such an event. Sometimes a
hydrostatic valve is employed, the arrangement being that the firing
mechanism is locked until released by the valve, until, that is, the
mine is immersed to a predetermined depth in the water.

Another device for the same purpose is a lump of sugar. The mine is so
made that it cannot be fired until this lump has been melted by the
action of the water: sal ammoniac is another substance employed for the
same purpose. The technical term for this is a "soluble seal." The
firing arrangement, whatever it may be, is sealed up so that it cannot
come into operation until the seal has been dissolved away by the water,
or until the mine has been in the water long enough for the mine-layer
to get out of harm's way.

Another interesting feature of the Elia mine is connected with the
source of the power which drives the hammer which causes the explosion.
The anchor, it will be remembered, pulls the mine down under water, the
latter being of itself buoyant. There is a continual pull, therefore,
upon the rope by which the mine is held under. It is that pull which
works the hammer.

And now observe the beautiful result of that simple arrangement. Suppose
the mine breaks its rope and gets loose, so that it can drift about and
carry danger far and wide. It can break loose and it can drift about,
but at the very moment of getting loose the danger vanishes, for the
rope ceases to pull and the firing mechanism loses its motive power.

In other mines the same result has been sought by means of clockwork,
which throws the firing arrangements out of action after the lapse of a
given time. This scheme of Captain Elia's, however, whereby the very act
of breaking adrift produces its own safeguard, is one of the most
delightful instances of a happy invention.

In conclusion, just a word about the measures taken against mines.
Counter-mining is one. It consists in letting off other mines in the
midst of a mine-field with the purpose of giving them such a shaking up
that some of them will be exploded by the shock.

The simplest and indeed the only effective way, however, seems to be the
simple primitive method of dragging a rope along between two light
draught vessels and thus tearing the mines up by their roots, so to
speak. The very act of thus dragging it along by its anchor rope often
causes a mine to explode, well astern of the mine-sweeping vessels, but
sometimes they are pulled up and fired or sunk by a shot from a gun
which the sweeper carries for the purpose.

The sweeping up of the mine-fields is a duty often allotted to the steam
fishing boats or trawlers, whose crews seem particularly well fitted for
the work. It is a hazardous duty, and many lives have been lost through
it. Let us hope that in time to come all submarine mines and the dangers
connected with them will be a thing of the past, for they are mean,
cowardly and contemptible weapons.



CHAPTER VI

MILITARY BRIDGES


Bridging has always been an important part of actual warfare. In my
school days I studied "Cæsar" from a textbook which is not much in use
nowadays and which had very copious notes, prominent among which was a
description, with drawings, of a bridge made by the Roman Legions in
Gaul. And a fine bridge it was, too. How its details came to be known
was partly through the description given by Cæsar himself and partly by
a study of certain old timbers found in the bed of the Rhone, which
timbers were believed to be relics of the very bridge which the great
Julius himself had had built.

This bridge of nearly two thousand years ago appeared to be built of
baulks of timber fastened together in very much the same manner as that
adopted by the engineering units of the great armies of to-day.

Every observant person has noticed how tall poles and short sticks tied
together with ropes can be fashioned into the firm, strong scaffolding
from which workmen can in safety raise great tall buildings. That mode
of construction can always be used to form a bridge.

Equally well known, no doubt, are the gantries built over the footway
while a large building is in course of construction. Generally of huge
square baulks of timber, they are intended to carry very heavy loads of
materials and to save the public passing beneath from any possibility of
damage through heavy objects falling from above. Those gantries furnish
us with an example of another sort of construction in wood which can be
and is often used in bridging.

When the Germans retired in Northern France they blew up all bridges
behind them, and before the Allies could use those bridges they had to
repair them. If only for foot-traffic, a contrivance of poles, lashed
together after the manner of the builder's scaffold, is ample in most of
such cases and by its means a strong and safe bridge can be made upon
what is left of the old bridge in the course of a few hours. For light
vehicles a similar structure but made stronger by more lashings and of
poles closer together will suffice, but for heavy traffic, with guns and
possibly railway trains, recourse has to be had to the heavy timberwork
exemplified by the builder's gantry. This takes longer to make, since
the timbers are big, heavy and not easy to move about: they are,
moreover, not simply laid beside or across each other and tied, but are
cut the right lengths, and one is notched where the end of another fits
into or against it. The baulks are connected by bolts and nuts for which
holes have to be drilled or by rods of iron with a sharply pointed prong
on each end stretching across from one baulk to another, one prong being
driven into each.

With the long-thought-out military operations of modern warfare it is
just possible that steelwork for repairing certain particular bridges
might be prepared in advance and simply launched across when the time
arrives, but that is manifestly impossible except in certain cases and
under particularly favourable conditions, such as railway facilities for
bringing up the new bridge close to the site where it is to go.

Nearly every military bridge therefore has to be more or less improvised
on the spot. In a highly developed country scaffold poles or baulks may
be found or brought up by road or rail, in less civilised lands their
equivalents may be cut and prepared from neighbouring forests, but all
armies have, as a recognised part of their organisation, certain
engineering "field companies," and "bridging trains," which carry with
them large quantities of material carefully schemed out long in advance,
so shaped and so prepared that it can be fashioned into almost anything,
much as the strips of a boy's "meccano" can be adapted to form a great
variety of objects.

First, there are pontoons, large though light boats or punts, about 20
feet long, constructed of thin wood with canvas cemented all over to
give additional strength and water-tightness. Each pontoon rides upon
its own carriage upon which there are also stowed away quantities of
timbers of various sorts, anchors for holding the pontoons in place,
oars for rowing them, ropes of different kinds, and so on.

Each pontoon, moreover, is divided about the middle into two pieces
called respectively the bow piece and the stern piece. The two are
normally coupled together by cunningly devised fastenings but they can
be quickly separated, in which state they form two shorter boats.

Other carriages carry more timber and material intended for the purpose
of forming "trestle bridges" but which is also usable in connection with
the pontoons.

Of this material the chief sorts are "legs," long straight pieces which
form the uprights; transomes, heavier beams which can be fitted across
horizontally between two legs so that the three form a huge letter H or
a very robust Rugby goal; "baulks" which are light timbers tapered off
towards each end for the sake of lightness and of such size that they
fit snugly into notches which are cut in the upper surface of the
transomes; and planks called "chesses" for forming the floors of a
bridge.

Probably the most dramatic incident of the war was when the British,
having been apparently beaten by the Turks in Mesopotamia, driven far
back and their General and many troops captured, suddenly turned the
tables upon their enemies, driving them from Kut and sending them
fleeing helter-skelter to Bagdad and then beyond. Now the capture of Kut
and then of Bagdad were both made possible by the rapid bridging of the
Tigris, and without doubt this is the sort of material which was used.
Let us see how it is done.

An army arrives at a river across which it is decided to throw a pontoon
bridge. The pontoons are unloaded off their wagons and launched into
the water. One is rowed out and anchored a little way from the shore,
while upon the bank parallel with the river is laid a "transome." On the
centre of the pontoon is a centre beam with notches in it like those in
the transomes and from the one to the other "baulks" are passed.
Meanwhile a second pontoon has been rowed into place and more baulks are
passed from the first pontoon to the second, while chesses are laid upon
the baulks to form a platform or floor.

Thus, pontoon by pontoon, the bridge grows until it has reached the
further bank.

If pontoons are scarce and the loads to be carried by the bridge are
light they are divided in two, and instead of a row of pontoons joined
by "baulks" there is a row of "pieces" joined by baulks. Pieces arranged
thus form a light bridge, pontoons a medium bridge, while pontoons
placed closer together form a heavy bridge. Which shall be built depends
upon the number of pontoons available in relation to the width of the
river and the nature of the traffic which will have to pass over.

An alternative arrangement is to make the pontoons up first into groups
or rafts and then bridge from raft to raft instead of bridging between
pontoons.

There is still another way of making the bridge, and that is to put it
together alongside the bank, afterwards swinging it across the river
like the opening or shutting of a door. Anyone can see that there must
be many advantages in this latter method when it is practicable, since
more men can work at once and with greater safety, for all will be near
the bank.

It is evident that such a structure depends for its security entirely
upon the anchors. Those which are carried for the purpose are like those
of a ship but there may not be enough or they may not suit every kind of
river-bed. They are often improvised therefore. Two wagon wheels lashed
together, with heavy stones clipped between them, are said to be a very
effective anchor. Under certain conditions a net filled with stones is
surprisingly effective. Two pickaxes tied together form a good imitation
of the conventional anchor, as also does a harrow sunk and held down by
stones thrown upon it.

Trestle bridges are made in quite a different way. The trestles are
formed of two legs or uprights with a transome between, a shape which
resembles, as has been already remarked, a very robust Rugby goal. The
transome is connected to the legs by a special form of band which
permits it to be fixed at any height without having to drill any special
holes for the connections. The legs are so shaped at their ends that
they can be shod with steel shoes provided for the purpose, enabling
them to get a good foothold even on shifty soil. The trestles are put
together ashore, and each is taken out in a boat or on a pontoon to the
place where it is to stand. Then it is launched feet foremost into the
water, the boat being on the side away from the shore, so that a rope
from the trestle to the shore will enable men on land to pull the
trestle into an upright position.

[Illustration: AN INCIDENT AT LOOS.

This picture gives us some little idea of the devastation caused by
modern weapons. It also shows the inventiveness of the soldier who makes
his rifle into a battering-ram. Incidentally we see a kind-hearted
soldier rescuing a little girl from danger. This incident really
happened.]

Thus trestle after trestle is added until the bridge has grown right
across the water to the further bank. The trestles cannot fall over
sideways because of their own width, they cannot fall forwards or
backwards because of the "baulks" which pass between them and carry the
floor, but as a precaution diagonal ties of rope are always added here
and there along the bridge, that is to say, two trestles are tied
together with two ropes, each rope passing from the bottom of one
trestle to the top of the other, a form of tying which is very effective
and very easy and simple to carry out.

One interesting thing to notice is the form of the "baulks," in which
connection I would like to remark that when I use the word without
inverted commas I mean it in the ordinary sense as implying a big heavy
timber, but when I use the commas I mean it in its technical sense as it
is used in military engineering. In this latter sense it describes the
timbers specially provided for the purposes just described. Large
supplies of the ordinary heavy baulks could not be carried with an army:
but strength is required nevertheless. Hence the military engineers have
invented a form which combines strength with lightness.

If you stand a plank upon its edge, supported at each end so as to form
a beam, its strength will vary as its width and as the _square of its
height_. If then you double its width you only double its strength, but
if you double its height you multiply its strength _four_ times. If you
halve the width of a given beam you halve its strength, but if you then
double its height you quadruple that half, in other words, without
making the beam any heavier by these two operations you double its
strength. Moreover, if you support a beam at each end and pass a load
over it or spread a load permanently upon it, its greatest strength is
required in the middle. You can shave away the ends without making the
beam as a whole any less strong. So these "baulks" are made like planks,
very oblong if looked at endwise, also thinner at the ends than in the
middle. But if by chance they tipped over on to their sides they would
for that very reason be very weak, and that is why the notches are
provided in the transomes and the centre beams of the pontoons, in order
that the "baulks," having been laid edgewise in them, cannot tip over.
Thus a considerable saving is made in the weight of the bridging
material to be carried.

It sometimes happens that when a trestle is dropped into the water one
leg will fall into a depression in the river-bed or will sink more
deeply if the bed be soft, leaving the whole structure lop-sided and
useless. That, however, is easily overcome, since it is provided
against. A little iron bracket, which is carried for the purpose, is
clipped on to the leg which has sunk near its top and on to it is hung a
pair of pulley blocks--one of those little contrivances which everyone
has seen at some time or another by which one man pulling a chain
quickly can raise, although slowly, a heavy load. By this means the end
of the transome is raised until it is horizontal and the legs have
assumed an upright posture, when the transome is refastened to the leg
in its new position. Thus we see the advantage of clamping the transome
to the leg rather than fixing it with any arrangement of holes. The iron
band, which is fastened on to the transome and which grasps the leg, is
so arranged that the greater the load the more tightly does it hold, so
that it is perfectly safe under all conditions.

The trestle bridge has a great advantage over the floating bridge if the
height of the water varies at all, as for instance, with the tide. The
former remains still, while the latter goes up and down, requiring a
special arrangement to be contrived for connecting it to the shore.

Under some conditions a suspension bridge is the most convenient form of
all, particularly if the banks are high and strong, or if the current be
very rapid or the river-bed very soft. In such cases steel wire ropes
are stretched across the water between two trestles. The latter may be
made in the way just described, but more often they have to be stronger
and are built specially out of big strong timbers securely fastened
together. Their form does not matter much so long as they are strong and
stiff, high enough to carry the ends of the suspension ropes and of such
a shape as not to block the entrance to the bridge itself. The higher
they are the better, because, according to the natural laws which govern
such things, the more sag or dip there is in the ropes across the river
the less severely will they be strained. They need to be very strong, as
the whole weight of the bridge and its load falls upon their shoulders.
The pull of the suspension ropes, moreover, tends to pull them forward
into the water, so they must be held back by other strong ropes called
guys, and the action of these two sets of ropes entails the unfortunate
trestles bearing really _more_ weight than the actual weight of the
bridge and load. The guys, too, require very strong anchorage or at the
critical moment they may give way, when the whole contrivance, with
possibly valuable guns or ammunition on board, will be precipitated into
the water. The men may be able to swim but the guns will sink.

Having, then, constructed a trestle upon each bank, securely guyed it
back and connected the suspension ropes to it, the next operation is to
attach smaller vertical ropes to the suspension ropes at intervals, to
support the ends of the transomes. Then upon the latter are laid
"baulks" and upon them the flooring as usual. Or if ropes be not
sufficiently plentiful, timbers may be lashed on to the suspension ropes
instead, the transomes being fastened to them.

That is all that is absolutely essential to a suspension bridge, but one
so formed would be rather flimsy and unstable. It needs to be stiffened
by diagonal timbers at suitable places and often it has props placed
upon the bank reaching out as far as their length will permit over the
water to steady and consolidate what to commence with is rather too much
like a spider's web. Those little strengthening dodges can be laid down
in no books. They need to be left to the judgment of the men in charge
to do what is necessary in the best way they can with the materials
which happen to be at hand.

But very often warfare has to be carried on in the most outlandish
places where armies can only travel light, and where, hampered by
bridging material of the conventional sort, they would have no chance
in catching up with a fleet and agile native enemy. Yet bridges are
needed even more under those conditions perhaps than under any other.
There are many examples of this in the wars just beyond the frontier in
Northern India. Then ingenuity has to make good the luck of prepared
material and the bridges are made of those materials which happen to be
procurable.

An army in India once wanted to cross a river, where no materials of the
ordinary kind were available. The river, however, was lined with tall
reeds. A reed has for centuries been a favourite example of weakness and
untrustworthiness, so how can reeds be made to form a safe bridge? This
is how it was done.

Great quantities of reeds were cut and were made up into neat round
bundles about a foot in diameter. Ropes were scarce too, but these
likewise were improvised by twisting long grasses into ropes. It is
surprising what good ones can be made in this way, and they served their
purpose well. Many bundles having thus been made numbers of them were
tied together so as to form rafts. Each bundle in fact was a small
pontoon, and the rafts which were thus constituted differed only in size
from the regulation rafts made of pontoons.

While this work was being done two ropes were got across the river and
secured on both banks: then rafts were floated down in succession, each
one on arrival being tied up under the two ropes. Finally a track of
boards was laid over the centre and the bridge was strong enough for
men in fours to walk over it.

Had it been necessary, the floor could have been made of brushwood,
interlaced so as to form a kind of continuous matting or of a layer of
branches covered with canvas. Floors for bridges can be made in many
ways.

A dodge which soldiers in the British Army are taught is how to make
boats for bridging purposes out of a tarpaulin or piece of canvas,
supported on a framework of light wood poles or twigs. The outline of
the boat is first drawn roughly on the ground. Then three posts are
driven in on the centre line of the boat and to the top of these three a
horizontal pole is tied, thin, flexible branches stripped of their bark,
being fixed by having their ends stuck in the ground on either side. The
ends are driven in on the outline already marked out so that when done
the branches form a framework like the ribs of a boat upside down. Other
branches are intertwined among these so as to bind them together and
finally a tarpaulin or canvas sheet is laid over all. A number of boats
formed after this fashion can be used as pontoons to support a bridge,
or several can be made into a raft and towed to and fro--a sort of
floating bridge.

Another scheme is to make a number of crates like those in which
crockery and other things are often packed. These are of very simple and
easy construction, consisting of sticks slightly pointed at the ends
driven into other pieces which are perforated with suitable holes to
receive the ends. The only tools necessary are an axe (or even a
pocket-knife will do) to sharpen the ends and an auger to make the
holes. Almost any sort of wood can be made to serve. The cover for this,
and indeed for most of these improvised rafts, is tarpaulin or canvas,
the latter of which, being the material used for so many purposes, is
almost sure to be available in some form or other.

For instance, every one of those familiar "General Service Wagons" has
its large canvas cover. In fact, a general service wagon, taken off its
wheels and wrapped up in its own canvas cover, makes quite a serviceable
boat, pontoon, punt, barge or whatever you like to call it.

Then there is an ingenious type of little bridge which can be quickly
and easily made where bamboos or similar light canes or sticks are
available. The only tool required in making this is a couple of poles
ten feet or so in length. To commence with, these poles are laid side by
side upon the bank with one end of each pointed out over the water,
overhanging it by about four feet. Two men then climb along these, while
others sit upon the inshore ends to keep them from tipping into the
water.

Seated, then, on the outer ends of the poles the men drive some bamboos
or whatever they are using into the water, after which they tie a
crosspiece to the uprights, so forming a light trestle. Then the poles
are pushed forward until they overhang another four feet beyond the
trestle just made, the other men, of course, continuing to sit upon the
rear ends. And so the bridge grows until it entirely crosses the
stream.

Between the trestles other light poles are laid and tied, forming the
floor upon which men can cross in single file.

Another type, known as the "hop pole" bridge is made of slightly heavier
poles which are tied together in threes so as to form isosceles
triangles. Each triangle forms one trestle.

The two poles which form the sides project a little above the apex so
that in fact we have an isosceles triangle with a V at the apex. To the
root of the V another pole is tied loosely and the whole trestle is
pushed feet first into the water. Then, by pushing the pole, it is
forced into an upright position in which it is secured by the pole being
firmly fixed to the shore and strongly lashed to the root of the V
where, before, it was only loosely tied. A second trestle is then in
like manner fixed in front of the first one, connected to it by a pole
just as the first is connected to the bank. And so the thing grows. To
all the upper ends of the V's a light pole is tied to form a handrail.
In this case, of course, the floor of the bridge is nothing more than a
pole, but with the assistance of a handrail it is quite easy to walk
along a single pole.

And that reminds me of a simple type of suspension bridge which, an
engineer officer once assured me, is actually copied from one habitually
made by some of the Indian natives. It consists of three ropes upon one
of which you walk, while the other two form a handrail upon either side.
The three ropes are held at intervals in their correct relative
positions by little wooden frames formed of three sticks tied together,
one rope being tied to each corner of each triangle.

On the banks stakes are driven in and tied back with cords to give
additional strength, and to them the ends of the ropes are secured. One
drawback to this form of bridge is that the ropes are naturally far from
level and one has to walk down a steep hill to commence with and up
again at the other end. I once saw a specimen of this kind of bridge
across a wide ditch, a part of the old defences of Chatham, and an
elderly gentleman who was with me, a man of considerable proportions,
insisted upon trying it for himself. He took but a step or two when his
foot began to slide downhill along the foot rope faster than he dare
move his hands along the hand ropes, with the result that he was very
soon in a very uncomfortable position. Thus he remained, to the
amusement of all his friends, until two stalwart Royal Engineers came to
his aid and "uprighted" him.

In crossing a swamp something in the nature of a bridge is sometimes
required. Canvas laid upon branches often makes a good road over what
would otherwise be impassable.

Rapidly moving detachments of cavalry are provided with what is called
"air-raft equipment," which enables them to get their light "Horse
Artillery" guns across rivers which would be impassable otherwise. It
consists of sixty bags like huge cylindrical footballs except that the
outer covering is canvas instead of leather. These are blown up partly
by the mouth and partly by pumps provided for the purpose until they
are just about as tight as a football should be. Then they are laid out
in rows of twelve, each row being fastened together by the bags being
tied to a pole running lengthwise of the row. Cords are attached to the
bags for the purpose. The five rows are then placed parallel and
connected together by two light planks called wheelways placed across
the rows and tied thereto.

This arrangement is capable of carrying light guns or ammunition wagons.
The men are expected to ride through the water, but if necessary
something can be laid upon the raft, between the wheelways, to form a
floor upon which men and even horses can ride.

As part of the equipment there is a small collapsible boat with oars and
by its means men first cross, carrying with them a line by which,
afterwards, the raft can be hauled to and fro.

Rafts can be made, too, of hay tightly tied up in waterproof
ground-sheets or tarpaulins or canvas. Indeed, given a little ingenuity
and the need to use it (for it is very true that necessity is the mother
of invention), it is surprising what a large variety of things can be
pressed into this service.

Of course, barrels can be made to form excellent pontoons, but there is
one clever little way of using them which is more than usually
interesting, and with that I must conclude this chapter which has
already exceeded its appointed limits.

Imagine two poles perhaps ten feet long, placed parallel. Between them,
at one end, a barrel is lashed: at the other end is a plank forming with
the poles a T. A man can then sit upon the barrel and paddle about, for
the poles and planks will steady the barrel just as the outriggers and
floats steady the narrow canoes or catamarans of which we read in books
of travel. For that reason a bridge formed of such is called a
"catamaran" bridge. Of course, if there are only a few barrels to be had
they can be fitted out like this and then combined into a raft. Or if
there are enough of them they can be anchored at intervals and poles or
planks laid from one to another so as to form a continuous bridge. Or a
single one may be used as a boat. I can almost fancy I see some of my
readers who have access to a pond rigging up an old barrel in this way,
just to see how it goes.



CHAPTER VII

WHAT GUNS ARE MADE OF


No longer ago than the days of the Crimea, the largest guns were made of
the cheapest and commonest kind of iron, that known as cast iron.

This material has the advantage of being cheap and easily worked, but is
comparatively weak and liable to crack, so that the guns of that time
were comparatively small compared with those of to-day; they could only
withstand a feeble explosion and their range was therefore limited. Had
the energetic explosives of the present time been employed in them they
would inevitably have burst, killing their gunners instead of the enemy.
Attempts were made to strengthen them with bands made of wrought iron, a
form of the metal which is tough and elastic and therefore better able
to withstand sudden shocks than the more brittle cast iron, but it was
not a real success.

At first sight one naturally wonders why the whole gun was not made of
the stronger wrought iron. The reason was that while cast iron can be
melted and poured in a liquid form into a mould, so as to produce the
shape of the gun, wrought iron will not melt. It will soften with heat,
in which condition it can be hammered into shape and, moreover, when in
a very soft state two pieces can be joined by simply forcing them
closely together, which operation is called welding.

With the machinery available now it would be possible to make a gun of
wrought iron, but even a few years ago it would have been quite
impossible. There was an obvious need therefore of a metal which could
be melted and cast in moulds like cast iron, yet tough and strong to
resist shock like wrought iron. Fortunately this problem excited the
interest of a certain Mr. Henry Bessemer, a gentleman who, having made a
considerable fortune through an ingenious method of manufacturing bronze
powder, had sufficient leisure and money to devote himself to its
solution.

The vast steel industries of Great Britain and the United States are the
direct results of this gentleman's labours, and in the latter country
there are quite a number of towns which, being the home of steelworks,
are called by his name.

Iron is one of the most plentiful things in the world. Deposits running
into millions of tons are to be found in many parts, but it is
practically always in the form of ore, that is to say, in combination
with something else generally oxygen and sometimes oxygen and carbon.
The former sort of ore is called oxide of iron and the latter carbonate
of iron, and both of them bear not the slightest resemblance to the
metal. They are just rocks which form part of the earth's crust, and it
is only the metallurgist who can tell what they consist of.

In order that the iron may be obtained from the ore it is necessary for
the oxygen to be separated from it, an operation which requires the
intervention of heat, and the heat must be obtained from a fuel which
consists mainly of carbon. Wood fulfils these requirements, but there is
not enough wood in the whole world to smelt all the iron which we need.
It was not until "pit-cole" displaced "char-cole" (to use the spelling
of the period) that the iron industry began to assume its present
importance.

To produce iron cheaply, therefore, ore and coal should for preference
lie side by side, and in some few favoured localities that state of
things exists. Generally speaking, however, the ore and the coal are not
found together, with the result that one has to be taken to the other,
and in practice it is usually the ore which is taken to the coal. Hence,
the iron and steelworks are generally to be found on the coalfields,
while the ore comes by rail or ship from, it may be, remote parts of the
world.

The method by which the metal is obtained from the ore is in principle
very simple. Coal and ore are mixed together in a furnace, the fire
being fanned by a powerful blast of air. The result is that the bonds
uniting iron and oxygen are relaxed by the heat, when the oxygen, having
a preference for union with carbon rather than with iron, leaves the
latter to join up with some of the carbon of the coal.

The furnace in which this operation is carried out is a tall, vertical
cylinder of iron, lined with firebrick. The fire is at the bottom and
the fresh fuel and ore are thrown in at the top. As the ore is
"reduced" (the chemist's term for removing oxygen from anything) the
liquid iron accumulates in the lowest part of the furnace, whence it is
drawn off at intervals, being allowed to run into grooves or gutters in
a bed of sand, where it solidifies into what is called "pig iron."

Along with the coal and ore, there is thrown into the furnace from time
to time quantities of limestone which combines with the earthy
impurities with which the ore is contaminated. Together these form what
is called "slag," which also exists, while in the furnace, as a liquid,
but is so much lighter than the molten iron that it keeps quite separate
and can periodically be drawn off through a hole higher up than that
through which the iron is obtained. The slag solidifies into a hard
stone which is broken up and used for making concrete and tar-paving,
also for road metal.

The kind of furnace just described is, owing to the strong blast of air
needed for its operation, called a "blast-furnace." One would be
inclined to think that a fire so well supplied with oxygen, both from
the blast and from the ore itself, would cause the fuel to be completely
burnt up, yet such is not the case. The gases which ascend from the fire
consist largely of "carbon-monoxide," a burnable gas with lots of heat
still left in it. Years ago, and one may still see instances of it, this
gas was allowed to escape at the top of the furnace, where it burnt in
the form of a huge flame. In most modern furnaces, however, there is a
kind of plug in the orifice at the top which, while it can be lowered in
order to admit the ore and fuel, normally prevents the escape of the
gases, which are led away through pipes. In some cases the gases are
burnt under boilers to provide the works with steam, in other cases they
heat other furnaces for metallurgical purposes, while in yet others they
are employed to drive large gas-engines to generate electricity. It is
sometimes a difficulty to find useful employment for the vast quantities
of this "blast-furnace gas" which are produced at a large works.

We see, then, how is obtained the pig iron from which the other kinds of
iron and steel are made. It is not pure iron by any means; indeed, it is
not sought to make iron pure, as is the case with most other metals,
since, in its pure state, it is too soft to be of much use. All the
familiar forms of iron and steel are really alloys of iron and carbon, a
fact which tends to give iron its unique position among the metals,
since by exceedingly slight variations in the percentage of carbon we
can vary the properties of the iron to an amazing extent, thereby
producing in effect a wide range of different substances each
particularly suitable for a particular purpose.

To make cast iron, such as the guns of the Crimea were made of, it is
only necessary to melt up some pig iron and to pour it into a mould.
There is scarcely a town in which there is not an iron foundry, either
large or small, and that is the work carried on there. A smaller form of
the blast-furnace, known as a "cupola," melts the pig iron, and the
moulds are generally made of sand. The process of pouring the melted
metal into the moulds is called "casting" and the things so produced are
"castings," and are said to be made of "cast" iron.

[Illustration: AN 18-POUNDER IN ACTION.

The crew consists of six men. No. 1 (the sergeant) gives instructions.
No. 2 stands at the right of the breech. No. 3 fires the gun. No. 4
holds the shell ready for placing in the bore. No. 5 adjusts the fuse
and hands the shell to No. 4. No. 6 prepares the ammunition and hands it
to No. 5. In this picture only three of the crew are left.]

Wrought iron is made by working the molten pig iron instead of casting
it. The work is done in a different type of furnace altogether from the
blast furnace and the cupola. It is more like an oven, in the floor of
which is a depression wherein the molten metal lies. The fire-place is
so arranged that the flames pass over the metal, being deflected
downwards upon it by the roof as they pass.

It should be understood that in casting pig iron one does little more
than form it into some desired shape, the nature of the metal undergoing
little or no change. In working it, however, into wrought iron, we
change its nature.

The pig iron contains from 2 to 5 per cent of carbon, which it obtains
from the coal in the blast-furnace, and it is this particular proportion
of carbon which gives it its own peculiar properties. To convert it into
wrought iron a workman puts a long iron rod into the furnace and stirs
the metal about, thereby exposing it to the air and permitting the
carbon to be burnt out. As it loses carbon the iron becomes less and
less fluid until it reaches a sticky stage. Thus the workman, who is
known by the name of puddler, as the process is called puddling, works
up a ball of decarbonized and therefore sticky iron upon the end of his
rod. Having thus produced a rough ball or lump he draws it out of the
furnace and leaves it to cool.

Thus the result of the puddling process is to produce a number of rough
lumps or balls of iron with only about one-tenth per cent of carbon.
They are next reheated, in another furnace, and a number of them are
hammered together under a mechanical hammer into larger lumps called
blooms or billets. The hammering process has the effect of driving out
impurities and also of improving the texture of the metal.

Iron sheets, bars, rods and so on are formed by heating the billets and
rolling them out in powerful rolling mills, machines which in principle
are precisely similar to the domestic mangle, wherein two iron rollers
with properly shaped grooves in them squeeze out the billet into the
desired form.

Wrought iron, owing to the method by which it is produced, is not
homogeneous, that is to say, it is nor quite the same all through, with
the result that when it is rolled it develops a grain somewhat similar
to the grain in wood, so that if bent across the grain it is somewhat
liable to crack. On the other hand, it has the advantage over steel that
it rusts much less readily. Hence, for outdoor purposes it is still
sometimes preferred to the otherwise more popular steel.

Now the problem which Bessemer set before himself was to find out how to
make a metal which could be cast like cast iron yet should be as strong
and tough as wrought iron. After a little experimenting, by a happy
inspiration, he hit upon the idea of blowing air through a mass of
molten pig iron, thereby burning out the carbon, just as is done in the
puddling process, only much quicker and with less labour. By this means
he produced a metal with less carbon than cast iron and more than
wrought iron, a sort of intermediate state between the two, and to his
joy he found that this "Bessemer steel" could be cast like cast iron yet
had strength and toughness equal to if not superior to that of wrought
iron. Moreover, it was homogeneous and when rolled did not possess the
troublesome grain characteristic of wrought iron.

Having thus found the way to make this new and desirable metal, Bessemer
encountered a great disappointment, so great that it would have entirely
beaten many men. He made samples of steel and submitted them to experts
in iron manufacture. Everyone thought them admirable and many large iron
works were induced by them to make arrangements with Bessemer for the
right to use his process. His name was already famous and it seemed as
if a new fortune was made, when, to his alarm, he learned that wherever
it was tried except in his own works, the process was a miserable
failure. Instead of being at the end of his labours he was just at the
beginning.

It turned out that the particular iron which he happened to buy and use
at his own works was particularly free from an impurity which is,
generally speaking, a great nuisance in iron, namely, phosphorus. It was
pure accident which had led him to use this iron: it happened to be the
kind he could purchase most easily in the small quantities needed for
his experiments but it led him into a great difficulty, for other
people, after paying him for the right to use his process and after
spending large sums on the requisite plant, found themselves unable to
make the steel because of the phosphorus in their iron and finding
themselves unable to make a success were inclined to write him down a
fraud. As it turned out, after much labour on Bessemer's part, it was
due to the presence of tiny percentages of phosphorus in most of the
iron that is produced.

After much trouble he was able to induce certain owners of
blast-furnaces to make, by special methods, a kind of pig iron
practically free from phosphorus and therefore suitable for his process.
This special pig iron was known as Bessemer Pig Iron.

A little later a new inventor, a Welshman, Thomas by name, overcame the
difficulty in another way, but to explain that I must first describe the
Bessemer Converter, the special apparatus designed by Bessemer for
making his steel.

It can best be likened to a huge iron kettle with a big spout at the top
and with two projecting pins, one on each side. These pins rest in
supports, so that it is easy to tilt the whole thing over on to its
side. This is lined with fire-clay or some suitable heat-resisting
material.

Through one of the "pins" (trunnions is their proper name) there runs a
hole, communicating to what we might call a grating in the bottom of the
converter. To this hollow trunnion there is connected the pipe from a
powerful blowing engine, so that air can be driven in at will.

To load or charge the converter it is tilted over somewhat to one side
so that molten pig iron can be poured into it. The blast is then turned
on after which it is raised to an upright position with the air
bubbling up from below through the iron. Thus by being brought into
close contact with air, the carbon is burnt out of the metal until none
is left. That, however, is not desired, so, as soon as the carbon is
known to have all gone, a fresh quantity of molten iron is added of a
special kind, the amount of carbon in which is known very exactly. Thus
all the carbon is first removed and then exactly the right amount is
added, and so the desired result is attained with certainty.

Now Thomas's improvement was this. He discovered that the converter
could be lined with certain substances which have a great attraction for
phosphorus and under those conditions any phosphorus which may be in the
ore goes readily from the iron into the lining, or forms, with material
from the lining, a slag which floats upon the surface of the metal.

When the process is completed the converter is tipped over once more and
the metal, now steel, is poured into rectangular moulds from which the
steel can be lifted after cooling in the form of ingots.

Steel produced by Bessemer's process as improved by Thomas is called
Basic Bessemer Steel.

Incidentally Thomas, by this invention, laid the foundation of much of
the steel industry of Germany and Belgium, for there are enormous
deposits of ore in the neighbourhood of Luxemburg which because of the
presence of phosphorus were useless until Thomas showed how it could be
dealt with.

And there is another interesting feature of this "basic" process.
Phosphorus is a valuable fertilizer, so that the "slag" makes a very
fine chemical manure. It is ground up into a fine powder and is sold to
farmers under the name of Thomas's Phosphate Powder. It owes its
fertilizing virtues to the presence of the phosphorus which it has
stolen from the molten iron.

Bessemer derived a huge fortune from his process after he had fought and
overcome his difficulties, in addition to which he received the honour
of knighthood and became Sir Henry Bessemer.

It will be noticed that one of the virtues of the process is its economy
in fuel. During the whole time that the metal is in the converter, from
twenty to thirty minutes, no fuel is used to keep it hot. The reason for
that is that the carbon which is being got rid of is acting as fuel. It
is burning with the air which is driven through, thereby generating
heat.

In Bessemer's early days, it was arranged that he should attend a
meeting of ironmasters at Birmingham to explain his new process. On the
morning of his lecture two eminent ironmasters were breakfasting
together in a Birmingham hotel when one exclaimed to the other, "What do
you think, there is a fellow coming here to-day to tell us how to make
steel without fuel." To this eminent South Wales ironmaster the proposal
seemed preposterous but it was true all the same.

Although vast quantities of steel are made by the Bessemer process there
is another one of equal importance known as the Siemens-Martin
Open-hearth process. In this the molten metal is kept in a huge bath
practically boiling until the carbon has been reduced to the required
amount. Perhaps the most interesting feature about it is the way in
which fuel is saved by what is called the "regenerative" method due to
that versatile genius Sir William Siemens.

The open-hearth, as it is termed, is a huge rectangular chamber of
firebrick with a firebrick roof, and doors along one side just under the
roof through which the process can be watched and new materials be added
from time to time.

The fire is some way away and not underneath as one might perhaps
expect. Now if a deep coke fire is fed with insufficient air it does not
give off carbonic acid such as usually arises from a fire, and which as
everyone knows will not burn, but a gas called carbon monoxide which
will burn very well. So the fire-place for these furnaces is constructed
in such a manner as to produce carbon monoxide, which then passes
through a huge flue to one end of the open-hearth. Here it meets air
coming through another flue and the two combining burst into flame over
the metal.

The hot gases resulting from this burning pass out through a flue at the
other end of the hearth to a tall chimney which causes the necessary
draught, but on their way they pass through a chamber loosely filled
with bricks. Consequently the hot gases only reach the open air after
having given up much of their heat to these bricks.

After that operation has been going on for a time certain valves are
operated and the gas and air then come in at the other end of the
hearth, travelling through it in the opposite direction. And the air
comes through the chamber which has the hot bricks in it, bringing back
into the furnace a large quantity of that heat which otherwise would
have gone up the chimney but which the bricks intercepted. Thus all day
long does this reversal take place at intervals, the fresh air all the
time picking up and bringing back some of the heat which just previously
had escaped towards but not into the chimney. This arrangement enables
the process to compete, so far as economy is concerned, with the
Bessemer process.

At intervals the steel is tapped off from the furnace and run into
ingot-moulds, the same as with the other process. On the whole it is
regarded as producing a slightly better steel, the operation being under
slightly better control.

However the steel is made the ingots are reheated and either hammered
under a powerful steam hammer or pressed in an enormous hydraulic press.
This greatly improves the quality.

The steel can then be rolled into plates, bars or whatever form may be
required.

The finer qualities of steel such as are used for making sharp tools are
made in quite another way. Instead of being made from crude iron by
taking out the carbon, the materials are the finest qualities of wrought
iron and charcoal which are mixed together in the correct quantities and
melted in a crucible. This cast steel is very hard, so that it will
carry a very fine, sharp edge. It is also capable of being tempered by
heating and cooling, so that the exact degrees of hardness and
toughness can be attained.

Of recent years a special quality of steel for tools called "high-speed"
steel has been produced, mainly by the addition to ordinary cast steel
of a small percentage of tungsten. The advantage of this is that, within
certain limits, this does not soften with heat, and it is, I can assure
you, a great invention in war-time, when a nation is straining every
nerve to turn out guns and shells as fast as possible.

For all these things need to be turned in lathes and if you have ever
watched a metal-turning lathe at work you will have noticed that the
tool which actually takes a shaving off the article being turned tends
to get hot. For this reason lathes are usually fitted with pumps which
pump cold soap-suds on to the tool as it works. What you see there is
the energy employed in shaving the metal being turned into heat in the
tool. If left uncooled by the water it would soon be red-hot. And the
faster the machine works the hotter will the tool get.

Now with the old steel a very little heat will suffice to make it soft,
when its cutting power is lost. So with the old steel, no matter how
much cooling water you might use, there was a distinct limit to the
speed of the lathe and the speed at which the work was finished, for if
that speed were once exceeded a stop became necessary to regrind the
tool or to put in a fresh one.

But with high-speed steel that limit is much higher, for it can get
almost red-hot before it loses its hardness and consequently machines
can be run and jobs finished at a speed which would have been out of
the question only a few years ago. If one belligerent knew how to make
high-speed steel while the other did not the former would have an
enormous advantage in war-time.

Speaking generally, steel such as is used for tools is called hard
steel, while that made by the Bessemer and Siemens-Martin processes is
called mild steel. Leaving out of account for the moment fancy steels
such as that just described, where other metals are added to the
mixture, the essential difference between all the varieties of steel is
simply a slight difference in the percentage of carbon. This is so
remarkable that it is worth while to tabulate these percentages again.

Cast iron has from 2 to 5 per cent.

Steel from one-fifth to one per cent.

Wrought iron less than one-fifth per cent.

Mild steel, which has least carbon of all the varieties of steel and in
this respect is therefore nearest to wrought iron, is used for the same
purposes as wrought iron, such as shipbuilding, bridges and roofs,
tanks, gas-holders, etc. When the Admiralty want a specially fast ship
such as a torpedo-boat destroyer with a hull as light as possible
consistent with strength they have it made of steel with a slightly
larger percentage of carbon so that the steel is stronger and the
vessel's frame can be made lighter. The steel for shells, too, needs to
be of a certain strength to give the best results, so the percentage of
carbon is adjusted accordingly.

For guns themselves, again, special properties are needed, and so not
only is the carbon regulated to a nicety but other things such as nickel
and chromium are added. Altogether, steel is one of the most marvellous
substances known, certainly the most marvellous metal. Copper is just
copper and no more, zinc is just zinc, and the same with lead, but iron
(which really includes steel) can be adapted to so many purposes, can be
endowed at will with so many different properties, that without doubt
iron, common, plentiful iron, is the king of all the metals.



CHAPTER VIII

MORE ABOUT GUNS


As has been remarked elsewhere, some of the guns used by the soldiers in
land warfare are very different from those used in the navy. The latter,
being carried on the ships to which they belong, can be of those
proportions which best suit their purpose. Consequently they are usually
very long compared with their diameter.

The field guns used by the Royal Field Artillery are shorter in
proportion to their calibre than are the big naval guns. Otherwise they
would be far too long to handle in the field. They are mounted on
carriages drawn by horses, and are so handy that they can go anywhere
where infantry can go and can travel just as fast. It takes a very short
time to get them ready for action, too, so that they can accompany
infantry quite freely, neither arm impeding the movements of the other.
The Horse Artillery, again, whose guns are even lighter still, can
accompany cavalry, travelling as fast and coming into action almost as
quickly as the troopers themselves.

The famous French "seventy-fives" (meaning 75 millimetres calibre) which
played such a great part in the war, are field guns intended to move
rapidly and to operate with infantry.

Both these types of gun were used by the British in South Africa, as
also were some field howitzers, a type of gun to which further reference
will be made later. But the Boers taught the world something new as to
the possibilities of moving heavy guns quickly. Perhaps the reason for
this was that they, being something of the nature of amateurs in the art
of warfare, were less under the influence of tradition. Anyway, they
surprised the British by the quick way in which they moved heavy guns,
sometimes into quite difficult positions, over rough ground and up steep
hills. These heavy guns of theirs were called by the British soldiers
"Long Toms."

But the British were quick to respond, particularly the ever-resourceful
navy. When the war broke out there were, in the neighbourhood of Durban,
a number of warships which had as part of their own armament some of
those guns which afterwards became famous as "4·7's," that being the
diameter of the bore in inches. They were of the long shape usual in
naval guns, and it is easy to see that they were much heavier than the
field guns of 3 inches or so in diameter.

Captain Scott (now Admiral Sir Percy Scott) saw that these would be
useful, so he quickly designed some carriages for them, got these made
in the railway workshops at Durban, and in a few hours was rushing them
up to Ladysmith. It was these guns very largely which enabled that town
to hold out for so long, until, in fact, it was triumphantly relieved.

Thus the effect of the Boer war was to show that much heavier weapons
could be manipulated in the field than had been considered possible
before. The Great War which followed but a few years later carried on
this same lesson, for one of the great surprises with which the Allies
were confronted in the early days of the conflict was the inexplicable
fall of fortresses which till then had been deemed almost impregnable.

Liége, Namur, Maubeuge and, finally, Antwerp, all fell to a wonderful
gun of enormous dimensions which the Austrians had produced from up
their sleeve, so to speak. Like conjurers they had kept them secret
until the last moment.

These weapons which made history so fast were of the kind called
howitzers, a name mentioned just now. It should be explained here that
gunners talk of guns and howitzers as if the latter were not guns; but
that is only a convenient habit which has grown up, for the latter are
unquestionably guns. The distinction is, however, so convenient that we
may well adopt it ourselves for the rest of this chapter.

Repeated references have been made already to the question of the length
of guns, and it has been pointed out that to get high velocity, great
range and vigorous hitting power a gun needs to be as long as possible.
On ships this is only limited by the strength of the steel of which the
gun is made, for beyond a certain length the gun bends of its own
weight. Ashore, however, the difficulties of transport impose a further
limitation in most cases, although the famous 4·7, like many other naval
guns, has a length of 50 calibres, and the guns of small calibre do
approximate somewhat to the proportions of the naval guns, since even
then their length comes within manageable limits.

Modern warfare, however, requires the use of larger shells containing
larger charges of explosives, and to fire these requires guns of greater
calibre. We hear of shells of as great a diameter as 16 inches being
thrown into the Belgian fortresses and of course nothing smaller than a
16-inch gun could do that. Now a 16-inch gun, if made to the naval
proportions of 50 calibres or even 45 calibres, would mean a length of
at least 60 to 70 feet. It would also mean a weight exceeding 100 tons,
for the 12-inch naval gun of 50 calibres weighs about 70 tons. And it is
easy to see that such a gun would be very difficult to move on the field
of battle. Indeed, it would be almost useless because of the time it
would take to get it into position and to construct the foundations
which it would need. If the Austrians had only had such as those the
Belgians would have had plenty of time to prepare for them at Antwerp,
whereas it was the quickness with which they brought up their heavy guns
that astonished everyone and took their opponents by surprise.

The secret of this astonishing performance lies in the fact that they
were not guns at all but howitzers, which instead of being long, slender
tubes are short, fat ones, and that involves a different idea in gunnery
altogether. The "gun" fires _at_ an object. The howitzer fires its shell
upwards with the purpose of dropping it _upon_ the object.

The difference between the two is well illustrated by the methods of
practising with them. In learning to work a gun the gunners fire at a
vertical target just as those of you who practise shooting at a
miniature range fire at a target of paper placed vertically against a
wall. The target for howitzer practice, on the other hand, is a square
marked out on the level ground, and the object of the gunners is to see
how great a proportion of a given number of shots they can drop inside
that square.

Of course, being so much shorter the howitzers cannot throw a shell so
far or at such a high velocity as the naval guns, but that can to a
certain extent be compensated for by using a higher explosive for the
propellant. That, however, involves greater stresses in the tube when
firing takes place and also calls for stronger foundations in order that
the aim may be steady.

A great part, too, of the velocity of a naval shell is required for the
penetration of the armour, whereas against forts or earthworks it is
sufficient if the shell "gets there."

Moreover, generally speaking, it is possible to get much nearer to a
fortress or entrenched position for the purpose of attacking it than it
is to an enemy ship on the sea. Except for the occasional help of a mist
there is no "cover" to be obtained at sea, while on land the ground must
be very flat indeed if there is no low hill or undulation behind which a
gun can be set up unnoticed.

The Austrians cherish a piece of steelwork from one of the forts of
Antwerp which they smashed with a shell from one of their big howitzers
at a range of seven miles. They evidently were able to get their big
howitzers within that comparatively short distance of the Antwerp
fortifications without being molested.

[Illustration: A GERMAN AUTOMATIC PISTOL.

The action is fully described on the illustration.]

In this connection one often hears the word mortar used, and just a
reference to that will be appropriate here. Many years ago short guns
which threw their balls very high were in use, and because of their
resemblance to the mortar which is used for pounding up things with the
aid of a pestle these were termed mortars. Later a man named Howitzer
introduced a type of gun which was something of a compromise between the
long thin gun and the short stubby mortar. As time has gone on, however,
the mortars have grown in length while the howitzers have shortened,
until to-day the two names are used almost indiscriminately to denote
the same thing. Hence the giant howitzers of the Austrians are often
spoken of as the "Skoda" mortars, Skoda being the name of the factory
where they were made.

At one time many people wondered why the Germans did not put some of
these huge mortars on their battleships: many thought that they would do
so, and that by that means they would demolish our navy as they had
already smashed the Belgian forts. The reason they did not is, no doubt,
the very simple one, that our naval guns would have probably sunk their
ships before the howitzers could have reached ours, because if they had
attempted to make up for the shortness of the weapons by using higher
explosives, these mortars would, there is little doubt, have knocked to
pieces the ships on which they were mounted.

The old-fashioned fortress, suddenly made "out-of-date" by the Skoda
mortars, was usually armed with guns of the naval type. Sea-coast forts
are always so armed. Nowadays, however, the inland fortress takes the
form of a labyrinth of trenches and underground passages, combined with
deeply excavated chambers known as dug-outs, and these do not fitly
accommodate large guns at all. The guns are placed well back behind the
trenches sheltered behind hills or woods, over which they hurl their
shells. The chief defenders of the actual trench are the machine gun,
which is little more than an automatic rifle on a stand, and the trench
mortar.

We are now in a position to sum up broadly the features of modern
artillery. There is first the naval gun, the ideal gun, long and of
great range, able to send forth its shells with great velocity. This gun
appears again in the sea-coast forts, where the conditions are very much
those which obtain on a ship and where the attacking party is of
necessity a ship.

In the field we have the field and horse artillery, which we may regard
as the naval gun modified somewhat in order to make it easy to move
about, so that it can accompany troops and support the operations of
both infantry and cavalry. These light guns are supported by the field
howitzers, which are also light and easily handled, and the guns of the
4·7 type, originally naval guns but now mounted on wheels and possessing
a certain amount of mobility, not equalling the field guns it is true,
but still very serviceable in a campaign.

Then we have the howitzers of various sizes which have rendered the
old-fashioned steel and concrete forts useless, and which are the chief
weapons used in the modern trench warfare. It is these which blow in the
walls of the trenches and dug-outs, shatter the barbed-wire
entanglements and render it possible for the infantry to attack an
entrenched position.

Finally, we have the machine guns, each of which is equivalent to a
considerable number of riflemen and which, with the trench mortars, form
the chief defences of the actual trench itself. Of course these are only
useful against attacks by infantry: they cannot in any way cope with the
heavy artillery. That has to be dealt with by the opposing artillery
posted away back behind the trenches.

And now let us take a rather more close look at some of these weapons.
Essentially each one is a steel tube. It may be a single tube or it may
be several one outside another. It may even have a layer of wire between
two tubes as many naval guns have. It is invariably (one small exception
will be mentioned later) loaded at the breech or rear end and not
through the muzzle as used to be the custom. For this purpose it needs a
breech-block or door, which can be opened to put in the shell and
explosive, and which can then be closed tightly so that it will not be
driven out or burst open when the explosion takes place and also shall
be gas tight so as not to let any of the force of the explosion escape.

Then the gun must be mounted upon a carriage so that it can be quickly
moved about. The lighter forms of artillery are fired when upon the same
carriage upon which they travel. In years gone by the whole thing,
carriage as well as gun, used to run back when the gun was fired, which
was a great nuisance since it had to be got back into position again
after each shot. To obviate this the gun is now mounted upon a slide,
and it is the slide which is fitted to the carriage. Thus the gun can
slide back without the carriage moving at all. The latter is made very
strong, and shoes are provided at the end of chains which go under the
wheels just like the "drag" which coaches and heavy carts have for use
going down hills. There is also a part like a spade which can be driven
down into the ground so that, what with the shoes and the spade, the
carriage is fixed very firmly.

The gun is kept at the front part of the slide by means of a powerful
spring, which is compressed when the gun is fired but which, as the
force of the recoil is spent, pushes the gun back to its original
position once more. The spring is often reinforced by a cylinder and a
piston with compressed air or water behind it, acting after the manner
of those door checks with which we are all familiar, its function being
to steady the motion of the gun and to let it go gently back to its
place without slamming, just as the door check prevents a door from
slamming.

By this means the gun is returned automatically after each shot to
practically the same position which it occupied before, so that it does
not need re-aiming each time, but only a slight readjustment if even
that. The result of this is that such a gun can be fired very rapidly.
In fact, it can be fired just as fast as the gunners can keep on
reloading it.

The big Skoda mortars owed their mobility to the clever way in which
they were constructed. The gun tube itself, the support for it or
mounting, and the steel foundation were each fitted to a special
motor-driven trolley. The steel foundation was dumped down on the
ground, which of course was prepared for it in advance, then the
mounting was run right on to it so that it simply needed bolting down
and finally the tube was hoisted by specially prepared appliances into
its place. It is said that the whole operation occupied less than an
hour.

For firing, these mortars of course are pointed at a very high angle,
almost like an astronomical telescope. No doubt the gunners have many
jokes about "shooting the moon" and so on, for that is just what they
seem to be attempting. For loading, however, they are lowered into a
horizontal position: the shell comes up on a small hand-truck, is raised
by a specially designed jack until it is level with the breech, and is
then pushed into its place. The breech is then closed, the tube
re-elevated, and all is ready for firing.

Between these two forms of gun, the field gun on its light carriage,
which not only bears it from place to place but forms its support while
in action, and the great mortar carried in parts on specially made
trolleys, there are now an enormous variety of guns and mortars adapted
for the various purposes which experience in the Great War revealed.
Artillery suffered many changes in the light of the South African
campaign and of the Russo-Japanese war, but of far more importance have
been the lessons learnt in Northern France and on the plains of Poland.
To some extent these lessons have been learnt and profited by during the
actual war, but there is no doubt that as men have time to think over
them in the years of peace which are ahead many more developments will
take place. Unless, that is, we are on the threshold of that happy time
when guns and fighting material of all sorts will be looked upon as the
relics of a bad and ruinous time now happily past.

In conclusion, a passing reference must be made to the trench mortars
and similar contrivances which have arisen as the result of the
prolonged spell of trench warfare which no one had ever contemplated.
These are in effect very short range mortars or howitzers, specially
intended for throwing bombs from trench to trench. Some are simply the
larger mortars on a small scale, but one has decidedly original
features.

This consists of a short light mortar into which the bombs are slipped
through the muzzle, thus reverting to the old method of loading. The
propellant is combined with the bomb and there is a percussion cap which
fires it as soon as it strikes the bottom of the tube. Thus the
operation is just about as simple as it can be: the man merely places
the bomb in the upturned muzzle and lets it slide down. An instant
later, up it comes again, to go sailing through the air into the trench
of the enemy a hundred yards away.

One must not conclude this chapter, however, without a reference to
those useful weapons which are known among the soldiers as "Archibalds"
and officially as anti-aircraft guns. These are perhaps the most
familiar guns of all to the general public, since they were installed in
many places in Britain for the purpose of dealing with the Zeppelins. No
doubt not a few of my readers have had the experience of being awakened
from their beauty sleep by the cracking of the anti-aircraft guns and
have seen their shells bursting like squibs in the air.

They are fairly long guns, not unlike field guns, but they are mounted
upon special supports which enable them to be pointed at any angle so
that they can fire right up into the sky. The sights, also, are somewhat
different, being fitted with prisms, or reflectors, so that the gunners
can look along the sights and align the gun upon an object overhead
without lying on their backs.

Much more could be said on this subject, but national interests forbid,
so with this general review of modern artillery we must pass to another
subject.



CHAPTER IX

THE GUNS THEY USE IN THE NAVY


Both the great English-speaking nations are immensely proud of their
navies. They can, on occasion, produce soldiers by the million of the
very highest and most efficient type, but they never feel quite that
pride and patriotic fervour over their soldiers that they do over their
ships of war and their sailors.

The guns, therefore, with which the ships are armed, always form a
subject of great interest, especially those large ones which constitute
the armament of the Dreadnought battleships and battle-cruisers.

Let us first consider what is required in a naval gun, for it must be
remembered that the naval and military weapons are different in some
respects. Experience at the Dardanelles showed that even the guns of the
_Queen Elizabeth_, the largest and most powerful then known, fresh from
the finest factories, were not particularly successful against the
Turkish forts. The Germans, too, set up what was probably a naval gun
and occasionally dropped shells into Dunkirk with it at a range of
twenty miles or so, but without causing much harm, and the fact that
they only did it occasionally and then abandoned it altogether seems to
indicate that in their opinion they were not doing much good with it.

It must not be assumed from this that naval guns are bad guns or poor
guns, however, but simply that they are made for a special purpose for
which they are highly efficient, from which it follows almost as a
natural consequence that they are somewhat less efficient when used for
some other purpose. Their purpose is to pierce the hard steel armour
with which warships are protected and then to explode in the enemy's
interior, whereas in modern warfare the greatest military guns are
chiefly required to blow a big hole in the ground or to shatter a block
of concrete. In both cases the ultimate object is to carry a quantity of
explosive into the enemy's territory and there explode it, but whereas
the land gun has simply to do that and no more, the naval gun has to
pierce thick armour-plate as well.

And just think what that means. Many large ships have their vital parts
protected by armour-plates twelve inches thick. Moreover, the
armour-plates are made of very special steel, the finest that can be
invented for the purpose. Vast sums of money have been expended in
experimenting to find out just the best sort of steel for resisting
penetration by shells. Some time ago I saw several pieces of
armour-plate which had been used in one of these tests. They had been
set up under conditions as nearly as possible the same as those
obtaining on the side of a ship and then they had been fired at from
varying distances, the effects of the various shots being carefully
recorded. And that is only one experiment out of tens of thousands
which have been tried again and again, while the steel manufacturers are
always trying to improve and again improve the shell-resisting
properties of their steel. Thus, we see, the presence of the steel
armour which has to be perforated before the shell can do its work makes
the task set before the naval gun somewhat different from that which
confronts its military brother.

These considerations result in the naval gun needing to have as flat a
trajectory as possible and its projectiles the highest possible speed.

Now trajectory, it may be useful to explain, is the technical term
employed to denote the course of a projectile, which is always more or
less curved.

Let us imagine that we see a gun, pointed in a perfectly horizontal
direction, and let us also imagine that by some miracle we have got rid
of the force of gravity and also that there is no air. Under those
conditions the shot from the gun would go perfectly straight and with
undiminished velocity for ever and ever. Then let us imagine that the
air comes into being. The effect of that is to act as a brake which
gradually slows the shell down until finally it stops it. Theoretically,
perhaps, it would never quite stop it, but for all practical purposes it
would.

Again, let us suppose that while the air is absent the force of gravity
comes into play, what effect will that have? It will gradually pull the
shell downwards out of its horizontal course, making it describe a
beautiful curve.

But, someone may think, does not a rapidly-moving body remain to some
extent unaffected by gravity? Not at all: it falls just the same and
just as quickly as if it were falling straight down.

If our imaginary horizontal gun were set at a height of sixteen feet and
a shell were just pushed out of it so that it fell straight down the
shell would touch the ground in one second. If the ground were perfectly
flat and the shell were fired so that it reached a point half a mile
away _in one second_ it would strike the ground exactly half a mile
away. You see, the horizontal motion due to the explosion in the gun and
the downward motion due to gravity go on simultaneously and the two
combined produce the curve.

To make this quite clear, let us imagine two guns precisely alike side
by side and both pointed perfectly horizontally. From one the shell is
just pushed out: from the other it is fired at the highest velocity
attainable: both those shells will fall sixteen feet or a shade more in
one second, and if the ground were perfectly level both would strike the
ground at the same moment although a great distance apart.

Clearly, then, the faster the shell is travelling the more nearly
horizontally will it move, for it will have less time in which to fall,
and the slower the more curved will be its path, from which we see that
the air by reducing the velocity causes the curve to become steeper and
steeper as the shell proceeds.

If, then, our gun is placed low down, as it must be on a ship, to get
the longest range we must point it more or less upwards because
otherwise the shell will fall into the water before it has reached its
target. When we do that we complicate matters somewhat, for gravity
tends to reduce the velocity while the shell is rising and to add to it
again while it is falling. We need not go too deeply into that, however,
so long as we realize that, whatever the conditions may be, the shell in
actual use has to follow a curved course, first rising and then falling.

The really important part about a shell's journey is the end. So long as
it hits it really does not matter what it does on the way, and if it
misses it is equally immaterial. The reason why we need to bother about
the first part of the trip is because upon it depends the final result.
Whatever the trajectory may be we see that the shell must necessarily
arrive in a slanting direction. And the more steeply slanting that
direction is _the less likely is the target to be hit_.

If the shell went straight it would only be necessary to point the gun
in the right direction and the object would be hit no matter how far
away it might be. The more curved the course is, the more likely the
shell is to fall either too near or too far, in the one case dropping
into the water, in the other passing clear over the opposing ship.

Let us look at it another way. Suppose the vital parts of a ship rise 20
feet out of the water and the shell arrives at such an angle that it
falls 20 feet in 100 yards: then, if the ship be within a certain zone
100 yards wide it will be hit in a vital spot. If it be nearer the shell
will pass over, if it be further the shell will fall into the water.
That 100 yards is what is called the "danger zone." If the shell is
falling less steeply, say, 20 feet in 200 yards, then the danger zone
is increased to 200 yards and so on, which gives us the rule that the
flatter the trajectory, or the more nearly straight the course of the
shell the greater is the danger zone and the more likely is the enemy
ship to be hit.

We have established two facts, therefore, first, that the trajectory
must be as flat as possible and, second, that to make it flat the
velocity must be high. We can also see another reason for high velocity,
namely, to give penetrating power.

To obtain a high velocity the gun must be long, and consequently naval
guns are always long, a fact which is very noticeable in the photographs
of warships. The reason for this is quite obvious after a little
thought. You could not throw a cricket ball very far if you could only
move your hand through a distance of one foot. To get the best result
you instinctively reach as far back as ever you can and then reach
forward as far as you are able, so that the ball shall have as long a
journey as possible in your hand. Perhaps you do not know it but all the
time you are moving your hand with the ball in it you are putting energy
into that ball, which energy carries it along after you have let go of
it. And it is just the same with the shell in the gun. So long as it is
in the gun energy is being added to it but as soon as it leaves the
muzzle that ceases. After that it has to pursue its own way under the
influence of the energy which has been imparted to it.

The powder which is employed as the propellant or driving power is of
such a nature and so adjusted as to quantity that as far as possible it
shall give a comparatively slow steady push rather than a sudden shock,
so as to make full use of the gun's length, the expanding gases
following up the shell as it goes forward and keeping a constant push
upon it.

On the other hand, a gun can be too long, for no steel is infinitely
strong and stiff, so that beyond a certain limit the muzzle of the gun
would be likely to droop slightly of its own weight and so make the
shooting inaccurate. The limit seems to be about 50 calibres or, in
other words, fifty times the diameter of the bore.

For a considerable time the standard big gun of the British Navy was the
12-inch, that being the calibre or diameter of the bore. The famous
_Dreadnought_ had guns of that calibre and so had her immediate
successors.

The 12-inch gun of fifty calibres weighs 69 tons and fires a projectile
weighing 850 lbs. which it hurls from its muzzle at a velocity of about
3000 feet per second.

More recently the size has grown to 13½, 14 and even as great as 15
inches calibre, but we may for the moment take the 12-inch gun as
typical of all these large guns and have a look at its construction.

It is made of a special kind of steel known as nickel-chrome gun steel,
formed by adding certain proportions of the two rare metals nickel and
chromium to the mixture of iron and carbon which we ordinarily call
steel. The metal is made after the manner described in another chapter
and is cast into the form of suitably-sized ingots which are afterwards
squeezed in enormous hydraulic presses into the rough shape required.
Besides giving the metal the desired form this action has the effect of
improving its quality. Since a gun is necessarily a tube it may be
wondered why the steel is not cast straight away into that shape instead
of into a solid block and the reason why that is not done is very
interesting. It is found that any impurities in the metal--and it is
impossible to make it without some impurities--collect in that part
which cools last and obviously that part of a block which cools last is
the centre. Thus the impurities gather together in the centre of the
mass whence they are removed when that centre is cut away, whereas if
the first casting were a tube they would collect in a part which would
remain in the finished gun.

The ingot, then, is cast and pressed roughly to shape. Then it is put
into a lathe where it is turned on the outside and a hole bored right
through the centre.

But that is by no means all of the troubles through which this piece of
steel has to pass. It undergoes a very stringent heat treatment, being
alternately heated in a furnace to some precise temperature and then
plunged into oil, whereby the exact degree of hardness required is
attained.

Moreover, this is only one of the tubes which go to make up the gun,
which is a composite structure of four tubes placed one over another
with a layer of tightly wound wire as well.

First, there is the innermost tube, the whole length of the gun, then a
second one outside that, usually made in two halves. Both are carefully
made to fit, and then the outer is expanded by heat to enable it to be
slidden over the inner one, after which on cooling it contracts and fits
tightly. Outside this second tube is wound the wire, or more strictly
speaking tape, for it is a quarter of an inch wide and a sixteenth
thick. It is so strong that a single strand of it could sustain a ton
and a half. It is carefully wound on; first several layers running the
whole length of the gun and then extra layers where the greatest
stresses come, that is to say, near the breech, for that has to
withstand the initial shock of the explosion. Altogether about 130 miles
of wire go on a single gun.

The advantages of this form of construction are many. For one thing, a
wire or strip can be examined throughout its whole length and any defect
is sure to be found, whereas in a solid piece of steel, no matter how
carefully it may be made, there may lurk hidden defects. Moreover, if a
solid tube develops a crack anywhere it is liable to spread, whereas a
few strands of wire may be broken without in any way affecting the rest.
It has been found that even if a shell burst while inside one of these
guns no harm is done to the men in the turret where it stands, a thing
which cannot be said for guns composed entirely of tubes, so that the
merit rests with the wire. A third advantage is that the wire can be
wound on to the tube beneath it at precisely that tension which is
calculated to give the best result, whereas in shrinking one tube on to
another this cannot always be attained.

Over the wire there come two more tubes not running the whole length
but meeting and overlapping somewhat near the middle, so that at one
point there are actually four concentric tubes besides the wire.

At the rear end a kind of cap called the breech-piece covers over the
ends of all the tubes, itself having a central hole into which fits the
breech-block, one of the triumphs of modern engineering, of which more
in a moment.

While we have in mind the wire-wound form of construction it is
interesting to note that something similar but in a crude form was
practised sixty years or more ago. The guns of that era were some of
them even of cast iron while the more refined consisted of a steel tube
strengthened with coils of wrought iron. This iron was first rolled into
flat bars, then it was made hot, and wound on spirally round an iron bar
the same size as the tube. A little hammering converted this spiral into
a tube which was then fitted round the steel tube. Thus, although very
different there is still a distinct resemblance between this old method
and the up-to-date wire-wound weapon.

The manufacture of guns, it may be remarked, owes more to one man than
to any other, namely, Mons. Gustave Canet, a French engineer who, having
fought in the Franco-German War, decided to devote his engineering
talents to developing the artillery of his native land. He spent many
years in England but later established works at Havre for the
manufacture of guns upon improved methods, finally merging his interests
into those of the great French armament firm of Schneider of Creusot.
By French and English artillerists at all events the name of Canet is
regarded with reverence.

But to get back to our naval gun. It will be clear that operations such
as have been described, involving the handling of great tubes fifty feet
or more in length, heating them as required, dipping them in oil while
hot and so on, can only be carried out at works specially designed for
the purpose.

The furnaces where the tubes are heated are well-like formations in the
ground, deep enough to take the tube vertically. To lift them in and out
there have to be tall travelling cranes capable of catching the tube by
its upper end and lifting it right out of the furnace so that its lower
end clears the ground. To accomplish this with a little to spare the
cranes need to be seventy feet or so high.

Then there are deep pits full of oil so that a tube can be heated in a
furnace, drawn out by a crane and quickly dropped into the adjacent oil
bath. Likewise there have to be pits of a third kind wherein a cold tube
can be set up while a hot one is dropped over it for the purpose of
shrinking the latter on.

Then, of course, there have to be lathes of gigantic dimensions capable
of taking a length of nearly sixty feet and of swinging an object
weighing anything up to fifty tons. But of those machines we can only
pause to make mention, for we must pass on to the breech-block, in some
ways the most interesting part of the gun.

When it was first suggested to leave the back end of the gun open so
that the powder and projectiles could be put in that way instead of
through the muzzle, people at once foresaw how much would depend upon
the arrangements for stopping up the hole while the gun was fired. For,
of course, the force of the explosion is exerted equally in all
directions, backward just as much as forward, so that unless very
securely fixed the stopper closing the breech would be liable to become
a projectile travelling in the wrong direction. To fix such a thing
securely enough to avoid accidents would surely take up too much time
and so largely neutralize any advantage arising from its use. These
fears were, indeed, to some extent justified by accidents which actually
occurred with the early examples of breech-loading guns, and for that
reason our own authorities for a time looked askance at breech-loaders.

Now let us take a look at the breech-block of the 12-inch naval gun of
to-day, which never blows out, not even when 350 lbs. of cordite go off
just the other side of it. The explosion hurls an 850-pound shell at the
rate of 8000 feet per second but it never stirs the breech-block. Yet it
can be opened and closed so quickly, including the necessary
fastening-up after closing, that shots can be fired from the gun at the
rate of one every fifteen seconds.

The breech-block partakes of the nature of a plug and also of a door. It
swings upon hinges like the latter but its shape more resembles the
former. If we want to make such a thing very secure we usually make it
in the form of a screw with many threads, but that entails turning it
round many times and that takes time. Given plenty of time to screw the
breech-block into its place and there would never have been any anxiety
as to the possibility of its blowing out, but there is not time. The
problem, therefore, was to get the strength of a screw combined with
quickness of action.

This dilemma is avoided in the following simple manner. The breech-block
is given a screw thread on its exterior surface, and the hole in the
breech-piece is given a similar screw-thread on its inner surface, just
as if the one were to be laboriously screwed into the other after the
manner of an ordinary screw in machinery. Then four grooves are cut
right across the threads on the block and similarly on the breech-piece,
so that at four different places there is no thread left. In other
words, instead of the thread running round and round continuously, each
turn is divided up into four sections with sections of plain unthreaded
metal in between. Thus in a certain position the block can be pushed
into the hole without any threads engaging at all, for each strip of
threaded block passes over an unthreaded strip in the hole and vice
versa, in other words, the threads on the one part miss those on the
other part. Yet an eighth of a turn serves to make all the threads
engage and the thing is held almost as securely as if it were just an
ordinary screw with threads its whole length.

The block is carried upon a hinged arm so that although it can be turned
in this manner it can also be swung back freely when necessary.

Combined with the breech-block is a pneumatic contrivance which blows a
powerful jet of air through the gun every time the breech is opened,
thereby cleaning away the effects of the last explosion.

Each of these great guns is mounted upon a slide so that when it is
fired it can slide back, thereby exhausting the effect of the recoil,
yet can be returned instantly to its original position. Indeed, this
return is brought about quite automatically by the agency of springs,
compressed air and hydraulic power. Thus the gun fires, slides back,
returns and is at once ready for the next shot.

It is trained, or pointed in a horizontal plane, by turning the turret
in which it stands but the correct elevation is gained by the use of
telescopic sights.

The principle of these sights is very simple. Imagine a graduated circle
fixed to the side of the gun. Pivoted at the centre of the circle is a
small telescope. The telescope can be turned round to any angle upon the
circle and it can then be clamped at that particular angle.

The range having been given to the officer in command of the gun from
the range-finding station on another part of the ship, the telescope is
set to the correct angle. Then the gun is elevated or depressed until
the ship being aimed at is precisely in the centre of the field of view
of the telescope, in other words, until the telescope is pointing
exactly at the ship. Then the gun is fired.

The effect, therefore, is this. The telescope always points (while the
gun is being fired) at the object aimed at, but the gun is pointed
upwards at a certain angle, which angle depends upon how the telescope
is set upon the divided circle. Thus the setting of the telescope for a
given range produces the correct upward tilt of the gun for that range.

The breech-block carries a trigger and hammer arrangement whereby the
firing can be done and also an electrical arrangement so that an
electric spark can be employed. Both these firing contrivances are so
made that they cannot be operated until the breech-block has been
inserted and _made secure_. Thus a premature explosion is guarded
against.



CHAPTER X

SHELLS AND HOW THEY ARE MADE


Modern warfare seems to resolve itself very largely into a question of
which side can procure the most shells. During the great war there was a
time when the British and their allies were hard pressed because they
had not sufficient shells. The enemy had in that matter stolen a march
upon them and had during the winter, when military activity is at its
minimum, rapidly produced large supplies of high-explosive shells.

Discovering their lack the British set about remedying it in true
British fashion. It is quite characteristic of this strange people to
let the enemy get ahead at the commencement, after which they pull
themselves together and put on a spurt, so to speak, and after that the
enemy had better prepare for the worst, for defeat is only a question of
time. So, finding themselves short of shells, they set to and dotted the
whole country in an incredibly short time with huge factories entirely
devoted to making shells. Older factories also were adapted to the same
purpose. Places intended and normally used for the manufacture of the
most peaceable things--ploughs, gramophones and piano parts for
example--were soon turning out shells or parts thereof by the thousand.
Electric-light works, waterworks, cotton mills, technical schools, all
sorts of places where, for doing their own repairs or for some similar
reason, there happened to be a lathe or two, all these were organized
and in a few weeks they too were working night and day "something to do
with shells."

Meanwhile other factories were springing up for the purpose of making
explosives while others again were erected for producing the acids and
other chemicals necessary for the explosive works; and yet another kind
of works, the filling factories, came into being as if by magic and
thousands of girls flocked from far and near to these places, there to
fill the shells with the explosives.

Even the soldiers did not realize a few years ago how important the
supply of shells was going to be. The rifle has fallen from its old
place of importance while the gun and the shell have risen to the first
place.

What, then, is a shell? It is what its name implies, a case covering
something else, just as the shell of a fish covers its owner. It is a
hollow cylinder of steel with certain things inside it. Its chief
function is to hold these other things and to be shot out of a gun
carrying them with it to their destination. You want to cause an
explosion in an enemy's ship. You cannot get near enough to put the
explosives there by hand, for he will not let you, so you put them into
a steel shell and then hurl the whole thing at him out of a gun.

[Illustration: BOMB THROWING.

One of the most striking things about the war was the re-invention of
the bomb thrown by hand. This officer hurled bombs at the enemy for
twenty-four hours continuously.]

In the attempt to prevent your doing him any harm by thus throwing boxes
of explosives at him, the enemy clothes the sides of his most valuable
and important ships with thick steel plates, wherefore you have to make
your shell strong and tough so that it shall not splinter against the
armour but shall on the contrary bore its way through, finally exploding
in the interior of the ship.

If it is not a ship that you are attacking but, say, an earthwork or an
arrangement of trenches, then you do not need to penetrate steel armour
and your shell can be thinner and of lighter construction. It still
needs to be strong, however, for it has another function besides simply
carrying the explosive. It must hold the force of the explosion in for a
moment while it gathers force so that when the hour comes the pent-up
energy may strike all round with the utmost violence. Even the most
powerful explosives are comparatively feeble if they go off in the open.
By holding them in check for a moment and then letting their force loose
suddenly you get a much more forceful blow.

Shells which contain only an explosive are called common shells or
high-explosive shells. Shrapnel shells constitute another type in which
the force of the explosion is simply employed to release a number of
round bullets, which strike mainly because of the velocity which they
derive from the original motion of the shell. These are above all things
man-killing shells, for their result is akin to a volley of bullets at
close range.

We can thus sum up the chief types of shell as follows: the naval shell
which has to be capable of penetrating armour: the high-explosive shell
which must be able to break up earthworks and blow down the walls of
trenches: and the shrapnel shell which scatters a shower of bullets and
is most useful in attacks upon bodies of men rather than upon material
structures.

Some shells have their propellent explosive combined with them just as
the familiar rifle cartridge contains the propellant combined with the
bullet. In the larger sizes, however, it is much more convenient to have
the propellant in a separate cartridge, which can be handled separately
and loaded into the gun separately.

As has been already explained, the propellant is a "powder" which gives
a steady push rather than a destructive blow: moreover, it is
practically smokeless, so as not to "give away" the position of the gun
to the enemy. The "high explosive," however, shatters and usually makes
a dense smoke, so that the observers can see where it fell and report to
the gunners whether or not they have got the range. Soldiers' letters
have told us of the "black Marias" and "coal boxes" used by the Germans,
those terms being simply soldiers' nick-names arising no doubt from the
fact that certain particular shells are filled with "tri-nitro-toluene"
which gives a black smoke. Clearly, smoke, which is most objectionable
in the propellant, is a positive advantage in the bursting charge.

And now let us take a glimpse at the manufacture of one of these
terrible missiles. An ingot of shell-steel is first cast as described in
an earlier chapter. Since impurities are apt to rise, while the metal
is liquid, the top of the ingot is always cut off and discarded. This
waste material is used for many other purposes, in which a chance flaw
would not be a serious matter, under the title of "shell-discard" steel.

The lower part is then heated and passed through a rolling mill, a
machine very similar in principle to the domestic mangle, the rollers
being of iron with suitable grooves cut in them. A few passages through
this machine transforms the ingot into a thick round bar. This is then
sawn into short pieces called billets, each of which is the right size
to form a shell. Again heated, a powerful press drives a pointed bar
through the softened steel, thereby converting the short billet into a
rough tube. Another press then slightly closes in one end, making it
resemble a bottle without a bottom and with the neck broken off.

The rough forging is then ready to be machined, an operation which is
performed in a lathe. The outside is made perfectly round and smooth and
of precisely the right size. The inside is also bored out to the correct
diameter and finished off to an exceeding smoothness so as to avoid the
possibility of any rough places irritating the explosive which in due
time will be filled into it. For the same reason, the inside, when
finished, is varnished in a certain way and with a certain varnish. The
formation of this varnish is one of those little thought of but highly
important services which alcohol renders to us, as mentioned elsewhere.

The smaller end (that which has already been partially squeezed in) is
bored out and screwed for the reception of the nose-bush, while the
other end is recessed for the reception of the plate which forms the
bottom.

Most of these operations have to be very accurately carried out and, to
ensure that that is so, gauges are continually employed to check the
work. These gauges are based upon a very simple principle, known as the
"limit" principle. This is both interesting and important, sufficiently
so to merit a more detailed reference.

It must first be realized that no two things are alike and no
measurement is perfectly correct. When we lightly speak of two things
being "alike" we really mean that for the purpose contemplated they are
nearly enough alike. Two things might be "alike" for one purpose and yet
be so unlike as to be useless for another.

What the authorities do in the case of shells, therefore, and what is
done nowadays in many branches of engineering, is to recognize this fact
and at the same time overcome the difficulty by stating what difference
is permissible. In other words, instead of saying that a thing must be a
certain size, it is required to fall between two limits: it must not be
more than one or less than the other.

For example, suppose a hole is required to be nominally an inch in
diameter it may be specified that it shall not exceed an inch plus
one-thousandth or fall short of an inch minus one-thousandth. In such a
case a variation of a thousandth of an inch either way is permitted.
The permitted variation may be more than that, or it may be less and be
measured in ten-thousandths, it all depends upon circumstances. Clearly
in every case it is desirable to permit as large a variation as is
consistent with a good result.

Now to make measures with the degree of accuracy just mentioned is not
easy. One can just about see through a crack a thousandth of an inch
wide if held up to a bright light. How then can dimensions such as these
be dealt with easily and quickly in the rough conditions of a large
workshop?

Let us again think of that one-inch hole and we shall see how simply and
easily it is done. The gauge in such a case would be shaped somewhat
like a dumb-bell, one end being the "go" end and the other the "not-go"
end. The former is made to agree as nearly as possible with the lower
limit, the other with the higher limit, and all the inspector has to do
is to try first one end in the hole and then the other. One must "go" in
and the other must "not-go." So long as that happens he knows that the
hole is correct within the prescribed limits. If, on the other hand,
both go in, then he knows the hole is too large, or if neither goes in
he knows it is too small. It may be urged by some acute reader that the
gauges themselves cannot be correct, and that is quite true, but it is
possible, by great care and laborious methods, to produce gauges which
are correct to within far narrower limits than those mentioned.

In the case of outside dimensions the gauges take the form of a thumb
and finger capable of spanning the object to be measured, and in that
case also two are used, one of which must "go" and the other "not-go."

By methods such as these the shells are measured and examined.

One of the most important features of a shell is its driving band. In
the old days of round cannon balls it is said that the gunners used to
wrap greasy rag round each so as to make it fit the cannon and to
prevent the force of the explosion to some extent wasting itself by
blowing past the ball. That is one of the functions of the driving band.
It is made of copper which is comparatively soft, and it forms a fairly
tight fit in the bore of the gun, so that while the shell is free enough
to slide out of the gun it is tight enough to prevent the loss of any of
the driving force of the explosive.

Its second purpose is to give the necessary spinning action to the
shell. The old cannon ball suffered from the fact that it offered a
considerable surface to the air in proportion to its weight. The idea
arose, therefore, of making projectiles cylindrical and with a pointed
nose, so that while the weight might be increased the resistance to the
air might be even reduced. But it was clearly no use doing this unless
the thing could be made to travel point foremost. Now for some rather
mysterious reason, if you shoot a cylindrical object out of a gun, it
will turn head over heels in the air, unless you give it a spinning
motion. This motion, however, because of a gyroscopic effect, keeps the
shell point first all the time.

It has another effect, too, known as "air-boring." A spinning shell
seems actually to bore its way through the air. Probably this is due to
a centrifugal action, the spinning shell throwing the air outwards from
itself and so to some extent sucking the air away out of its own path.
Whether that be the true explanation or not, the fact remains that the
spinning shell makes its way through the air better than a non-spinning
one would do.

The gun, therefore, has formed in its bore a very slow screw-thread
called "rifling," from a French word meaning a screw. And it is the
second function of the copper band to catch this rifling and by it be
turned as the shell proceeds along the barrel. The soft copper conforms
to the shape of the rifling and so itself becomes in a sense a screw
engaging with the rifling.

This band is situated near the base of the shell, lying in a groove
turned in the shell for its reception. To prevent the band turning round
without turning the shell there is a wavy groove turned in the bottom of
the larger groove, and the band, being put on hot, is squeezed into the
latter by a powerful press.

The nose-bush is a little fitting of brass which screws into the smaller
end of the shell and it has a hole in its centre into which another
brass fitting, the nose itself, is screwed.

The base of the shell is closed with a little disc of steel plate.
People sometimes wonder why the original forging is not made solid at
the bottom so as to save the necessity for this disc, but the reason is
that if that were done defects might very possibly arise in the steel
in the centre which, since it is the very spot whereon the propellant
acts, might let some of the heat or force of the propellant through,
causing a premature explosion of the charge inside the gun itself
instead of among the ranks of the enemy.

In the case of naval shells, the nose is not of brass but of a soft kind
of steel. One might expect it to be of the very hardest steel, since it
has to pierce the hard armour, but experience has shown that the soft
nose is better than a hard one. The reason probably is that a hard nose
splinters, whereas a soft one spreads out on striking the armour and
then acts as a protection to the body of the shell behind it. In these
shells, too, the fuse which explodes the charge is placed in the base.
In the others it is in the nose, but clearly it could not be so placed
in the armour-piercing shell.

It is interesting to mention that the propellent "powder" has combined
in it some vaseline or other greasy matter which acts as a lubricant
between the gun and the shell when firing takes place.

Shrapnel is so different from the other types of shell that it merits a
short paragraph or two to itself. Instead of being filled, as the others
are, solely with explosive, the front part of it accommodates a
considerable number of small round bullets, behind which comes a charge
of gunpowder. The front half of the shell is separate from the back
part, the two being connected by rivets of soft iron wire, so that a
sudden shock can rend them apart. The shell is fired from the gun and
comes flying along: suddenly, owing to the action of the fuse, the
gunpowder explodes: the case then flies in two, the bullets are
liberated and fall in a shower. In the South African War, where
fortifications were few, these shells were very effective, but against
fortifications, and particularly against trenches and barbed wire, big
explosive shells are of much greater value.



CHAPTER XI

WHAT SHELLS ARE MADE OF


The body of a shell is made of steel of a fairly strong variety. That is
to say, it is stronger than that used for shipbuilding and for bridges
and such work: but it is less so than some of the higher grades of
steel, such as that used for making wire ropes. Owing to so much of this
steel being rolled during the war, "shell quality" has come to be as
well known to the general engineer as any of the many varieties which he
has been accustomed to since his apprentice days. Many people wondered,
at one time, why the cheaper and more easily worked cast iron could not
be used for shells. There was a period when the steel works were quite
unable to cope with the demands for steel, yet the iron foundries were
crying out for work. This question then arose in many minds, Why not
make cast iron shells? The answer is that cast iron is too weak: it
would blow into fragments too soon.

Just think what a shell is and what it has to do. It is a metal case
filled with explosive. It is thrown from a gun and is intended to blow
itself to pieces on arrival at its destination. It is that
self-destruction which carries destruction to all around as well. It is
necessary, in order to obtain the best result, that an appreciable time
should elapse between the ignition of the explosive and the bursting of
the case. The force of the most sudden explosion is not really developed
at once, but takes an appreciable time. After ignition, therefore, as
the explosion gradually becomes complete, the pressure inside the shell
is growing, and too weak a shell would go to pieces before the maximum
pressure had been attained. Thus much of the energy of the explosion
would simply be liberated into the air instead of being employed in
hurling the fragments of shell with enormous force.

That is, of course, not a complete explanation of the whole action of a
high-explosive shell, but it indicates generally the reason why a
special quality of steel is required in order to get the best results.

Steel having been dealt with in another chapter, we will pass to the
other metals which play important if not essential parts in the
production of modern projectiles. So important are several of these that
the lack of one or two of them would, under modern conditions, mean
certain defeat for a nation.

Let us first of all take copper, of which is made the driving bands of
the shells and which in combination with zinc forms brass of which noses
and other important parts are made.

Its ore is found in many parts of the world, notably in the United
States, Chile and Spain. The ores are of several kinds, the simpler ones
to deal with being oxides and carbonates of copper, meaning compounds
of copper with oxygen and with oxygen and carbon respectively.

It will be remembered that ores of iron are usually of the same nature,
namely, oxides and carbonates, and consequently we find that the method
of obtaining copper from these ores resembles the methods employed to
obtain iron from its ores.

The ore is thrown into a large furnace, like the blast furnaces of the
ironworks, and in the heat of the fire the bonds between copper and
oxygen are loosened and the superior attractions of the carbon in the
fuel entice the oxygen away, leaving the metal comparatively pure.

Unfortunately, however, copper is found most plentifully in combination
with sulphur with which it forms what is termed sulphide. This copper
sulphide is called by miners "copper pyrites." Another trouble is that
mixed with the copper pyrites there is usually more or less of iron
pyrites, or sulphate of iron, so that to obtain the copper not only has
the sulphur to be got rid of but also the iron. This complicates the
operations very much, the ore having to be subjected to repeated
roastings and meltings during which the sulphur passes off in the form
of sulphur dioxide (a material from which sulphuric acid can be
obtained), leaving oxygen in its place. Thus the copper sulphide becomes
copper oxide, after which the oxygen is carried away by carbon, leaving
the relatively pure metal. Moreover, at each operation various
substances are thrown into the furnace called fluxes, which do not
mingle with the metal but float on the top in the form of slag, and
into the slag the iron passes, so that finally the copper is obtained
alone.

Zinc is another important material for shell-making. Its ores used to be
found in great plenty in Silesia, but the chief source of supply is now
Australia. It is what is called "zinc blende," and consists of zinc
sulphide, or zinc and sulphur in combination. In all these names, it may
be interesting to mention, at this point, the termination "ide"
indicates a compound of two substances, so that we can safely conclude
that the "ides" consist of the two elements named in their titles and no
others. Thus zinc sulphide is zinc and sulphur and nothing else, iron
sulphide is iron and sulphur, copper oxide is copper and oxygen, and so
on.

The blende is first roasted in huge furnaces specially built for the
purpose. To ensure its being thoroughly treated it has to be "rabbled"
or turned over and over, since otherwise all of it might not be brought
into contact with the necessary oxygen. At one time done by men with
rakes, it is now generally accomplished by mechanical means.

A description of one such furnace will be of interest. It consists of a
long rectangular building of brickwork bound together with steel
framework. Inside it is divided up into low chambers, the roof of each
forming the floor of the one above.

At intervals along its length mighty shafts of iron pass up from
underneath right through all the floors, emerging finally above the
topmost, while along underneath the furnace there runs a shaft the
action of which turns the vertical shafts slowly round and round.

Attached to the vertical shafts are long strong arms of iron, one arm to
each floor, and upon the arms are placed rabbles, as they are termed,
pieces of iron shod sometimes with fireclay, resembling most of any
familiar objects a small ploughshare.

As the arms slowly revolve, at the rate of once or twice per minute, the
arms are carried round and round and the rabbles plough up and turn over
and over the layer of ore lying upon the floor.

There are arms on the top of the furnace, too, sometimes, where the ore
is first laid so that it may be dried by the heat escaping from the
furnace beneath, an interesting example of economy effected by utilizing
heat which would otherwise be wasted.

The whole of the furnace, from end to end and on every floor, is thus
swept continually by the rotating arms with their dependent rabbles, and
the latter are cunningly shaped so that they not only turn the ore over
and over, but gradually pass it along the different floors or hearths.
It is fed automatically by a mechanical feeder which pushes it on, a
small quantity at a time, to the drying hearth on the top. Then the
rabbles take charge of it and gradually pass it from the area swept by
one shaft to that of the next until it has passed right along the top
and has become thoroughly dried. Arrived there it falls through a hole
on to the topmost hearth or floor, along which it travels by the same
means but in the contrary direction until it again falls through a hole
on to the top floor but one. And so it goes on until at last, fully
roasted, it falls from the bottom floor of the furnace into trucks or
other provision for carrying it away.

Some kinds of ore require to be heated by means of gas which is
generated in a "gas-producer" near by. In others, however, the sulphur
in the ore acts as the fuel, and so the furnace, having been once
started, can be kept up for long periods without the expenditure of any
coal at all. Very little attention is needed by furnaces such as these,
so that with no fuel to pay for and very little labour, they are
extremely economical.

Owing to the great heat, too, the arms would stand a very good chance of
getting melted were they not kept cool by a continual stream of water
flowing through the shafts and arms. This furnishes a continual supply
of hot water which is sometimes used for other purposes in the works.

The process of roasting, whether carried on in furnaces such as these or
not, results in the formation of oxide instead of sulphide; in other
words, the sulphur is turned out and oxygen takes its place. The
dislodged sulphur then joins up with some more oxygen and forms sulphur
dioxide, which can be led away to the sulphuric acid plant and there, by
union with water, turned into that extremely valuable substance,
sulphuric acid.

We cannot, however, treat zinc oxide as we would iron oxide or copper
oxide, for zinc is volatile, and so, instead of accumulating in the
bottom of a blast furnace as the iron and copper do, would pass off up
the chimney.

The oxide is therefore mixed with coal or some other form of carbon and
placed in retorts made of fireclay. These retorts are fixed in rows one
above the other like the retorts at a gasworks, and hot gases from a
gas-producer down below pass around and among them. To the mouth of each
retort is fitted a condenser, also made of fireclay.

Now what happens in the retorts is this: the heat loosens the bonds
between the zinc and the oxide, the latter passing into union with some
carbon from the coal. The zinc at the same time becomes vapour and
passes into the condenser, the lower temperature of which turns it into
a liquid which the workmen remove at intervals in ladles. On being
poured into moulds and allowed to solidify this metal is called by the
name of "spelter," which bears to zinc the same relation that pig-iron
does to the more highly developed forms of iron. Spelter is simply zinc
in its crudest form.

Tin, although less important in war than copper and zinc, plays a not
unimportant part. It has been found for centuries in Cornwall. The
Romans used to trade with the natives of Britain for tin. Although
considerable quantities of it is still obtained from there, the greatest
tin-producing country of all at present is the Federated Malay States.
Australia also furnishes ore, as does Bolivia and Nigeria.

In Cornwall the ore occurs as rock in veins or lodes filling up what
must once have been fissures in granite rocks. That near the surface has
long been taken, so that to-day the mines are very deep and costly to
work. Some can only afford to operate when the market price of tin is
above a certain limit. Much of the ore from the newer districts--the
Malay States, for example--is in small fragments mixed with gravel in
beds near the surface. Such is called alluvial or stream tin, since the
deposits were undoubtedly put in their present position by streams or
rivers. So long as they last these easily accessible alluvial deposits
will always be cheaper to work than the deep mines. On the other hand,
they may give out, and recent explorations underground seem to indicate
that there is still much valuable ore not only of tin but of other
metals too, to be obtained from the old mines of Cornwall.

The ore of tin, like so many other ores, is generally oxide. It is first
roasted to expel sulphur and arsenic which are often present as
impurities, and then it is melted in a reverberatory furnace such as
that described for the manufacture of wrought iron. As usual, the oxygen
combines with carbon, the impurities form slag which floats on the top,
and the pure metal falls to the bottom of the furnace from whence it can
be drawn off.

Mixed with or in the neighbourhood of tin ore there is sometimes found
another mineral called wolfram, which plays an extremely important part
in modern warfare, so much so that the British and other Governments
engaged in the war were at times hard put to it to find enough. Its
value resides in the fact that it contains tungsten, an element which
has wonderful powers in hardening steel.

It consists of tungsten and oxygen, but is not an oxide since there is
also iron in the partnership. This fact is very useful, however, since
it enables the particles of wolfram to be picked out from the mass of
other stuff among which they are found by a magnet.

There are some very wonderful machines called magnetic separators, made
for this express purpose. In one, with which I am familiar, there is an
endless band stretched horizontally upon two rollers. One of the rollers
being driven round the belt travels along so that the mineral being fed
on to it in a stream is carried along under several magnets. These
magnets are very different from the ordinary magnet, inasmuch as they
are revolving. We might almost describe them as small magnetized
flywheels. As they spin round they pick up slightly the particles of ore
which contain iron, but have no effect at all upon those which do not
contain iron. They do not actually lift the particles up on to
themselves: they just exercise a slight pull upon them, and by virtue of
the fact that they are revolving, pull them off the band and throw them
to one side. The wheels can be set closer or farther from the belt at
will so as to make them act more or less strongly, and thus the most
magnetic particles can be separated from those less magnetic, these
latter being still kept separate from the wholly non-magnetic particles.
Thus by simple and purely mechanical means are the precious bits of
wolfram obtained from the other less valuable or worthless minerals with
which they are mixed.

The same method is used with other minerals besides wolfram: it can be
applied to all those which exhibit in some small degree the magnetic
properties which we usually associate with iron.

This sorting out of one mineral from others continually crops up in
connection with nearly all the metals except iron. Iron is practically
the only one whose ore occurs in vast masses which need simply to be dug
up and thrown into the furnace. The others, where they occur as rock in
veins, have to be crushed to detach what is wanted from what is not
wanted, and then the two have to be sorted in some way. Magnetic
separation is but one of these ways. Another takes advantage of the fact
that we seldom find two things together which have precisely the same
specific gravity. Consequently, if we throw the mixture on to a shaking
table the heavier particles will behave differently from the lighter
ones and the two will separate. The same result can be obtained by
throwing the mixture into a stream of water, the water acting
differently upon the lighter and upon the heavier particles. Another way
which may be mentioned is founded upon the fact that some things can be
readily wetted with oil while others throw the oil off and refuse to be
wetted by it. If a mixture of these two sorts of thing be stirred
violently in a suitable oily liquid the former will be found eventually
in the froth, while the latter will sink to the bottom. All these
different methods are employed, as they are found necessary in preparing
the ores of the various metals to which we have been referring.

Except in the case of alluvial ores which have been broken already by
the action of ancient streams of water, nearly all ores (except iron)
have to be crushed before the ores can be separated out. Some of this
work is done by the very simplest contrivances, showing how in some
cases invention has almost come to a stop through the machines having
been reduced to their simplest form. A notable instance of this is the
stamp mill, in which heavy timbers are lifted up by machinery and then
allowed to slide down upon the ore, just like gigantic pestles. More
elaborate grinding machines are sometimes used, however, but it is
impossible to mention them all here.

The action of sorting out the fragments of ore from the miscellaneous
assortment of crushed rocks is termed "concentrating," and the sorted
ores are called "concentrates."

Another metal which has proved itself of immense importance in war is
aluminium, and it fittingly comes at the close of the list since it is
dealt with in a manner peculiar to itself. Practically all the others
are obtained from their ores by means of heat and heat alone. Aluminium
is obtained by electricity acting in the process called electrolysis.

It is surprising to learn that aluminium is one of the very commonest
things on the face of the earth. Clay and many common rocks are very
largely made of it. Clay, to be precise, is a silicate of alumina, a
term which is interesting when it is explained. Silica is the name given
to oxide of silicon. Sand is mostly silica. Alumina, too, is oxide of
aluminium. Silicate of alumina is a combination of the two.

Any clay, therefore, could be used as an ore from which to obtain
aluminium, but of course there are certain minerals specially suitable
for the purpose, since in them the metal is plentiful and easily
extracted.

In another chapter reference is made to the production of caustic soda
from a solution of common salt by electrolysis. The same principle,
precisely, is used to obtain the metal aluminium from its ore, which is
generally an oxide.

Common salt, let me remind you, is sodium and chlorine combined. When
you dissolve it in water it becomes ionized, which means that each
molecule of salt splits up into two ions one of which is electrically
positive and the other electrically negative. Then, when we introduce
two electrodes into the solution and connect them to a battery or
dynamo, all the positive ions go to one electrode and all the negative
ions to the other.

We cannot dissolve aluminium ore in water, but we can in a bath of
molten cryolite, and for some reason or other, whether because of the
heat or not we cannot say, the ore becomes ionized, the aluminium atoms
being one sort and the oxygen atoms the other sort. These ions then sort
themselves out, the oxygen ions being taken into combination with the
carbon rod which forms the positive electrode, while the metal ions
collect upon the negative electrode. Since this latter is a slab of
carbon which forms the bottom of the vessel in which the process is
carried on, the result is that pure aluminium gradually accumulates in
the bottom of the vessel and can be drawn off from time to time.

Aluminium is always produced in places where electric power can be
obtained cheaply, such as near waterfalls.



CHAPTER XII

MEASURING THE VELOCITY OF A SHELL


In at least two of the preceding chapters of this book reference has
been made to the speed at which a shell fired from a gun travels through
the air. Such velocities as 3,000 feet per second have been mentioned in
this connection, and some readers are sure to have wondered how such
measurements could possibly be made. Possibly some sceptics have even
supposed that they were not measured at all but simply estimated in some
way or other. They are actually measured, however, and by very simple
and ingenious means.

Needless to say, electricity plays a very important part in this
wonderful achievement. In fact, without the aid of electricity it is
difficult to see how it could be done at all.

People often ask how quickly electricity travels, as if when we sent a
telegraph signal along a wire a little bullet, so to speak, of
electricity were shot along the wire like the carriers of the pneumatic
tubes in the big drapers' shops. That is quite a misconception, for in
reality the circuit of wire is more like a pipe full of electricity, and
when we set a current flowing what we do is to set the whole of that
electricity moving at once. If we think of a circular tube full of water
with a pump at one spot in the circuit, we see that as soon as the water
begins to move anywhere it moves everywhere. Moreover, if it stops at
one point it stops simultaneously at every other point. While
practically this is the case it is theoretically not quite so, for the
inertia of the water when it is suddenly started or stopped no doubt
causes a slight distortion of the tube itself resulting in a very slight
(quite imperceptible) retardation of the movement of the water.
Electricity also has a property comparable to the inertia which we are
familiar with in the objects around us, and there is also a property in
every conductor which to a certain extent resembles the elasticity of
the water-pipe, whereby it may for a moment be bulged out. In a short
wire, however (up to a mile or so), particularly if the flow and return
parts of the circuit be twisted together, this electrical inertia
practically vanishes and consequently we may say that for all practical
purposes the current starts or stops, as the case may be, at precisely
the same moment in every part of the circuit.

That fact is of great value when, as in the case we are now discussing,
we want to compare very exactly two events occurring very near together
as to time but far apart as to place.

[Illustration: BOMB-THROWERS AT WORK.

Many kinds of bombs are used. One has a metal head and a handle about a
foot long, with a streamer to ensure correct flight; another form
resembles a brush when it is flying through the air; and a third, known
as "the egg," is oval in form.]

We need to compare the time when the shell leaves the gun with the time
when it passes another point, say, one hundred yards away, and then
again another point, say one hundred yards further on still. Supposing,
then, a velocity of 3,000 feet per second, the time interval between the
first point and the second and between the second and third will be
somewhere about a tenth of a second. So we shall need a timepiece of
some sort which will not only measure a tenth of a second, but will
measure for us a very small _difference_ between two periods, each of
which is only about a tenth of a second and which will be very nearly
alike. That represents a degree of accuracy exceeding even what the
astronomers, those princes of measurers, are accustomed to.

This exceedingly delicate timepiece is found in a falling weight. So
long as the thing is so heavy that the air resistance is negligible, we
can calculate with the greatest nicety how long a weight has taken to
fall through a given distance.

Near the muzzle of the gun there is set up a frame upon which are
stretched a number of wires so close together that a shell cannot get
past without breaking at least one of them. These wires are connected
together so as to form one, and through them there flows a current of
electricity the action of which, through an electro-magnet in the
instrument house, holds up a long lead weight.

At some distance away, say one hundred yards, there is a similar frame
also electrically connected to an electro-magnet in the same instrument
house. This second magnet, when energized by current from the frame,
holds back a sharp point which, under the action of a spring, tends to
press forward and scratch the lead weight. The third frame is likewise
connected to a third magnet controlling a point similar to the other.

To commence with, current flows through all three frames so that all
three magnets are energized. The gun is then fired and immediately the
shell breaks a wire in the first frame, cutting off the current from the
first magnet and allowing the weight to fall. Meanwhile, the shell
reaches the second frame, breaking a wire there, with the result that
the second magnet loses its power, lets go the point which it has been
holding back and permits it to make a light scratch upon the falling
weight. This action is followed almost immediately by a similar action
on the part of the third magnet, resulting in a second scratch on the
lead weight.

The position of these two scratches on the weight and their distance
apart gives a very accurate indication of the time taken by the shell to
pass from the first screen to the second and from the second to the
third. From those times it is possible to calculate the initial velocity
of the shell and the speed at which it will move in any part of its
course. Indeed, with those two times as data, it is possible to work out
all that it is necessary to know about the behaviour of the shell.

This is rendered practicable by the fact that the moment the wire is cut
the magnet lets go, no matter what the distance of the screen from the
instrument may be. But for the instantaneous action of the current,
allowance of some sort would have to be made for the fact that one
screen is farther than another and the whole problem would be made much
more complicated.

Even as it is, someone may urge that the magnets themselves possess
inertia and will not let go quite instantaneously, but that can be
overcome by making the magnets all alike so that the inertia will affect
all equally. It is only necessary to have a switch which will break all
the three circuits at the same moment (quite an easy thing to arrange)
and then adjust all three magnets so that when this is operated they act
simultaneously. After that they can be relied upon to do their duty
quite accurately.

Thus by a method which in its details is quite simple is this seemingly
impossible measurement taken.



CHAPTER XIII

SOME ADJUNCTS IN THE ENGINE ROOM


Before we deal with the subject of the engines employed in warfare, it
may be interesting to mention two beautiful little inventions which have
been made in connection with them.

Let us take first of all a contrivance which tells almost at a glance
the amount of work which the engines of a ship are doing.

As everyone knows, there is in every ship (except those few which are
propelled by paddles) a long steel shaft, called the tail-shaft, which
runs from the engine situated somewhere near amidships to the propeller
at the stern. Many ships, of course, have several propellers, and then
there are several shafts. Now each of these shafts is a thick strong
steel rod supported at intervals in bearings. If anyone were told that,
in working, that shaft became more or less twisted, he would be tempted
to think he was being made fun of. Yet such is literally the case. The
thick strong massive bar becomes actually twisted by the turning action
of the engine at one end and the resistance of the propeller at the
other. And the amount of that twisting is a measure of the work which
the engine is doing. The puzzle is how to measure it while the engine
is running, for of course the twist comes out of it as soon as the
engine stops.

A space on the shaft is selected, between two bearings, for the fixing
of the apparatus. Near to each bearing there is fitted on to the shaft a
metal disc with a small hole in it. On one of the bearings is fixed a
lamp and on the other a telescope. When the engine is at rest and there
is no twist in the shaft, all these four things--the lamp, the two
holes, and the telescope--are in line. Consequently, on looking through
the telescope the light is visible. But when the engine is at work and
the shaft is more or less twisted one of the holes gets out of line and
it becomes impossible to see the light through the telescope. A slight
adjustment of the telescope, however, brings all four into line again,
which adjustment can be easily made by a screw motion provided for the
purpose. And the amount of adjustment that is found necessary forms a
measure of the amount of the twisting which the shaft suffers and that
again tells the number of horse-power which the engine is putting into
its work.

But it is also necessary to know how fast the engine is working. There
are many devices which will tell this, of which the speedometer on a
motor-car is a familiar example. Most of those work on the centrifugal
principle, the instrument actually measuring not the speed but the
centrifugal force resulting from the speed, which amounts to the same
thing. There is one instrument, however, which operates on quite a
different principle, because of which it is specially interesting. It
consists of a nice-looking wooden box with a glass front. Through the
glass one sees a row of little white knobs. If this be placed somewhere
near the engine while it is at work immediately one of the knobs
commences to move rapidly up and down, so that it looks no longer like a
knob but is elongated into a white band. There is no visible connection
between the instrument and the engine, yet the number over that
particular knob which becomes thus agitated indicates the speed of the
engine.

Let us in imagination open the case and we shall find that the knobs are
attached to the ends of a number of light steel springs set in a row.
The springs are all precisely alike except for their length, in which
respect no two are alike. Indeed, as you proceed from one side of the
instrument to the other each succeeding one is a little longer than the
previous one. Now a spring has a certain speed at which it naturally
vibrates and other things being equal that speed depends upon its
length. You can, of course, force any spring to vibrate at any speed if
you care to take the trouble, but each one has its own natural speed at
which it will vibrate under very slight provocation.

Every engine is, of course, made to run as smoothly as possible. All
revolving or reciprocating parts are for this reason carefully balanced
and in turbines the whole moving part, since it is round and
symmetrical, naturally approaches a condition of perfect balance. Hence
every engine ought to run perfectly smoothly. As a matter of fact,
however, no engine ever does. There are certain limitations to man's
skill and at the high speed of a fast-running engine, such as is to be
found on a destroyer, for example, some little irregularity is sure to
make itself felt by a slight vibration in the floor. It may be hardly
perceptible to the senses, but to a spring whose natural frequency
happens to be just that same speed or nearly so, it will be very
apparent and in a few seconds that spring will be responding quite
vigorously.

It is another example of the principle of resonance, which is employed
so finely in making wireless telegraph apparatus selective. Every
wireless apparatus is made to have a certain natural frequency of its
own and it therefore picks up readily those signals which proceed from
another station having the same frequency while ignoring those from
others. In just the same way a reed or spring in this speed-indicator
picks up and responds to impulses derived from the engine only when they
are of a frequency corresponding with its own natural frequency. Hence,
one spring out of the whole range responds to the vibrations of the
engine while the others remain almost if not entirely unaffected.

In another form, the springs are actuated electrically. A magnet, or a
series of magnets, is arranged so that as the engine turns the magnets
pass successively near to a coil of wire, thereby inducing currents in
that wire. They form, in fact, a small dynamo or generator, generating
one impulse per revolution or two or three or whatever number may be
most convenient. Then the current from this is led round the coil of a
long electro-magnet placed just under the free ends of all the springs.
The magnet therefore gives a series of pulls, at regular intervals, and
the rapidity of those pulls will depend upon the speed of the engine,
while the frequency of them will be registered by the movement of one or
other of the springs.

This instrument can also be employed to determine the speed of aeroplane
motors and, in fact, any kind of engine, especially those whose speed is
very high.



CHAPTER XIV

ENGINES OF WAR


The phrase which I have used for the title of this chapter is often
given a very wide meaning which includes all kinds and varieties of
devices used in warfare. In this case I am giving it its narrower sense,
taking it to indicate the steam-engines and oil-engines which are
employed to drive our battleships, cruisers and destroyers, our
submarines and our aircraft. They are inventions of the highest
importance, which have played a large part in shaping modern warfare.

The type of engine almost invariably used on ships of war other than
submarines is the steam turbine. Great Britain, for the most part, uses
that particular kind associated with the name of the Hon. Sir C. A.
Parsons, while the United States rather favour the Curtiss machine.
Other nations have adopted either one of these or else something very
similar.

All turbines are very simple in their principle, far more so that the
older type of steam-engine, called, because the essential parts of it
move to and fro, the "reciprocating" steam-engine.

In these latter machines there are a number of cylinders with closed
ends and with very smooth interiors, in each of which slides a disc-like
object called a piston. The steam enters a cylinder first at one end
and then at the other, thus pushing the piston to and fro. The movement
of the piston is communicated to the outside by means of a rod which
passes through a hole in the cover at one end of the cylinder, the to
and fro motion being converted into a round and round motion by a
connecting-rod and crank just as the up and down motion of a cyclist's
knees is converted into a round and round motion by the lower leg and
the crank. The lower part of a cyclist's leg is, indeed, a very accurate
illustration of what the connecting-rod of a steam-engine is.

As is evident to the hastiest observer, some arrangement has to be made
whereby the steam shall be led first into one end and then into the other
end of the cylinder: also that provision shall be made for letting the
steam out again when it has done its work. Moreover, such arrangements
must be automatic. Hence, every reciprocating engine has special valves
for this purpose and such valves need rods and cranks (or something
equivalent) to operate them. Further, to get the best results the steam
must not simply be passed through one cylinder but through several in
succession. Engines where the steam goes through only one cylinder are
called "simple," where it goes through two they are "compound," where
three "triple-expansion," where four "quadruple-expansion." Generally
speaking, each cylinder has its own connecting-rod and crank, also its
own set of rods, etc., for working its valves. Hence, a high-class marine
reciprocating engine is of necessity a complicated mass of cylinders,
rods, cranks and other moving parts continually swinging round or to and
fro at considerable speeds, all needing oiling and attention and all
liable at times to give trouble.

And now compare that with the turbine, which has TWO parts, only one of
which moves. That part, moreover, is tightly shut up inside the other
one, being thereby protected from any chance of damage from outside and
likewise rendered unable to inflict any damage upon those in attendance
upon it.

At first sight it seems very strange that the turbine should be the
newer of the two, for it is simply an improved form of the old
time-honoured picturesque windmill which used to top every hill and
grind the corn for every village and hamlet.

The old windmill had four sails against which the wind blew, driving the
whole four round as everyone knows. The new turbine has a great many
sails, only we now call them blades, and the steam blows them round. The
old windmill had to have another smaller set of sails at the back for
the purpose of keeping the main sails always in that position in which
they would catch the full force of the breeze. In the turbine we need
not do that, for we shut the windmill up in a kind of tunnel and cause
the steam to blow in at one end and out at the other.

The difference between the various kinds of turbine lies simply in the
manner in which the steam is guided in its passage through the machine.

After that general description we can take a more detailed view of the
Parsons turbine. The casing or fixed part is a huge iron box suitably
shaped for standing firmly and rigidly upon the floor of the
engine-room. It is made in two halves, the upper of which can be easily
lifted off when necessary. Often, indeed, this upper half is hinged to
the lower, so that it can be opened like the lid of a box.

Inside, the casing is cylindrical, comparatively small at one end but
increasing by steps till it is very much larger at the other end. At
each end is a bearing or support in which the rotor or moving part is
held and in which it can turn freely.

The rotor or part which rotates is a strong steel forging shaped
somewhat to follow the lines of the inside of the casing. It does not
entirely fill the casing but leaves a space all round and all the way
along, which space is intended to accommodate the blades. The ends of
the rotor are smaller than the body since they are intended to fit into
the bearings, and one of the ends is prolonged so as to be available for
coupling to the propeller-shaft of the ship.

At one end of the casing, the smaller one, is the steam inlet and the
steam after emerging from it passes along till it finds its way out at a
very large outlet formed at the bigger end. On its way it has to pass
thousands of small blades so that the progress of each individual
particle of steam is not a straight line but a continual zigzag. There
are rings of blades round the rotor, tightly fixed to its surface. There
are likewise rings of blades affixed to the inner surface of the casing,
the rings upon the casing coming in the spaces between the rings on the
rotor.

Let us imagine that we can see through the casing of a turbine at work
and that looking down upon it from above we can trace the progress of a
particle of steam. It rushes in from the inlet and at once makes
straight for the outlet at the further end. Suddenly, however, it
encounters one of the guide blades (those on the case) and by it is
deflected to one side, we will suppose the left. That causes it to rush
straight at one of the blades upon the rotor against which it strikes
violently, giving that blade a distinct and definite push to the left.
Rebounding, it then comes back towards the right but quickly is caught
by another guide blade and by it hurled back upon a second rotor blade,
giving it a leftward push just as it did to the first. Thus it goes
zigzagging from one set of blades to the other until, tired out, so to
speak, it finally flows away forceless and feeble through the outlet,
having given up all its energy to the blades of the rotor against which
it has struck in its course.

That, then, is the journey of one single particle. Multiply that by an
unknown number of millions and you have a description of what takes
place in the interior of a steam turbine. The blades are so
proportioned, so arranged and so placed that it is very difficult indeed
for a particle of steam to creep past without doing its share of work.
Practically every one is made use of and while, of course, the action of
a single particle of steam would have but a negligible effect, the vast
number engaged cause the rotor to be powerfully blown round.

The reason why the casing and rotor are made larger and larger as one
proceeds from the inlet towards the exhaust or outlet is that the steam
must, if all its energy is to be extracted, expand as it goes and the
enlargement provides room for this expansion.

One of the great advantages of the turbine is that the steam is always
entering at the same end. In the cylinder of a reciprocating engine the
steam enters alternately. It comes in hot but as it does its work and
finally goes out it becomes very much cooler: the next lot of steam
which enters, therefore, is chilled by the cool walls of the cylinder
which have just been cooled by the departure of the previous lot of
steam: so heat is wasted. Wasted heat means fuel lost, and as any given
ship can only carry a limited quantity of fuel, wasted heat means less
range and more frequent returns to the base to coal or to "oil."

Also let me remark again upon the simplicity of the turbine as opposed
to the other sort. The latter consists of a mass of moving and swaying
rods and cranks, to work among which, as the engineers have to do, is a
terrifying and nerve-racking experience. The turbine, on the other hand,
has its only working part enclosed. It is difficult to tell, by looking
at it, whether a turbine is at work or not, so silent and still is it,
so self-contained. The reciprocating engine-room is noisy and full of
turmoil: the turbine room is weirdly still by comparison.

On the whole, too, it makes better use of the steam which it uses, but
it has one decided drawback. It will not reverse, which the other type
of engine does readily.

This means that two turbines have to be coupled together, one with the
blades so set that the steam drives it round correctly to produce
motion ahead and the other set the opposite way so that it drives the
vessel astern. The steam can be sent through either turbine at will and
so motion can be obtained in either direction. Whichever turbine is in
use the other revolves idly.

Unfortunately it is impossible to make a turbine to go slowly and yet be
efficient. Consequently, slow steamers cannot use turbines, but for
warships, which are nearly all fast boats, it has almost displaced the
older type of engine.

The Curtiss turbine is different from the Parsons in that the steam
encounters periodically, in its passage through, a partition perforated
with funnel-shaped holes. Between the partitions it passes blades upon
which it acts just as already described. The chief effect of this is to
permit the machine being made of a rather more convenient shape and
size. Other varieties of turbine are more or less combinations of the
two ideas underlying these two.

When we look at a locomotive in motion we always see steam coming out of
the funnel, but we never see that in the case of a steamer. That is
because all the energy of the steam is taken and used in the latter
case, while in the former much valuable energy goes off up the funnel,
making a puffing noise instead of doing useful work.

On the steamship the steam is led not to the open air but to a vessel
called a condenser the walls of which are kept cool by a continual
circulation of cold water. The steam on entering the condenser at once
collapses into water, leaving a vacuum. A pump called the "air-pump"
removes the water (which was once steam) from the condenser and also any
air which might get in, with the result that the engine is always
discharging its steam into a vacuum. Thus to the pressure of the steam
is added the suction of the vacuum.

In turbine ships the cooling water for the condensers is circulated by
powerful centrifugal pumps driven by subsidiary engines.

The steam is obtained from boilers of that special variety known as
"water-tube."

The boilers with which most people are familiar are either Lancashire or
Cornish, both sorts being large steel cylinders with two steel flues in
the former and one in the latter running from back to front. The fire is
made in the front part of the flue and the hot gases from it pass to the
back and then along the sides and underneath through flues formed in the
brickwork in which the boiler is set. Locomotive boilers, however, have
no flues, but the hot gases from the fire in the fire-box pass through
tubes which run from end to end through the cylindrical shell, each tube
starting from the fire-box behind and terminating in the smoke-box in
front. Thus we have tubes with fire inside and water outside: hence such
boilers are called "fire-tube" boilers.

On many ships of the merchant type cylindrical boilers are used which
combine the features, to some extent, of the Cornish and the fire-tube,
since there is a flue running from front to back in which the fire is
made and the hot gases return from back to front through a number of
tubes which occupy the space above the fire. Arrived at the front the
gases pass upwards to the chimney.

Water-tube boilers are different from all of these, since in them the
water is inside the tubes while the fires play around the outside. This
enables steam to be got up very quickly, a matter of much importance for
a warship which may be called upon to undertake some operation at a
moment's notice.

The boilers are fed with water from the condensers, so that the same
water is used over and over again. When coal is burnt it is put on the
fires by hand, for although mechanical stoking is a great success on
land, there are special difficulties which prevent its use at sea. It is
becoming more and more the fashion now to burn oil instead of coal in
several types of ships and in those cases the oil is blown in the form
of spray into the furnace. This has many advantages, some of which are
exemplified on a small scale by the difference between using a coal fire
and a gas stove. Like the latter, the oil spray can be quickly lit when
needed and as quickly extinguished. It can be regulated and adjusted
with equal facility. Oil can be taken on board too through a pipe,
silently and quickly and without the terrible dirt and the exhausting
labour involved in coaling a big ship. Oil, too, can be taken on board
at sea, from a tank steamer, almost as easily as it can be taken in
ashore, whereas the difficulty of coaling at sea despite many ingenious
efforts has never been solved quite satisfactorily. Finally, oil can be
stowed anywhere, for the stokers do not need to dig it out with a
shovel. Therefore it can be carried in those spaces between the inner
and outer bottoms which have to be there in order to give strength to
the ship's hull but which would be quite useless for carrying coal. The
advantages of oil fuel, therefore, are many and no doubt it will be used
more and more as time goes on.

For Great Britain, oil fuel has the disadvantage that it has to be
imported whereas the finest steam coal in the world is found in
abundance in South Wales, but the difficulty may eventually be overcome
by distilling from native coal an oil which will serve as well as that
which is now imported.

So much for the turbine, the engine of the big ships: now for the Diesel
oil-engine which drives the submarines. It belongs to that family of
engines called "internal-combustion" since in them the fuel is burnt
actually inside the cylinder and not under a separate contrivance such
as a boiler. There have been oil-engines, so called, for many years, but
they were really gas-engines since the oil was first heated till it
turned into vapour and then that vapour was used as a gas. The Diesel
engine, however, actually burns oil in its liquid state.

To understand how it works let me ask you to conjure up this little
picture before your mind's eye. A hollow iron cylinder is fixed in a
vertical position: its upper end is closed but its lower end is open:
inside it is a piston, free to slide up and down: by means of a
connecting-rod hinged to it and passing downwards through the open lower
end the piston is connected to a crank and flywheel. At the upper end of
the cylinder are certain openings which can be covered and uncovered in
succession by the action of suitable valves.

Now let us assume that that engine is at work, the piston going rapidly
up and down in the cylinder. As it goes down it draws in a quantity of
air through a valve which opens to admit the air at just the right
moment. The moment the piston reverses its movement and starts to go up
again that valve closes and the air is entrapped. The piston continues
to rise, however, with the result that the air becomes compressed in the
upper part of the cylinder.

Now it is necessary to remind you at this point that compressing air or
indeed any gas, raises its temperature. This air, therefore, which was
drawn in at the temperature of the outer atmosphere, by the time the
piston has reached the top of its stroke has attained a temperature well
above the ignition point of the oil fuel.

The piston, having arrived at the top of its stroke, the upper part of
the cylinder is filled with hot compressed air: the next moment the
piston commences its descent, but at precisely that same moment a valve
opens and there is projected into the cylinder a spray of oil. Instantly
it bursts into flame, heating the air still more, so that as the piston
descends the air, expanding with the heat, pushes strongly and steadily
upon it. The amount of that push can be varied by varying the duration
of the jet. The longer the jet is injected the more heat is generated
and the more sustained is the push. On the other hand, if the jet is
cut off very quickly the push is only a gentle one.

The power of the engine can thus be adjusted to suit varying
circumstances by a slight variation in the valve which controls the jet.

The piston having thus been driven down to the limit of its stroke, it
commences another upward movement, at which moment another valve opens
and lets out the hot waste gases which have resulted from the burning of
the oil. Thus the cylinder is cleaned out ready for a fresh supply of
pure air to be drawn in on the next ensuing downstroke.

The engine thus works upon a series or cycle of operations which are
repeated automatically over and over again. First comes a downstroke,
drawing in air: then an upstroke, compressing it: then a second
downstroke, during which the fuel burns and the power is generated: and,
finally, a second upstroke during which the waste products of the
burning are ejected. Power, it will be noticed, is only developed in one
out of the four strokes: the other movements having, in single cylinder
engines, to be performed by the momentum of the flywheel.

In most cases, however, the engine has several cylinders in which the
cycles are arranged to follow in succession. Thus, if there are four
cylinders, there is always power being developed by one of them.

The valves are operated automatically by the engine itself just as is
the case with steam-engines. The engine also works a small pump which
provides the very highly compressed air necessary to blow the oil jet
into the cylinder.

Arrangements are often provided whereby the engine when working stores
up a reserve of compressed air which can be used to start it. From the
very nature of its working such an engine cannot develop power until it
has accomplished at least four strokes or two revolutions, so that it
cannot possibly start itself. If, however, compressed air be admitted to
the cylinders to give it a vigorous push or two and so get it going, it
can then take up its own work and go on indefinitely.

In some cases this is not necessary and that of an engine in a submarine
is one of them. In that instance, the electric motor, which drives the
boat when submerged, can be made to give the engine a start.

By altering the rotation in which the valves act the direction can be
reversed. A very simple mechanism can be made to effect this change, so
that reversing is quite easy.

Aircraft are mostly, if not entirely, driven by petrol engines, some of
which are very little different from those of a motor-car or
motor-cycle.

These motor-car engines are so well known that little need be said about
them. It may be well to explain, however, that they, like the Diesel
engines, work on a cycle of four strokes, as follows:--

  First stroke (down) draws in a mixture of air and gas.

  Second stroke (up) compresses the mixture. Just at the top of this
    stroke an electric spark fires the mixture, causing an explosion
    which drives the piston downwards, thus making the

  Third stroke (down), during which the power is developed.

  Fourth stroke (up) expels the waste products of the explosion.

Although all of them work on this same cycle, in which they resemble the
engines of the motor-car, there are several much-used types of
aero-engine in which the mechanical arrangement of the parts is quite
different. Of these the best known is the famous Gnome engine which has
a considerable number of cylinders arranged around a centre like the
spokes of a wheel. The centre is in fact a case which covers the crank,
and the cylinders are placed in relation to it just as the spokes are
placed around the hub of a wheel.

There is only one crank and all the connecting-rods drive on to it.
Owing to their position around it they thus act in succession, giving a
nice regular turning effort.

Further, these engines differ from all others in that the crank is a
fixture while the rest of the engine goes round, exactly the opposite of
what we are accustomed to. The engine, in fact, constitutes its own
flywheel. Rushing thus through the air, the cylinders tend to keep
themselves cool, doing away with the need for cooling water and
radiators. Consequently engines of this type are the very lightest known
in proportion to their horse-power. A fifty horse-power engine can be
easily carried by one man.

It would be possible to go on much longer with this most interesting
subject of engines, but having treated the three types which are most
used in warfare, it is now time to pass on to something else.



CHAPTER XV

DESTROYERS


Except for the submarine the most prominent craft during the war has
undoubtedly been the destroyer.

All warships are in one sense destroyers, since it is their prime duty
to destroy other ships, so why should one particular kind of boat be
given this name specially? Like many other of the terms which we use it
is an abbreviation, a mere remnant of a fully descriptive title.
"Torpedo Boat Destroyer" is what these ships are called in the Navy
List.

Even that full title, however, only tells us what their original purpose
was: it leaves us very much in the dark as to the many various functions
which they perform.

The invention of the torpedo called for the construction of small boats
whereby the new weapon could be used to best advantage, and so we got
our torpedo boats. They in turn called forth another boat whose duty it
was to run down and destroy them, and in that way we get our destroyers.
From that bit of naval history we can almost see for ourselves what the
characteristics of the destroyers must be. They have to be bigger than
the torpedo boats, but as the latter were quite small the destroyers,
though larger, are still comparatively small craft, latterly of about
one thousand tons. Then they have to be very fast, in order to be able
to chase the others and, finally, they need one or two guns,
comparatively small so as not to overburden the ship and yet large
enough to dispose of anything of their own size or smaller.

Unquestionably, their greatest feature is their speed. They are the
fastest ships afloat, rivalling even a fairly fast train. Some of them
can exceed forty miles an hour. They are very active and nimble, too,
being able to turn in a comparatively small circle. For warships, too,
they are cheap, so that a commander can afford to risk losing a
destroyer when he would fear to risk another vessel. For all purposes
except the actual hard-hitting they are the most useful weapon which the
commander of the fleet possesses.

When the main fleet puts to sea a whole cloud of these smaller craft
hover round looking for submarines or for the surface torpedo boats
which might try to attack the large ships under cover of darkness, while
keeping a sharp look-out, too, for mines or any other kind of floating
danger, and thus they screen the more valuable ships.

Likewise do they convoy merchant ships sometimes, especially through
waters believed to be infested with submarines. They also sally forth on
little expeditions of their own, knowing that they can fight any craft
equally speedy and show a clean pair of heels to any heavier ships,
while by adroit use of their own torpedoes they may even "bag" a
cruiser or two.

They are pre-eminently the enemy of the submarine, for the under-water
boat is necessarily less active even when it is on the surface than they
are, so that a submarine caught by a destroyer stands a very good chance
of being rammed by it, which means that the destroyer deliberately
rushes at it, using its own bow as a ram wherewith to knock a hole in
it. Or if that be not practicable the destroyer, while dodging the
torpedo of the submarine, may plant a single well-aimed shot into its
opponent and the fight is over. A cleverly-handled destroyer appears to
have little difficulty in avoiding the comparatively slow torpedo, but
no ship ever built could avoid a properly aimed shell, two facts which
are clearly indicated by the very few cases in which, during the war, a
destroyer has succumbed to a submarine. The gun of the latter, if it has
one, is no match for the guns of the destroyer.

Naval strategy and tactics, when one thinks about them carefully, reveal
a very close resemblance to those of the football field. The destroyers
are like the forwards, quick, light and nimble, valuable chiefly because
of their ability to run swiftly and to dodge cleverly, while the heavy,
stolid backs represent the battleships in their ability to withstand the
heavy shocks of the game. Any imaginative boy will be able to carry this
simile farther still and a comparison of the description of the battle
of Jutland with his own knowledge of the game will reveal a surprising
parallelism.

Thus the reader will to a very large extent be able to see for himself
the manifold uses to which these wonderful little ships lend themselves,
and he will see that above everything else it is their speed which
counts, which fact gives us the key to their peculiar construction.

To commence with, they are made as light as possible. The material used
is different from that of ordinary ships, being "high-tensile" steel, a
steel into which a little more carbon than usual is introduced,
resulting in about 50 per cent higher tensile strength but also
involving, alas! rather more brittleness. When made of this material the
whole framework of the vessel can be made of lighter beams and the
covering can be of thinner plates than would be the case if the mild
steel ordinarily employed for shipbuilding were used. The high-tensile
steel is lighter for a given strength and therefore a ship built of it
is lighter than it would otherwise have to be.

Besides the use of this particular material every resource in the way of
ingenuity and skill on the part of the designers is bent towards saving
weight. No unnecessary part is ever put in, but, on the other hand,
necessaries are skinned down to the utmost limit consistent with safety
in order to produce a light ship. How difficult this problem is is
hardly realized until one thinks of the conditions which prevail when a
ship floats in the water. The upward support of the water is exerted in
a fairly regular way all along the ship while the weights inside which
are pressing downward are concentrated in lumps. The engines, for
example, represent a very heavy weight concentrated in one fairly
confined spot. Thus the vessel has to have sufficient stiffness to
resist the action of these opposing forces which are thus tending to
break her in two. That, moreover, occurs in the stillest water; when the
sea is rough still worse stresses are brought to bear upon the
comparatively fragile hull, for a wave may lift each end, leaving the
middle more or less unsupported, or one may lift the middle while the
ends to a certain extent are left overhanging. All this, too, is in
addition to the knocks and buffets caused by huge volumes of water being
flung against the ship by cross seas in the height of a tempest. In the
case of ordinary ships where speed is not of such great importance, the
problem is simplified by the use of what is termed a high "factor of
safety," which means that the designers calculate these forces as nearly
as they can and then make the structure _amply_ strong enough. In other
words, care is taken to keep well on the safe side. In a destroyer,
however, there is no room for such a margin of safety. Risks have to be
taken, and it is only the high degree of skill and experience possessed
by our ship designers which enable these light ships to be made with, as
experience shows, a very considerable degree of safety. They have to be
continually choosing between strength on the one hand and lightness on
the other and the way in which they combine the two is marvellous.

The weight thus saved is used for carrying engines, boilers and fuel.
Relatively to its size, the destroyer is about as strong as an
egg-shell, but its engines are of extraordinary power.

The destroyers are generally organized and operate in little groups or
flotillas of perhaps twenty or so with a small cruiser or a flotilla
leader as a flagship, on which is the officer in command of them all.
There is also usually a depot ship for each flotilla.

The flotilla leaders are what one might call super-destroyers, about
double the size of the ordinary large destroyer, which is to say, about
two thousand tons, and capable of very high speed.

The depot ships form a kind of floating headquarters for their
respective flotillas. They are usually old cruisers which are specially
fitted up for the purpose, and although they are of comparatively slow
speed they can by wireless telegraphy keep in touch with the destroyers,
which can return to them when occasion permits or demands. They carry
workshops in which small repairs can be carried out, spare ammunition
and stores of all kinds and spare men for the crews. In fact they can
look after the smaller craft much as a mother looks after her children,
and for that reason they are sometimes called "mother ships."

As has been said, the destroyer was originally intended to destroy
torpedo boats, but small torpedo boats have almost gone out of existence
or rather the class have so grown in size as to have become merged in the
destroyers, which, it must be remembered, are well armed with torpedoes
which they have at times used with great effect. It is not surprising,
therefore, to find that a still newer class of ship has arisen which has
been described by one authority as "destroyer-destroyers." Officially
known as "light armoured cruisers," not very much is known of their
details. They are, however, about 3500 tons, with 10 guns, large enough
that is to dispose of any destroyer which they might encounter.

Thus, to review the whole class of ships of which we have been speaking,
we may say that there are the destroyers, all the more recent of which
are about 1000 tons but diminishing as we go backward in time to about
350 or 400; the flotilla leaders about twice the size of the largest
destroyers; and the destroyer-destroyers nearly twice as large as the
flotilla leaders: all are characterised by high speed and by guns just
large enough for the work for which they are intended. All are armed,
too, with the deadly torpedo for attack upon larger ships than
themselves.

They are essentially night-birds, much of their time being spent
stealing about with all lights out, in pitch darkness, seeking for
information or for a chance to put a torpedo into some chance victim.
These night operations are very hazardous, but so skilful are the young
officers who have charge of these boats that seldom do we hear of
mishaps.

But although, as has been said, the torpedo boat has almost vanished,
its under-water comrade has recently assumed a place in the first rank
of importance, and perhaps to us the most valuable work of all done by
the destroyer is that of hunting down and sinking these modern pirates.



CHAPTER XVI

BATTLESHIPS


Perhaps the greatest war invention of modern times was the British
battleship _Dreadnought_.

Of course, there have been battleships for centuries. In history we read
of fleets consisting of so many "ships of the line" or in other words
"line-of-battle" ships, meaning ships which were considered capable of
taking their place in "line of battle," as distinguished from "frigates"
which correspond to the modern "cruiser."

The "line-of-battle" ships were stout and strong with plenty of guns.
They went into the thick of the fight, since they were capable of giving
and receiving hard blows, while the lighter frigates hovered around
seeking an opening to use their higher speed to cut off stragglers or to
prey upon merchant ships.

Although so different in form and material that a sailor of the old
days, could he revisit the earth, would not recognize them, the
battleships of to-day are the real descendants of the "line-of-battle"
ships of those times. They are stout and strong, with the heaviest guns,
capable of giving and taking the hardest knocks, and it is they who form
the backbone of the fleet. As we saw in the accounts of the battle of
Jutland, the German Fleet tackled our cruisers and lighter vessels but
discreetly withdrew when the battleships came up.

Looked at in another way, we may say that a battleship is a floating
fortress. Its speed is not great, when compared with other ships, but it
is constructed to carry enormous guns. It is also armoured with steel
plates of great thickness and of special hardness placed upon the
outside of the hull so as to cover its vital parts and protect them from
the shells of the enemy. Its chief function, we may say, is to carry its
guns: to enable it to do this with safety, it is armoured: and to enable
it to get to grips with its enemies it has engines and boilers. Those
are the three features of greatest importance in a battleship, its guns,
its armour and its engines. All else is of minor importance.

It is strange to think how short a time the iron or steel ship has been
with us. In the American Civil War, for instance, only about sixty years
ago, the battleships were made of wood. It was during that war that
Ericcson thought of the idea of putting iron plates to protect the sides
of a ship from the hostile shots, and from that improvised armouring of
a wooden ship has arisen the iron-clad or, more correctly, steel-clad
monsters of to-day.

It is just about fifty years ago since the last iron-clad wooden
battleship was launched for the British Navy. Her name was _Repulse_,
and she took the water in 1868. With a tonnage of 6190 and a horse-power
of 3350, she had a speed of 12 knots. Her armouring of iron was in parts
4½ inches and in other parts 6 inches thick, while she carried 20
guns of sizes which to-day would seem mere toys. If all her guns were
discharged together she would throw a total weight of 2160 lbs. of
projectiles.

Now, for comparison, let us take a modern battleship, the _Orion_, for
example. The tonnage is 22,680, the horse-power 27,000.

She is more than twice the length of the older ship and is armoured with
steel 12 inches thick. Her 10 large guns, each 13½ inches in
diameter, if fired together (as I once heard them, like thunder, though
10 miles away) throw a weight of 12,500 lbs.

From this we see the wonderful growth in size, speed and in hitting
power during the comparatively short period of fifty years. But there is
a more striking comparison still.

The _Repulse's_ guns threw 2160 lbs. and the _Orion's_ throw 12,500. But
that takes no account of the energy with which the weight is thrown. A
tennis ball hit hard, might really contain more energy and do more
damage to anything it hit than a cricket ball thrown gently, which
illustrates the fact that in comparing the power of guns we need to
consider something more than the mere weight of the projectiles. To
arrive at a real comparison we take the weight of the projectiles in
tons and multiply it by the speed at which they leave the guns in _feet
per second_. And we call the answer so many "foot-tons."

Now the energy of the _Repulse_ thus reckoned comes to just under
30,000; that of the _Orion_ to just under 690,000. The _Orion_ can hit
twenty-three times as hard as could its forerunner of only fifty years
ago.

Since the _Repulse_ all our battleships have been built of wrought iron
or mild steel. Speaking generally, there was a steady development in
size and horse-power and in speed until 1906, in which year there was
launched the world-famous H.M.S. _Dreadnought_. Previously no battleship
had been faster than 19 knots: she was designed for 21 knots. Her
tonnage was 17,900, exceeding by more than 1000 tons anything that had
gone before. But the great change was in the guns. Pre-Dreadnoughts had,
or one ought to say "have" for there are still many in existence, four
of the biggest guns, a number of medium-sized guns and a still larger
number of smallish guns intended for the purpose of keeping off torpedo
craft and such small fry.

At one stroke Lord Fisher, who was then the First Sea Lord of the
British Admiralty, changed all this. He swept all the medium-sized guns
away and gave this new ship TEN of the largest guns then in use.

The advent of this ship startled the whole naval world, for it was seen
at once by all those able to judge that there was a vessel which might
be expected to sink with ease any other ship afloat. The onslaught from
those ten guns would be more than any other ship could stand. So other
powers set to work to copy more or less exactly, while Great Britain
quickly built more like her. So important was this new invention that
very soon the strength of the naval powers began to be reckoned entirely
on the number of Dreadnoughts they possessed, the older ships being
left out of account as though they did not make any difference one way
or the other.

But Great Britain was not content with the _Dreadnought_, for each
succeeding ship or set of ships was improved until, only four years
later, there was launched the _Orion_ already referred to, nearly 5000
tons bigger, with 2500 more horse-power, and with 13½-inch guns
instead of 12-inch. The _Orion_ and her sisters are often spoken of as
super-Dreadnoughts.

The Dreadnoughts as a class are often referred to as "all-big-gun"
ships, since that is the feature which most distinguishes them from
those which went before.

These large guns are mounted in turrets as they are called. We might
describe these as turn-tables with a cover over something like a small
gas-holder. There are usually two guns in each turret, although there
are a few ships whose turrets have three in each.

The turrets seem to be standing on the deck of the ship and it is by
turning them round that the guns are trained or pointed at their target.

The original _Dreadnought_ had one turret in front and two behind, all
on the centre-line of the ship, and two more, one each side, amidships.
In late vessels all five turrets are on the centre-line. Thus the
_Dreadnought_ can fire six guns ahead, eight astern and eight to either
side, while the newer ships can fire four ahead, four astern and all ten
on either side.

There are other battleships with even more guns than these, such as the
U.S.A. ship _Wyoming_, with twelve 12-inch guns, but the British Navy
seems to prefer to stick to the original number of ten. The reason for
this is that every such ship is a compromise between three alternatives.

The three great features have already been pointed out, namely, the
guns, the armour and the propelling machinery. Either of these can be
increased at the cost of one or both of the others, but all cannot be
increased without sinking the ship, unless indeed, the ship be made
larger and then other considerations crop up.

And that brings us to another class of ship often ranked among the
battleships. These remarkable vessels are also termed cruisers and the
fashion seems to have established itself of combining the two names and
calling them battle-cruisers. They gave a fine account of themselves
during the war.

The first three of these, of which the _Invincible_ is usually taken as
the type, made its appearance the year after the _Dreadnought_, and like
the latter were the offspring of the fertile brain of Lord Fisher. The
_Invincible_ was about the same size as the _Dreadnought_, but had
nearly twice the horse-power (41,000), which enabled it to attain an
actual speed of nearly six knots more, namely, 28·6.

For guns it had eight of the same large weapons, and it was armoured
with 7-inch steel armour-plates instead of 11-inch.

Thus we see illustrated what has just been said, less guns and thinner
armour, to allow for more engine power and higher speed. Or, to put it
the other way, we observe how higher speed was attained at the expense
of the guns and the armour.

But just as the _Dreadnought_ was followed by other still greater
improvements in the same direction we get, in 1910, the famous ship
_Lion_, a vessel not unknown to the Germans, a "super-Invincible."

This ship has a tonnage of over 26,000 and 70,000 horse-power. It was
designed to do 28 knots.

We saw the use of these ships in the Jutland battle, when, using their
high speed, they attacked the German battleships and kept them engaged
while the slower battleships came up. Though they suffered severe
losses, which probably the more heavily armoured battleships would have
escaped, they held the Germans so that it was only the failing light
which saved them from utter destruction.

Another example was the way in which they hunted down Von Spee and his
squadron off the Falklands, when they caught the Germans because of
their higher speed and then sank them by means of their heavier guns
with practically no loss to themselves.

We saw them again in the Heligoland battle, coming up to the assistance
of the lighter vessels just in the nick of time and scattering the enemy
like so much chaff.

A fact little known to most people and productive of much surprise is
that these battleships and cruisers are not such very large vessels,
when compared with those of the merchant service. The _Lion_ is 660 feet
long and 86 feet wide, the _Aquitania_ is 930 feet long and 98 feet
wide, and the _Olympic_ is 882 feet long and 92 feet wide.

The mighty _Orion_ makes a poorer showing still in point of size, since
she is only 545 feet long and 88 feet wide--little over half the length
of the _Aquitania_.

It is difficult to compare the tonnage of a warship with that of a
merchant ship, since they are not measured in the same way. The former
is the "displacement" or actual weight of water displaced: in other
words the precise weight of the vessel in tons of 2240 lbs.

The tonnage of a merchant ship, however, has nothing to do with weight
but is based upon capacity and is arrived at by a purely arbitrary rule,
thus: all the enclosed space in the ship is measured in cubic feet and
the total is divided by one hundred. That gives the gross tonnage. To
arrive at the net tonnage the space occupied by the engines and all
other space necessary for the working of the ship is excluded.
Originally the tonnage of a merchant ship was the number of "tuns" of
wine which it could carry.

Thus, you see, comparing the tonnage of a warship with that of a
merchant ship is somewhat like comparing a pound with a bushel. Net
registered tonnage is generally considerably less than the displacement
tonnage of the same ship, so that a warship is usually less than a
merchant ship of the same nominal number of tons.

And now let us turn to some of the internal arrangements of these
wonderful ships, more particularly to the means for working the guns.

Each turret is placed over the top of what we might call a well, running
right down deep into the inside of the ship. At the bottom of this well
is the magazine, where the shells are stored and also the cartridges
containing the explosive which drives the shell from the gun.

Underneath the turret, forming a kind of basement to it, is a chamber
called the working chamber, and up to it the shells and cartridges pass
by means of lifts. For safety's sake only a small quantity of explosives
is kept here at any one time, but it is from here that the guns overhead
are fed. Shells and cartridges alike pass up as required by means of
hoists right to the guns. Indeed, the hoists are ingeniously contrived
so that in whatever position a gun may be the hoist stops exactly
opposite the breech, or opening at the back of the gun through which it
is loaded. Then a mechanical rammer drives the shell or cartridge into
its place in the gun.

The hoists are worked by hydraulic power or electricity, and in most
cases by both, arrangements being made so that either can be used at
will, thus serving as alternatives in case either should get out of
order.

The turrets themselves are also turned by power. Indeed, so heavy are
the weights involved that only by the use of carefully designed
machinery is the operation of such great weapons made possible. A single
shell of the 13·5-inch gun weighs 1250 lbs.

Around each turret there is placed a wall of thick armour plate as high
as it is possible to make it without interfering with the movement of
the guns. This is called the barbette armour and the space enclosed by
it, in which the turret stands, is called a barbette, an old
fortification term meaning a place behind a rampart.

The turret is covered over, as has already been remarked, by a steel
hood, so that altogether the guns and their crews are about as well
protected as it is possible to be.

That all this means a considerable burden upon the ship is shown by the
fact that a pair of 12-inch guns with their turret and barbette armour
will weigh something like 600 tons, and if there be five of them that
means 3000 tons in all.

Down below in the magazine there are lifting appliances whereby the
shells can be readily picked up and run to the hoist. Moreover, there is
elaborate machinery for keeping them cool. Our allies the French had,
years ago, several bad accidents through the explosives going off
spontaneously in their ships, and this is quite likely to happen if the
magazines become too hot. So refrigerating apparatus is installed
similar to that employed in meat-carrying ships, which provides a
constant flow of cool air into the magazines.

The ships also are subdivided to the greatest possible extent consistent
with efficient working, so that in the event of a collision or a torpedo
making a hole below water the ship may not sink. As far as possible the
divisions or bulkheads are made to run right from top to bottom without
any openings, but that obviously is a very inconvenient arrangement, so
in many places there have to be doorways through them, leading from one
part of the ship to another. In such cases these are closed by
water-tight doors, which can be shut before the ship goes into action or
into any dangerous region.

The engines of these vessels are now always turbines. This type of
engine has many advantages over the older type, in which certain parts
move to and fro, that motion being changed by cranks into a round and
round action. For one thing, they are lighter for a given power, so that
more power can be put into a ship without adding to the weight. That
means higher speed. Then there is less to get out of order. Anyone who
has been into a ship's engine room where to and fro or reciprocating
engines are at work will realize this, for there is a maze of rods and
cranks all moving together, and many parts which need to be oiled while
in motion and which would get hot and tight if they were not carefully
looked after. All this in an enclosed space with possibly an
uncomfortable motion of the whole ship used to make the engineer's life
at sea a very hazardous and unhappy one.

But the turbine is entirely enclosed. There is nothing to be seen moving
at all. Indeed, there is only one moving part, and that is coupled
directly to the propeller-shaft, so that nothing could possibly be
simpler.



CHAPTER XVII

HOW A WARSHIP IS BUILT


When it is decided to build a certain ship, the first thing to be done
is to draw it on paper. The Admiralties of the world, and also the great
shipbuilders, have each their own chief designer installed in a big,
light, quiet office fitted with large strong, flat tables at which work
a number of draughtsmen.

The naval authorities tell the "chief" in general terms what they want
the ship to be capable of, and he determines its size and form. Then the
draughtsmen work out his ideas on paper, themselves deciding upon the
minor details, until they have produced exact representations of the
ship which is to be. Some draughtsmen deal with the actual hull of the
ship, while others design the various fittings and minor details, all
working, of course, under the constant supervision of the chief.

In this connection one may perhaps allude to a matter which the general
public often seems to misunderstand--the work and functions of a
draughtsman. I have heard people say of a boy that he is good at drawing
so they think of making a draughtsman of him. Now the point is that the
actual drawing is perhaps the least important part of a draughtsman's
work. He has to know _what to draw_. He is given just a rough idea of
something and from that he has to produce a perfect design, bearing in
mind that the thing to be made must well fulfil its purpose, must be
easy and cheap to construct, must be strong enough yet not too heavy,
must be made of the most suitable material and so on. He has to possess
a good deal of the knowledge of the skilled workman, he has to be
something of a scientist and a good mathematician in addition to his
ability to make neat and accurate drawings. So, you see, these men whose
minds conceive the details of our great ships are men of long training
and experience, with far greater knowledge and skill than we sometimes
give them credit for.

Anyway, there they stand, each at his own table, bending over his own
drawing-board, each doing his own particular share towards producing the
perfect ship.

But when all is said and done, there are limitations to the cleverness
of the cleverest among us, so the next step, after the draughtsmen have
done their best, is to test what they have done by experiment.

Years ago a certain Mr. William Froude interested himself in the
question of the best shapes for ships, and he found that by making an
exact model of a ship and then drawing that model through water it was
possible to foretell just how that ship would behave. He built himself a
tank for the purpose of these experiments at Torquay, where he lived,
and by its aid he added a very important chapter to the science of
shipbuilding.

Nowadays the Admiralty have a large and well-fitted tank at Portsmouth,
the United States Navy have one at Washington, private shipbuilders have
the use of a national tank at Bushey, near London, while several of the
large firms have tanks of their own.

The national tank at Bushey, by the way, was given to the nation by Mr.
Yarrow, a famous shipbuilder, in memory of Mr. Froude, it being called
the "William Froude Tank" in recognition of the great work done by him.

Now these tanks may be described as rather elongated swimming-baths.
Such a structure is generally a little narrower than the average bath,
but it is longer and much deeper.

At one end there are miniature docks in which the models float when not
in use, while at the other there is a sloping beach upon which the waves
caused by the models expend their energy harmlessly.

Along each side there runs a rail upon which are supported the ends of a
travelling bridge. Driven by electric motors, this bridge can run to and
fro from end to end of the tank, and its purpose is to drag the models
through the water.

Carried upon the bridge is a platform which bears a number of
instruments, chief among which is a self-recording dynamometer.

Now a dynamometer is an instrument for measuring the force of a "pull,"
and when we call it self-recording we mean that it automatically takes a
record of a series of pulls or of a varying pull. In this case there
projects below the bridge a lever, to the end of which the model under
test is attached. As the bridge rushes along it pulls the model through
the water by means of this lever, and the force which is expended in
doing so is recorded in the form of a wavy line upon a sheet of ruled
paper.

If the model slips through the water very easily there is little pull
upon the lever and the line drawn by the pen of the instrument remains
low down upon the chart. If, however, much power is needed and the pull
is a strong one the pen moves and the line rises towards the top of the
paper. Any change, whether increase or decrease, is thus shown by the
rise or fall of the ink line.

One model can be thus tried at various speeds and its behaviour noted
under different conditions. Other matters can be investigated too, such
as whether or not the bow rises in the water or falls when the boat is
in motion, also how much such rise or fall may amount to.

The suitability of a certain shape of vessel, moreover, can to a certain
extent be seen by observing the commotion which it makes in the water.
Everyone has noticed the way in which a ship throws up a wave at its
bows, and that bow-wave, as it is termed, represents so much energy
being wasted. The power of the engines is absorbed to a certain extent
in making that wave. It is impossible to make anything which when forced
through the water will not make some wave, but certain forms cause less
of it than others, and the designer of a ship seeks to find that form
which will make the smallest bow-wave.

In like manner the eddies which a ship leaves in its wake are the
result of wasted energy, and the ship must be so shaped that they too
will be reduced to a minimum.

Shipbuilders find that there are three things which retard a ship's
movement: skin friction, or friction between the water and the sides of
the ship; wave making at the bow and eddy making at the stern. The first
depends largely upon the smoothness of the ship's surface, the second
and third depend upon its shape. If a model behaves badly in the tank
the fault may be either too much wave making or too much eddy making,
and which of these it is the dynamometer does not of course tell. In
many cases the experienced eye of the tank officials furnishes the clue
to the trouble, but in some cases a cinematograph is used to make a
complete series of photographs of the model and the water around it as
it rushes from end to end. These can then be studied in conjunction with
the chart and the cause of the fault discovered.

The real aim, it is obvious, of all these tank experiments is to find
out the lowest horse-power necessary to drive the ship, or the best form
of ship to get the highest speed out of a given horse-power.

The cost of keeping up these large tanks and making the models and
conducting the experiments is very great, for not only are the premises
very large (I know one in which the water alone cost nearly a hundred
pounds) but a highly skilled staff is necessary. The saving effected in
the cost of ships and the superior efficiency of the ships makes it well
worth while however.

There is still one other point about this matter which will possibly be
puzzling the observant reader. What are the models made of and how are
they made? They are made of paraffin wax, and a very important
department of the experimental tank is that where the models are formed.

First of all a rough mould is fashioned by hand in modelling clay and
into this is poured melted wax, the result being a very rough model of
the ship. This is then placed in the model-making machine.

Those of my readers who are familiar with an engineer's shop will know
what a planing machine is like, and from that they can form an idea of
the general structure of this remarkable tool. There is, first of all, a
travelling table which, as the machine works, travels to and fro.
Spanning this table is a beam which carries on its under side two
revolving cutters, so that as the table passes beneath them the cutters
can operate upon anything placed upon the table.

Another part of the machine is a board upon which is placed the drawing
showing the external shape of the proposed ship, and working over this
board is a pointer connected by a system of rods and levers to the
cutters just mentioned. The rough block of wax, then, having been placed
upon the table and the to and fro motion set going, the attendant guides
the pointer along the lines of the drawing, and as he does so the
cutters so move as to carve away the soft wax into the precise shape of
the model.

A little smoothing by hand is all that is necessary to complete the
conversion of the rough piece of wax into a perfect model. It is then
placed in the water and ballasted with little bags of shot until it
floats at just the correct depth, and finally a light wooden frame is
fitted to it for the purpose of making the connection to the lever by
which it is pulled along.

Thus, after much thought and experiment, the designs for a new ship are
completed. Tracings are then made of them on semi-transparent paper or
cloth, which tracings are then used as "negatives," from which a number
of photographic prints are made, just as the amateur photographer makes
prints from his negatives. At least that is how they used to be done, in
a huge printing frame, but nowadays a machine is more often employed
which passes the tracing or negative with a piece of photographic paper
behind it slowly past an electric light, thus doing the work more
quickly and more conveniently, for the drawings of ships are often very
long and would either require an enormous frame or else would have to be
made in pieces and joined together.

The prints are finally passed out to the works to be translated in terms
of iron, steel and wood.

Perhaps the most important part of a shipyard is the mould loft, a large
apartment on the floor of which the ship is drawn out full size. Then
from these full-size drawings moulds or templets are made of wood or
soft metal, showing the exact size and shape of the various parts. The
moulds or templets go thence to the workshops, where the bars and plates
of steel are cut to the right shape and perforated with holes, and some
of the pieces are there joined together with rivets.

[Illustration: THE TRIPOD MAST.

Here we see one leg of the tripod mast of a warship. These masts have
greater stability and freedom from vibration than others. They are used
for observation and range-finding, and have a fighting-top on which guns
of small calibre are mounted. Here is shown a sailor carrying a wounded
comrade.]

From the workshops the various pieces or parts go to the yard where the
slip is on which the vessel is being built. This slip is by the water's
edge, conveniently placed with a view to the fact that later on the
great structure, weighing possibly thousands of tons, has got to slide
down into the water.

Where the keel of the ship is to go a row of timber blocks is placed a
few feet apart, and upon these blocks the plates of steel which form the
lowest part of the ship are laid. Upon them are laid other parts, and
upon them others, the joints being made by riveting. Thus the great ship
grows from the keel upwards. As she gets bigger and bigger there comes
the danger of her tipping over, and that is provided against by the use
of props or shores along both sides.

By the time the hull is ready for launching it is often of great weight,
all of which is borne upon the wooden blocks underneath the keel.
Consequently, if the ground be not good, piles have to be driven in or
concrete foundations laid to enable the huge mass of the ship to be
supported. For this reason a large vessel cannot be built anywhere but
only on a properly prepared "slip," and it is the possession of a large
number of such places which enables Great Britain to build so many ships
at once.

Along each side of the slip there is usually a row of tall masts with a
beam projecting out sideways near the top of each, forming cranes by
which the heavier parts can be hoisted into position.

In other yards, again, there is a tall iron structure called a gantry
along each side of the slip, while travelling cranes span across from
one to the other over where the growing ship lies. These travelling
cranes, worked by electricity, permit heavy weights to be handled with
ease and safety. Other subsidiary cranes, meanwhile, carry the heavy
hydraulic riveting machines by which riveting is done.

Much riveting is done by hand, men working together in squads of four.
Of these one, often quite a boy, heats the rivets in a small furnace,
after which he throws them one by one to man number two, who inserts
each as he receives it in its proper hole and holds it there with a big
heavy hammer or else a tool called a "dolly." Number two is called the
"holder-up," since he holds the rivet up in its place while the
remaining two hammer it over with alternate blows of their hammers.

In many cases, however, the two last described men give place to one,
who is armed with a tool in shape much like a pistol and operated by
compressed air obtained through a flexible tube. When he presses a
trigger a little hammer inside the "pistol" gives a rapid series of
blows to the rivet, completing the job more quickly than the two men can
do with hand hammers.

A third way of doing this operation so important in the building of a
ship is by the hydraulic machine suspended from the cranes. To the
casual onlooker this has the notable feature of being silent, whereas
riveting by hand and still more by a pistol hammer is terribly noisy.
The reason for this is that the hydraulic riveter does not hammer at
all, but, like a huge mechanical hand, it takes the rivet between finger
and thumb and just squeezes it down.

One strange result of all this hammering in of rivets is that every ship
by the time it leaves the slip has become a huge magnet, with somewhat
disconcerting effects upon its own compasses, but of that more later on.

Thus the great ship grows, being made piece by piece in the workshops to
the shapes indicated from the mould loft and put together and riveted on
the slip, until finally in due time it is ready to take its first
journey.

The launching of a big ship always strikes me as about the boldest and
most daring thing which is ever done in the course of industry. For the
huge structure, naturally top-heavy, weighing hundreds or thousands of
tons, is just allowed to slide at its own sweet will. From the moment it
starts until it is well in the water it is in charge of itself, so to
speak, and if anything were to go wrong no power on earth could stop it
once it had got a start.

That nothing ever does go wrong, or scarcely ever at all events, is due
to the care with which all preparations are made before that critical
moment when the ship is let loose and to the skill and experience of
those in charge.

As the hull reaches that degree of completion when it can safely be put
in the water, strong wooden structures termed launching ways are
constructed one on each side of her. These really act like huge rails
upon which in due course there will slide a gigantic toboggan.
Tremendously solid and strong they have to be, as they have each to
carry half the total weight of the ship.

Under each side of the ship and upon the launching ways there is built a
timber framework capable of raising the ship bodily off the blocks upon
which until now it has reposed. These two frames, being connected
together by chains passing beneath the keel, constitute what is called
the cradle, the "toboggan" which is to slide down the ways, bearing the
ship upon it.

It is easy to see that being top-heavy something must be done to give
the ship support before the shores on either side can be taken away, and
it is equally clear that these latter must be removed before she can
slide down to the water. Neither would it do to let the vessel slide
upon her own plates, so we see that the cradle fulfils a twofold
purpose, first enabling the ship to reach the water without ripping
holes in her own plates, and secondly giving it the necessary side
support to prevent it from toppling over on the way.

When all is ready, but a short time before the hour appointed for the
launch, a curious operation is performed. Between the main part of the
cradle and the part which actually slides upon the ways wedges are
inserted, hundreds of them, and they are all driven in simultaneously.
Their purpose is to make the cradle slightly higher and so to lift the
ship off the blocks upon which it was built. If they were driven in one
at a time each would only dig its way into the timber and nothing else
would happen, but being driven all together a most powerful lifting
action is produced which actually raises the mighty ship. So hundreds of
men stand, each with his hammer ready to strike a wedge, while the
foreman stands by with a gong. At a stroke on the gong the hundreds of
hammers strike as one, and so the ship is raised off the blocks, which
can then be removed, to facilitate which they too are built of
wedge-shaped pieces which can easily be knocked apart. The shores, too,
have ceased to serve any useful purpose and can be taken away until at
last all shores and all blocks are gone and the vessel rests upon the
cradle only. Meanwhile tons of grease have been put on the ways, and the
ship, urged by its own weight, is straining to get down the greasy slope
into the element for which all along it has been intended. At this stage
the only thing which restrains it is a kind of trigger arrangement on
either side which locks the cradle in its place. In some yards elaborate
mechanical catches controlled by electricity are used for this, but in
many the old device of "dog shores" is still used. These are simply two
stout wood props which fit between a projection on the ways and one on
the cradle, there being one dog shore on either side. Just over each dog
shore there hangs a weight.

The person who performs the ceremony cuts the cord which holds the
weights, the weights fall, the dog shores are knocked away, and the ship
is free. Slowly at first, but gathering speed every moment, she moves
majestically downwards into the water, being ultimately brought to rest
by means of chains.

Whether done by the simple dodge of cutting a cord or by the more
refined method of pressing an electric push, the launching is generally
preceded by the breaking of a bottle of wine against the bows and the
pronouncement of the vessel's name.

Once safely afloat, the vessel is towed away and berthed alongside a
wharf whereon are cranes and other machines which lightly drop on board
of her the massive turbines and boilers which in time will propel her,
and the guns with which she will fight. All the multitudinous little
finishing touches are here put into her until at last she sallies forth
on her trial trips to show what she is capable of, after which follow
trials of her guns, and then she takes her place in the fleet.

Thus, briefly sketched, we see the history of the warship from her
inception in the minds of her designers till she is ready to meet the
foe.



CHAPTER XVIII

THE TORPEDO


In parts of South America there lives a little fish, which, if you touch
its nose, gives you a severe electric shock. The natives call it the
"torpedo." When an artificial fish came to be invented, capable of
giving a very nasty shock to anyone touching its snout, that name was
bestowed upon it too.

Even more than the submarine, the torpedo resembles a fish with its
graceful outlines and its fins and tail, the chief difference being that
the tail of the torpedo carries a couple of little rotating propellers.
Looked at another way we may say that the torpedo is an automatic
submarine. As a matter of fact, we all know it best as the weapon of the
submarine.

It was originally invented by an Austrian who took it to a Mr.
Whitehead, an Englishman who then had an engineering works at Fiume.
This gentleman took up the idea and developed it into the Whitehead
torpedo, which is to-day used by half the navies in the world, the rest
using something very similar. It is curious to note that the German
variety is called the Schwartzkopf, the meaning of which is
"blackhead."

The smooth, steel, fish-like body consists of two separate parts, which
can be detached from each other. The front part called the "head" is
made in two kinds, the war-head and the peace-head. The former contains
a large quantity of explosive and the mechanism for firing it on coming
into contact with any hard body. It is only used in actual warfare. The
peace-head is precisely the same shape and weight as the other but is
quite harmless, so that when it is fitted to the torpedo the latter can
be handled with perfect safety, a valuable feature during the frequent
exercises through which our sailors go in their efforts to attain
perfection in the use and handling of these valuable weapons.

So much for the head. The body of the torpedo contains a beautiful
little engine precisely similar to a steam-engine but on a small scale,
which is driven by compressed air, a store of which is carried in a
compartment provided for the purpose.

Then there is an automatic steering apparatus controlled by a gyroscope,
the purpose of which is to keep the torpedo steered in precisely that
direction in which it is started. If any outside force, such as current
or tide, deflects it from its path the gyroscope, acting through a
rudder at the tail, brings it back again.

Like the submarine, moreover, it has rudders which can steer it upwards
or downwards and these again are controlled automatically so that having
been set to travel at a certain depth the torpedo can be launched into
the water with the practical certainty that it will descend to that
depth and then maintain it.

This remarkable result is attained by the use of two devices acting in
combination, namely, a hydrostatic valve and a pendulum. Either of these
alone would set the thing going by leaps and bounds, at one time above
the required depth and at another equally below it, and so on
alternately. The hydrostatic valve consists of a flexible diaphragm, one
side of which is in contact with the water outside, so that since the
pressure increases with increasing depth, it is bent inwards more or
less as the depth varies. This deflection is made to control the
horizontal rudders. Suppose that things are adjusted for the rudders to
steer the torpedo horizontally when at a depth of ten feet: if it
descends to twelve feet the increased deflection of the diaphragm will
so change the rudders that they will tend to steer slightly upwards: if,
on the other hand, it rises to eight feet the contrary will happen, with
the result that it will descend. As has been said already, this alone
would result in a continually undulating course, so the pendulum is
introduced to check the too decided changes in direction and so produce
a practically straight course.

There is an interesting feature, too, about the propeller. It is "twin"
but not, as in ships, two screws side by side. Instead, they are both
set upon one shaft or rather upon two concentric shafts, like the two
hands of a clock. The hour-hand of a clock is on one shaft, a solid one,
which itself turns inside the shaft of the minute hand, which is
hollow. The propellers of the torpedo are likewise, one on a tubular
shaft and the other on a solid shaft inside it. These two shafts turn in
opposite directions, but since the two propellers are made opposite
"hands" they both equally push the torpedo along. The reason for this
arrangement is that without it the action of a single propeller would
tend to turn the torpedo over and over. Instead of the torpedo turning
the propeller the propeller would to some extent turn the torpedo.

The range of the torpedo depends, clearly, upon the quantity of
compressed air which it is able to carry and that is limited by certain
practical considerations. One of these is the space required to store
it, and a very ingenious method has been invented whereby the limited
supply is eked out so that in effect its quantity is increased. As the
air is used up the pressure in the air-chamber naturally falls and when
that has gone on to a certain extent chemicals come into action which
generate heat, whereby the remaining air is raised in temperature. This,
of course, increases the volume of air and the result is just the same
as if a greater quantity were carried to commence with.

The explosion is brought about by the pressing in of a pin which
normally projects from the nose or point of the torpedo, and it would be
very easy to knock this accidentally, causing a premature explosion,
were not precautions taken to prevent it. These take the form of a
little fan which is turned by the water as the torpedo proceeds through
it. The firing-pin is locked by means of a screw so that it cannot be
operated until it has been released by the withdrawal of the screw and
that can only be done by the fan. Thus, while on the submarine or
whatever ship carries it, the torpedo cannot be fired: it only becomes
capable of explosion after it has passed through the water for a certain
distance, far enough, that is, for the fan to have undone the screw.
Thus the maximum of safety is combined with the maximum of sensitiveness
when the object aimed at is struck.

There are other forms of torpedo which although little used are by no
means lacking in interest. There is the Brennan, for example, at one
time much favoured in the British Navy. Its propellers were operated
from the shore, by the pulling of two very flexible steel wires. The
effect was much as if the thing were driven by reins, as a horse is
driven. On shore was a powerful engine with two large drums on which the
wires could be wound and by which they could be drawn in at a very high
speed. By pulling one more than the other the torpedo could be steered
and it is said that such a torpedo could be made to follow a ship
through complicated evolutions and fairly hunt it down, finally
overtaking and striking it.

The purpose of such weapons was clearly to defend a port or roadstead
against enemy craft which might try to rush in. It needed to be
controlled by someone perched upon an eminence of some sort from which
he could watch its course and guide it as might be necessary.

Compare this with the ease with which the Whitehead torpedo is just
slipped into the water and then left to itself. A submarine has in its
bows either one or two tubes just large enough to hold the torpedo
easily. At the front is a flap door which is kept closed while the
torpedo is slipped into its place. Then the similar door at the rear of
the tube is closed after which the front one can be opened. Water of
course flows in and surrounds the torpedo when this takes place and a
little push from some compressed air sends it floating out. As it
emerges from the tube the engines are set going automatically and
likewise the gyroscope which steers it, after which it continues to
proceed in a straight line, soon seeking and maintaining the desired
depth.

Other vessels besides submarines have submerged torpedo-tubes like
these, but others again have tubes of a different kind. These are fixed
on the deck and have the advantage that they can be pointed in any
direction almost like a gun, whereas the others are either fixed rigidly
in the vessel or are only slightly movable. In the case of these other
tubes the torpedo is shot over the side of the ship, off which it leaps
into the water somewhat like a man diving.

One other kind of steerable torpedo may be mentioned because of its
ingenuity, although so far as is known it is not in actual use. It is
called the Armorl, a compound of the names of its inventors, Messrs.
Armstrong and Orling. It is controlled by wireless telegraphy in a very
simple but effective manner. The rudder which steers it is connected to
a small crank in such a way that as the crank revolves it turns the
"helm" first to one side and then to the other. Suppose that, to
commence with, the rudder is straight: a quarter of a revolution of the
crank sets it to one side, say, the right: another quarter sets it
straight again: a third quarter sets it to the left: and so on. The
crank is turned by a wound-up spring, the effect of which is, however,
normally held in check by a catch. When a wireless impulse comes along
the catch is lifted for a moment, the crank slips round a quarter of a
turn and the rudder is moved accordingly. Every impulse changes the
position of the rudder and by sending suitable series of impulses it can
be set as desired and changed at any moment.

A difficulty with all these guided torpedoes is that they must carry
some indication whereby their place at any moment will be made visible
to the man in control. A little mast and flag would do, for example, but
it would be a fair mark for the enemy's guns and being shot away would
leave the torpedo uncontrollable. The same objection seems to apply to
the wireless antenna which this last type must carry with which to
receive their guiding impulses, but that can be made light and almost
invisible. It is when the thing is clearly visible that the danger
arises, and, of course, to serve its purpose it must be visible. The way
in which this difficulty was overcome by Messrs. Armstrong and Orling is
a beautiful example of ingenuity. They cause a jet of water to be blown
upwards by compressed air, something like the spouting of a whale, so
familiar in books of natural history. That forms a mast which is clearly
visible, yet the enemy may blaze away at it to their heart's content
without damaging it in the least.



CHAPTER XIX

WHAT A SUBMARINE IS LIKE


The precise details of the submarines of our own navy or of any other
for that matter are wrapped in mystery. Those who might tell do not know
and those who know must not tell. True, there have been fully
descriptive articles in many books and magazines, but it may be safely
asserted that those descriptions are nothing more than what this chapter
avowedly is, reflections by the authors on what such a craft must be
like, more or less. It is just as well that this should be clearly
understood, and the following description does not claim to be any more
than that.

Just as an aeroplane follows the general design of a bird of the swallow
type, which soars without flapping its wings, so the submarine
necessarily follows much the lines of a fish. It has fins which help to
guide it, it has rudders which compare with the fish's tail, and while
it cannot use either fins or tail to push itself along as the fishes do,
it has one or more propellers which serve that purpose admirably. It is
rather remarkable that, while we often imitate nature very closely,
there is one very important mechanical feature which almost invariably
distinguishes man-made schemes from natural ones--that is, that man
uses rotary motion for many purposes whereas nature practically never
does. To be perfectly honest, the natural mechanisms are far too
difficult for us to copy or I expect we should do so. For example, watch
a goldfish and see how cleverly it uses its tail. Man could never hope
to make anything so perfect as that tail. Absolutely under its owner's
control, it serves a double purpose of propelling and steering in a
manner which is equally beautiful and impossible to imitate.

For certain definite purposes, however, a rotary propeller is quite as
good as anything which the fishes can show us. As a straightforward,
simple, forward-pushing device it is equal to anything that a fish
possesses. It has to be given that one duty, however, and no other, the
steering being the task of a separate device, the rudder. There again,
too, we see how nature does two things with one kind of mechanism while
we have to use two, for the fish steers itself to right and to left with
its tail in a vertical plane, but if it wants to steer upwards or
downwards it twists its tail over somewhat towards a horizontal plane.
The submarine, however, needs two distinct and separate rudders, one for
right and left steering and one for up and down, the latter being
generally a pair, one each side the vertical rudder for the sake of
symmetry and balance.

So we find that a submarine has a body like that of a fish except that
it is rather more rotund, perhaps, than the most portly fish usually
seen. It has certain fixed fins projecting from its sides, which
together with the rudders enable it to be guided. It has also certain
long fins called bilge keels for the purpose of keeping it from rolling
too much. Also, it has one or more propellers and the two kinds of
rudder already referred to.

A fish, never wishing to get outside itself and walk about upon its own
upper surface, needs no deck, in which the submarine differs from it,
for the crew require somewhere where they can enjoy a breath of fresh
air when opportunity offers. It is not a very commodious place, one
could not exactly take a long walk upon it, nor even play deck-quoits,
but on the back of the submarine there is an undoubted deck where the
men can get out and upon which they can stand when she is on the
surface.

A fish, moreover, takes little heed of things upon the surface: its
interests lie almost entirely below. Hence it has no conning-tower or
periscope, but without these the submarine would be useless. The former
is a little oblong tower something like a chimney, which projects upward
from the deck, while projecting to a higher level still is the tall
hollow mast with prism and lenses at the top called the Periscope,
through which the commander of the submarine, himself comparatively
inconspicuous, can sweep the horizon for enemies or victims.

The problem of constructing a ship to travel under water is quite
different from making one to travel on the surface in the ordinary way.
When deep down the pressure of the water tending to crush the vessel is
something enormous. Roughly speaking, it is a pound per square inch for
every two feet in depth, so that if a submarine dives to a depth of
fifty feet the water presses upon it with a force of about twenty-five
pounds upon every square inch of its surface. On a square foot, that
means over a ton. And there are many square feet of the surface in even
a small submarine. Consequently, the whole shell of the ship has to be
of very substantial construction. Moreover, there are curious strains
which come upon the vessel when it dives to which surface ships are not
subject. All these have to be reckoned as far as possible and allowed
for.

The size of the modern submarine is not known with any certainty, but we
may put it down roughly as two hundred feet long and at least a thousand
tons displacement, which means that that is its actual weight, including
everything and everybody on board, when it is just about to submerge.

Of course, a submarine, alone among boats, has two "tonnages." When it
is on the surface it is comparatively light. Indeed, "running light" is
the technical term describing it when it is riding upon the surface of
the water like an ordinary ship. Then, by increasing its weight, it can
cause itself to sink until the little promenade or deck called the
superstructure is just submerged and little can be seen above water
except the conning-tower. That is termed the "awash" position, and it is
clear that it is then displacing more water than when running light, and
hence its displacement tonnage must be more.

When it is desired to sink, the vessel is set in motion in the awash
position, from which it is gradually steered downwards by the diving
rudders, until only the periscope, or it may be not even that, is left
showing above. Then the maximum of water is being displaced. It is then
actually displacing more than its own weight of water, for if left to
itself it will rise rapidly and it is only the speed and the action of
the rudders which keep it under. We see, then, that the action of a
submarine in submerging itself is a real genuine dive. It sinks upon an
even keel until it is awash, after which it goes under "head-first,"
just as a swimmer does. It also rises bow first.

This tendency to rise when the combined action of movement and rudder
ceases constitutes a very considerable safeguard, for should anything
happen to the propelling machinery the vessel simply rises. At one time
weights were attached to the under side of the hull which could be
detached from the inside so that in the event of the vessel descending
against the wish of her commander, she could be simply forced to the
surface by the great excess of buoyancy resulting from shedding these
"safety weights." Of course, in the event of a serious perforation of
the hull neither of these forms of surplus buoyancy would bring the boat
up.

Let us now trace the operations of diving right through, supposing that
our submarine is first running light. In that condition she is being
driven by the oil engines which constitute her primary propelling power.
The hatch or door at the top of the conning-tower is open, as also, it
may be, is the one lower down, just at the foot of the tower. Men are
standing upon the little platform formed by the tower, and one of them
is steering by means of a wheel, keeping his eye, moreover, upon a
compass also provided there, that being in fact, to the submarine when
light, what the bridge is to the ordinary steamer. Other members of the
crew may be upon the superstructure or deck just below, while others
again are down inside, attending to their duties there.

Under these conditions the inside is by no means an unpleasant place.
Plenty of fresh air comes down through the open hatches and through the
ventilators, it being drawn down through the latter by means of a fan.

Preparations are then made for submerging. The hand-rail along the
little deck is removed. The upper steering wheel and compass are covered
up or shut away into the coverings provided for them, the wireless
apparatus, if provided, is removed and the mast shut down. Hatches are
securely closed and valves in the ventilating pipes are closed. In fact
every opening is shut and made water-tight so that no risk shall be run
of diving prematurely and taking in water accidentally.

The quarter-master transfers himself to the steering wheel inside, where
he has another compass to guide him, not of the magnetic variety this
time but a cunning application of the gyroscope. The commander, too,
having descended before the last hatch was closed down, takes his stand
at the eyepiece of the periscope, since that is now his only means of
seeing what is going on above.

Another man takes his place at the wheel which controls the diving
rudder, conveniently near to which is a pressure gauge so connected to
the outer water that as the ship dives its depth is recorded upon its
dial: that in effect is to him what the compass is to his comrade at the
other wheel.

With every movement of men there needs to be adjustment made to keep the
ship on an even keel. Otherwise she would go down by the bow or down by
the stern according as the men's weight shifted towards either end. This
is arranged for by two small tanks formed in the structure of the
vessel, one at either end. Connected together by pipes and controlled by
compressed air, water can be transferred from one to the other at will
and so the balance be always kept. Quite simple manipulations of a valve
serve to accomplish this delicate balancing performance. It is perhaps
not of such importance at this stage, but in a moment, when the whole
vessel will be under water, a very little movement indeed will suffice
to upset the equilibrium.

Next water ballast is admitted into certain other spaces in the ship's
structure, these spaces being called, because of the use to which they
are put, ballast tanks. Gradually, as the incoming water increases the
weight of the vessel, she sinks until she is awash. Then the diving
rudders are set at the right angle (a pendulum serves to show the angle
at which the boat points) and down she goes. As the pressure-gauge
indicates the approach to the required depth the rudder is flattened out
a little until just that position is found which keeps the boat under at
the desired depth.

Of course, when all hatches and openings were closed the supply of fresh
air was cut off and after that the crew had to depend upon the air
contained in the submarine. Also, they had to stop the engine, for
without air it cannot work: nor can it work without giving off fumes,
which, if admitted to the ship, would soon suffocate the crew. Just
before closing up, therefore, the engine is stopped and electric motors
take up the task of driving the ship.

Now suppose that, while running submerged, the commander espies, through
his periscope, an unsuspecting enemy. He tries forthwith to get as close
as he can. Having noted the direction of the vessel and which way she is
going and as far as possible her speed, he submerges more deeply, in all
probability, lest the white streak which represents the wake caused by
his periscope should reveal his presence. For possibly she is one of
those terrible destroyers in fair fight with which he has but a poor
chance. His only safety lying in complete invisibility, he therefore
submerges entirely, trusting to his calculations to lead him in the
desired direction. Thus he attempts and, if he have good luck, he
succeeds in getting reasonably near to his foe.

Then he must try so to man[oe]uvre that his bow shall at the right
moment be pointing towards the quarry, for his torpedo tubes are in the
bow and they are fixed, or nearly so at all events, so that he can only
fire them in a direction nearly, if not precisely, in the direction of
the centre line of his ship.

Nay, he must do even more than that. It will not do to fire the torpedo
directly at the ship, for a torpedo is comparatively slow. Suppose it is
capable of forty miles an hour, and the other ship is a mile away: the
torpedo will take ninety seconds to reach it. And in that time it may
have travelled a mile or so itself. So the submarine man has to allow
for that.

Occasionally, therefore, he comes up a little for a moment in the hope
of getting a sight of the enemy while not revealing his own presence.
Or perhaps he may decide to risk being seen and caught, trusting
to the chance of getting his own blow in first. He needs to be a
most resourceful man, with clear and keen judgment and supreme
self-confidence, or he can never grapple with such a task.

Supposing, then, that he succeeds in getting undetected into a
favourable position, as he thinks; at the critical moment the other ship
may change its course, and the whole scheme goes awry. Perhaps he then
tries to follow, but that is bad, for the end of a ship is not nearly so
good a target as the side and the part hit is not so vulnerable. The
first torpedo may, however, so disable the vessel as to give him chance
to get into position for a second and better shot.

Anyway, when he thinks he has got his best chance he lets off a torpedo,
immediately diving to be safe out of harm's way for a while. Then he
rises to see the result of his work. If successful he would be sure to
hear the sound, for water is an excellent sound-conductor and a
submarine is like a gigantic telephone ear-piece.

It must be a nerve-racking job at the best of times, for the submarine
is a very vulnerable craft. A member of the crew of a German submarine
captured during the war is reported to have said that out of ten
submarines attacked, nine were sunk. That may or may not be true, but it
is certain that a very little damage, which would hardly affect an
ordinary craft, is enough to sink a submarine. That is because, in order
to be able to sink at will, the reserve of buoyancy has to be very low.
An ordinary surface ship has at least as much of its bulk above water as
below: hence it can take on board a weight of water almost equal to, if
not exceeding its own weight before it sinks. At the best a submarine
has not more than 30 per cent of excess and so it sinks if water
amounting to only 30 per cent of its weight gets into it. In other
words, the reserve in one case is at least 100 per cent: in the other at
most 30 per cent.

During the war a submarine saw and tried to track down, somewhat after
the manner described, a slow, steady-going collier which plies between
London and the north carrying coal for a London gas-works. Having, as it
thought, got into position for discharging its torpedo it rose for a
final look when (it must have been to the amazement of the crew) the
collier was seen making straight for them. What they really thought no
one will ever know, for the collier had the best of the encounter, the
submarine was crushed beneath her blunt bows and sank, no doubt, for
ever. The mere fact that a slow, clumsy, heavily-laden collier could
ever thus vanquish an up-to-date submarine is eloquent testimony to
their vulnerability.

Many a submarine, too, has fallen to the shells of an armed fishing
trawler simply because the shells of the latter were so much quicker in
action than a torpedo, coupled with the fact that one well-placed shot,
by preventing a submarine from diving, renders it almost helpless.

Some submarines, however, have a gun on the deck, so that when light
they can fight like a destroyer or other lightly-armed vessel. The gun
shuts down into a cavity when the vessel goes below.

The periscope, which forms such an important part of the submarine's
equipment, is really very little more than a telescope. On the top there
is a little mirror, or more probably a prism or three-cornered piece of
glass which serves precisely the same purpose in that it reflects
exactly as a mirror does. This is so placed that it throws the light
from distant objects down the tube into the interior of the ship. In the
tube are lenses very like those of an ordinary telescope and the light
may be made to throw a picture upon a little table or screen or else can
be viewed through another prism directly by the eye. In either case the
periscope is just like an ordinary telescope set up vertically with a
prism at the top so that it can "see" at right angles, and possibly
another at the bottom so that the picture can be viewed at right angles
to the direction of the tube. The latter is necessary only for the
convenience of the observer, since otherwise he would have to be upon
his back to look up the tube. The whole apparatus can be rotated
mechanically and a scale forms a means of measuring the precise
direction in which the prism or mirror is at any moment pointed. This is
useful for measuring roughly the position of the "prey," and it may
even be used as a rough means of getting the range.

Another feature is the gyroscope compass, to which a passing reference
has already been made. It is fairly well known that an object when
spinning exhibits properties quite different from those which it
possesses when still. A boy's top is a familiar illustration, for while
spinning it will stand perfectly steady, supported only upon a tall peg
with a sharp point, a pose which it will absolutely refuse to maintain
when not spinning. Now fortunately for the present purpose it so happens
that one of the peculiarities of the gyroscope or spinning-wheel is
this: that if mounted in a certain way it persists in placing its axis
in the same plane as that in which the axis of the earth lies. If you
imagine for a moment a plane or flat surface of which the earth's axis
forms a part you will see that wherever that plane cuts the surface of
the earth will be a line in a north and south direction. Consequently,
if any horizontal object has its axis in that same plane it, too, will
always point north and south. A wheel, small but heavy, is therefore
mounted with its axis supported horizontally upon a little metal raft
floating in a trough of mercury and driven round at a very fast speed by
a small electric motor fixed in it.

Whatever its position may be to start with, this revolving wheel will in
a short time slew itself round upon the supporting mercury until its own
axis is in the same plane as the axis of the earth: until, in fact, its
axis points due north and south. Arrived in that position, it will
remain there no matter how the ship upon which it stands may turn. Since
it floats freely upon mercury the motion of the ship has little effect
upon it, so little indeed, that it has no difficulty in following its
own peculiar bent, even if the ship be describing circles.

The advantages of this are various: two of them may be stated. First,
the apparatus points to the actual geographical north and not to the
magnetic north, which is a slightly different direction and one,
moreover, subject to frequent variation. Second, it is absolutely
unaffected by the presence of iron or other magnets, a very fruitful
source of error in the magnetic compass when used upon an iron ship
close to steel guns and electrical machinery. Surrounded with iron as is
the compass in the interior of a submarine, the magnetic needle
practically refuses to work at all, so that, although employed on other
ships, it is on the submarine that the gyro-compass finds its most
important field of usefulness.

The pressure-gauge or manometer, which indicates the depth, is probably
not different in any respect, except in its dial, which is marked in
feet-depth instead of in pounds-pressure, from the pressure-gauge used
on steam boilers. It has either a little cylinder with a piston in it
which the water presses upwards more or less against the force of a
spring, a diaphragm which is bent more or less, or a bent tube which
tries to straighten itself out as the pressure inside it increases.

The older submarines derived their power from petrol engines similar to
those which drive high-power motor-cars, but nowadays these have given
place to engines of the type invented by the unfortunate Diesel who,
after making one of the most brilliant and successful inventions of
modern times, committed suicide, apparently in the height of his
success.

These engines burn cheap heavy oil in place of the costly refined
petrol: they are exceedingly reliable and well-behaved, and are free
from many of the troubles which affect the petrol motor. They are
referred to in more detail in another chapter.

In twin-screw boats there are two distinct engines, one for each
propeller. Each engine, too, is coupled to a dynamo by which it can
generate electric current, which is stored in large accumulator
batteries until required and then withdrawn to drive the dynamos as
motors while the boat is submerged, for if you feed a dynamo with
current it becomes a motor.

A great deal of work is done, on the submarine, by compressed air, of
which large stores are carried in strong steel cylinders. For example,
the ballast is ejected from the ballast tanks, when the boat is required
to rise, not by pumps but by the action of compressed air from a
cylinder. The simple movement of a tap thus suffices to blow out the
water in a very short time. The torpedoes, too, are given their initial
push which sends them out of their tube into the water by compressed
air. In other ways, too, compressed air is employed and to facilitate
its use there are many tubes and valves whereby the cylinders and other
apparatus are connected. Like all things human, these tubes and valves
have their defects, which in this case means that they leak somewhat,
but this defect is of value since the leaking air helps to keep pure and
sweet the air inside the boat which, when submerged, the men have to
breathe.

To what extent it is used I do not know, but it is a fact that certain
chemicals, caustic soda for instance, have the power to absorb the
objectionable carbonic acid which makes tightly-shut rooms seem "close"
and uncomfortable, and if something of that sort be employed, it,
together with the fresh air which thus leaks in by accident, is
undoubtedly enough to enable men to live under water for many hours at a
stretch.

On the other hand, several instances are on record in which strong
healthy young officers have, after a course of service on a submarine,
been found to be suffering seriously from chest and lung trouble,
brought on, no doubt, by long spells of duty in this unhealthy
atmosphere.

It used to be the custom to keep some white mice on board a submarine to
give warning of the impurities in the air. Being very susceptible to the
smell of petrol vapour, which used to be a source of considerable
danger, and also to carbonic acid, these little creatures squeaked with
anxiety some time before the conditions became really dangerous, thus
giving timely warning. There is an instrument, however, which will give
an indication of this sort and probably it has been brought in to
reinforce the mice if not actually to supplant them. This interesting
little instrument, which the gasworks people use for detecting leakage,
consists of a metal drum with a porous diaphragm. Normally the pressure
of the atmosphere upon the diaphragm is equalled and balanced by the
pressure of the air inside the drum, but if there be gas in the air this
balance is upset, the diaphragm is bulged in or out and a finger is
thereby moved, which movement forms a measure of the amount of gas
present.

In conclusion, we may fittingly take a glance at what happens when a
submarine founders. Only a few years ago this occurred with lamentable
frequency, though now it is quite rare except under the actual stress of
warfare. Several interesting schemes were therefore invented to give the
men at least a sporting chance of getting to safety. One was to make the
conning-tower detachable and water-tight, so that the men could get into
it, fasten themselves in and float up to the surface. The practical
difficulties in the way prevented this being a success. For example, if
sufficiently detachable in an emergency it was difficult to make it
sufficiently water-tight in ordinary use.

Another and better device provided the men with small helmets and
jackets, like the dress of a diver very much simplified. One of these
for each man was stored in an accessible place in the boat and
partitions were devised inside the hull itself in order that whatever
happened there should be air entrapped somewhere wherein the men could
live for a time and put on their helmets in safety. Then, thus provided,
they could crawl out through the hatchway and float up to the surface.
Arrived there they could inflate their jackets by blowing into them,
open the window of the helmet and float upon the surface in comparative
safety until rescued.

This apparatus was largely installed in British submarines and a tank
was built at Portsmouth where the men could actually practise with it
under water.

A third device may also be mentioned. This takes the form of a buoy
fitted into a recess in the boat's upper surface. Sufficient line is
coiled up inside it and when the occasion arises it can be released from
inside. This does not in itself save the crew but it may go a long way
towards ensuring their safety by letting those above know just where the
sunken craft is and guiding them in their efforts to raise it.

The torpedo, the weapon without which the submarine would be practically
useless, is dealt with in another chapter. Enough has been said here to
give a good general idea of these interesting craft, their fittings,
their uses and the sort of life which befalls those who man them.



CHAPTER XX

THE STORY OF WIRELESS TELEGRAPHY


For ages people were puzzled as to the nature of light. Pythagoras, that
old Greek who invented what we now call the forty-seventh proposition of
Euclid, thought that the bright body shot off streams of tiny particles
which literally hit the observer in the eye. Sir Isaac Newton thought
the same, but for once "the greatest scientist of all time" was wrong.

For when the Danish astronomer, Romer, discovered that light travelled
at the rate of somewhere about 186,000 miles per second it dawned upon
people that it was scarcely believable that particles of any kind could
by any means be made to move so fast. So they set about searching for a
new explanation, and they found it in the idea that light was conveyed
from the bright body to the observer's eye by means of waves, and as
there cannot be waves of nothing they had to imagine a something to
exist in all the vacant spaces of the universe capable of forming the
waves of light. This something was called the luminiferous ether or
light-bearing ether. We can neither see, feel, taste nor hear it. Our
senses tell us nothing about it. Indeed, if it does really exist it
must be so very different from anything that we do know by our senses
that one is often tempted to doubt its existence. Still, it explains so
many things which are otherwise unexplainable and enables us so
correctly to reason from one phenomenon to another that our reason
forces us to accept it as a fact, at all events until something better
comes along.

This wave theory in regard to light was finally set at rest by the
curious discovery about a century ago by Dr. Thomas Young of London that
if two lots of light were brought together in a certain way they
produced darkness.

Now if a ray of light were a stream of particles, two such rays would
inevitably and always, if added together, produce a doubly brilliant
light, and under no conceivable circumstances could they do anything
else. But two lots of waves can, and do, under the proper conditions,
neutralize each other so as to produce rest.

This mutual action upon each other of two sets of waves can be very
simply exhibited by two violin strings tuned to _nearly but not quite
the same note_. If you have a violin handy, try it and you will find
that when either string is plucked separately it gives a steady
continuous sound, but if both be plucked at the same time they give a
throbbing sound. That is because, periodically, as one string is coming
up the other is going down, so that they neutralize each other, while at
other times, owing to the fact that one is vibrating faster than its
fellow, both are rising and falling together. When neutralizing each
other there is a momentary silence, while in between the silences come
the times when both are acting together and therefore producing a
specially loud sound. And so as the vibrations of the faster keep
gaining upon those of the slower string one hears a continual crescendo
and then diminuendo repeated over and over again. So two sets of sound
waves sometimes produce silence.

And in like manner two sets of light waves can be made so to "interfere"
(that is the technical term) that together they produce darkness.

So for a hundred years or more people have, generally speaking, accepted
the idea that light consists of waves in a medium called The Ether. Heat
also is brought to us from the sun and from any distant hot body by
similar means, the difference between light waves and heat waves being
simply in their wave length or the distance apart. The different colours
of light, too, are to be accounted for by different wave lengths.

You have of course seen how a magnet can act upon a piece of iron at a
distance. You may, too, have tried the experiment of jerking a magnet
past a piece of wire, thereby generating an electric current in the
wire. Both those things need, for explanation, that we assume the
existence of a something invisible and undetectable by our senses
between the magnet and the iron and between the magnet and the wire, by
which the action of one is conveyed to the other. So people imagined
another Ether capable of acting like a link between the magnet and the
iron and between the magnet and the wire.

Now just about half a century ago a celebrated professor of Cambridge
University brought all these facts about light, heat, magnetism and
electricity together and by skilful reasoning showed that but one Ether
sufficed to explain all these things. He showed how magnetic and
electric forces acting together could produce waves like those of light
and heat. And finally he demonstrated by figures that waves so formed
would necessarily travel at the very speed at which light and heat are
known to move.

This is known as the electro-magnetic theory of light. And not content
with showing the nature of things already known, Professor Clerk-Maxwell
added a prophecy that there were other waves in existence of longer wave
length, which no one then knew how to make or to detect if made.

Following up this prophecy many investigators sought these waves, and
the first to find them was Professor Hertz of Carlsruhe in Germany.
Fortunately for his position in the minds of English people he died
before the War, so that his name is not sullied by the stupidities of
which German professors in more recent days have been guilty. On the
contrary, his writings show him to have been a kindly, modest, genial
soul, and particularly gratifying is his generous assertion in one of
his books that had he not himself discovered these waves he is certain
Sir Oliver Lodge would have done so. He seemed quite anxious to share
the credit of his discovery with his "English colleague" as he called
him.

Let us see then how these "Hertzian waves" are produced. In the year
1748 a Dutch experimenter named Cuneus thought he would try to
electrify water. He got a glass flask and filled it with water into
which he let drop one end of a chain connected to an old-fashioned
frictional electrical machine. Thus he stood with the flask in his hand
while a friend worked the machine. After a short time the friend stopped
and Cuneus took hold of the chain to lift it out, when to his
astonishment he received a shock which knocked him over, broke his flask
and sent him to bed to recover.

Unwittingly Cuneus had invented what became known thereafter as a Leyden
jar, Leyden being the town in which he lived. It consisted, you will
notice, of two conductors, the water and his hand, with an insulator,
the glass, in between.

To understand or rather to give ourselves a useful working explanation
of how such an apparatus comes to be charged we must first imagine that
everything contains a certain normal amount of electricity which we can
by certain means add to or take away from at will. When we add some to
anything we say we have given it a positive charge: when we subtract
some we say that we have imparted a negative charge. Clearly, if we add
some to one thing we must first obtain it from something else, and if we
take some away from one thing we must do something with what we have
taken, and so we add it to something else. Therefore whenever we charge
anything positively we must charge something else negatively and vice
versa.

Now the ease with which we can thus charge two bodies seems to depend
upon their nearness to each other, so that the easiest things to charge
are two plates of metal separated by the thinnest possible insulator.
Modern Leyden jars are usually formed of a thin glass jar with a lining
inside and out of tinfoil.

The Leyden jar is, however, only one form of the piece of electrical
apparatus known as an electrical condenser, and many other forms exist.
For example, a flat sheet of glass with foil above and below, or several
such piled one on top of another. An eminent electrician whom I know has
recently made some of two tin patty pans put bottom to bottom, nearly
but not quite touching, the whole being enclosed in a solid block of
paraffin wax. And I might describe many other forms, but whatever they
may be every one is essentially two conductors with an insulator
between.

Now when a condenser has been charged its charges remain for a
considerable time unless they be given a chance to escape. Suppose you
have a charged condenser and that you take a wire and with it touch
simultaneously both the conductors, the surplus on one "plate" will rush
through the wire and make good the deficiency upon the other; it will
thus in an instant become discharged.

Now several scientific men had suggested, before Hertz's time, that when
that occurred something else happened too. They thought that the charge
did not simply rush from one plate to the other instantly, but that it
oscillated to and fro for a period; that the surplus rushing round
overshot the mark, so to speak, and not only made up the deficiency but
caused a surplus on the opposite plate, after which this new surplus
rushed back again through the wire, doing the same thing, though to a
less and less degree, several times over before a condition of perfect
rest was reached. To use a simple analogy, it was thought that the
surplus swung to and fro like the swinging of a pendulum. We know that a
pendulum swings because of its inertia, and electricity possesses a
property very like inertia which, it was thought, would cause it to
behave in the same way.

The Ether waves travel at the rate of 186,000 miles per second, so that
if, as was thought, a sudden current of electricity gives rise to a
wave, currents which succeed each other at the rate of one per second
would produce waves 186,000 miles apart. A hundred currents per second
would give a wave length of 1860 miles. A thousand per second would give
186 miles. But a thousand succeeding currents per second are difficult
to produce, and 186 miles is so very much greater than the tiny fraction
of an inch, which is the length of the light and heat waves, that Hertz
had to find some way of making currents succeed each other faster even
than a thousand times per second.

So he thought of these oscillating currents which were supposed to occur
when a condenser was discharged, and he rigged up a condenser with an
induction coil and a spark gap in a way which he thought would do what
he wanted.

There is not room here to explain the Induction Coil, indeed it is so
well known that it will be quite sufficient to state that it is an
apparatus which takes steady current from a battery and gives back
instead a lot of little spurts or splashes of current at a rate of,
say, fifty or one hundred splashes per second, according as we adjust
the little vibrating spring which forms a part of the coil. We can so
connect this to a condenser that each splash will charge it up; and we
can combine with it a spark-gap, that is to say, a gap between two
knobs, so that every time it is charged it immediately discharges again
through this gap. Thus we may have, say, one hundred splashes per
second, and each splash is followed by several oscillations across the
air-gap, the oscillations taking place at the rate of perhaps a million
per second. Each series of oscillations is called a "train."

Now a million per second gives a wave-length somewhere about what Hertz
wanted, so he arranged his apparatus as just described.

For a condenser he used two metal plates a little distance apart, the
air between forming the insulating material. He set up his apparatus in
a large room, and having started the coil he moved about with a nearly
complete hoop of wire, the ends of which nearly touched. Working in
darkness he found after a while that sometimes he could see little
sparks, very small but just visible across the gap between the ends of
the bent wire. Those sparks only occurred when the coil was in action,
and so he knew that the one was the result of the other's work. By
careful painstaking experiment he found that the sparks were
unquestionably caused by waves, and that the waves moved with the same
speed as light, also that they could be reflected and refracted just on
precisely the same principles as those which control light. Moreover,
he measured the wave-length.

At first sight it seems incredible that anyone could measure the
distance apart of waves which travel at such a speed as 186,000 miles
per second, but fortunately, by a special application of "interference,"
it is possible to make the waves stand still and tamely submit to
measurement. An example of this can be seen by simply tapping a glass of
water, when the ripples being reflected off the sides interfere with
each other and become stationary. Stationary waves are half the
wave-length of the original waves, and by using this method Hertz was
able to make a measurement which at first sight seems beyond the bounds
of possibility.

Thus Hertz discovered how to make the waves which Clerk-Maxwell had
predicted and also how to detect them when made.

It was not long before the idea arose of using these waves for
signalling to a distance. Many experiments were made but with no very
striking success until 1896 when Marconi first came to England.

Hertz had noticed that the farther apart he placed the plates of his
condenser the farther could he get his tell-tale spark, so Marconi saw
that the plates of his condenser, too, must be far apart. He also found
that the earth could be used as one of the plates, that in fact there
was a great advantage in so using it. So, one plate having to be the
earth itself and the other removed as far as possible from it, the tall
masts of the wireless antenna came into being.

[Illustration: LISTENING FOR THE ENEMY.

Special sensitive cylinders are sunk into the ground to which the usual
telephonic apparatus is fixed. This enables the sappers to detect any
underground operations by the enemy.]

When Marconi came to England he was taken under the kindly wing of Sir
William Preece, the veteran engineer of the Post Office, and the
facilities which Sir William was able to give no doubt helped largely in
his subsequent rapid progress. After a few experiments in London he got
to work across the Channel, sending messages from the North Foreland
Lighthouse to Wimereux on the coast of France, including congratulatory
messages between the French authorities and good Queen Victoria.

A little later he was signalling from Niton in the Isle of Wight to the
mainland and to the far west at the Lizard. The first wireless telegram
which was actually paid for was sent by Lord Kelvin, the father of cable
telegraphy, from Niton to the mainland, whence it was transmitted by
land wires to Sir George Stokes. This incident, so interesting because
of its marking a stage in the history of this great invention, also
because of the persons concerned, occurred in 1898.

But Marconi was quickly increasing the range of his apparatus far beyond
anything already mentioned. He journeyed in the Italian warship _Carlo
Alberto_ as far north as Cronstadt and as far east as Italy, keeping in
communication with England all the time. Then he crossed the Atlantic,
again keeping up communication with England the greater part of the
journey.

Raising his wires to a great height by means of kites he was soon able
to signal from Nova Scotia to the great station just previously built at
Poldhu in Cornwall, and then wireless telegraphy from land to land
across the great ocean became an accomplished fact.

We all know how things have progressed since then. A telegram by Marconi
is as commonplace to-day as a telegram by cable. The British Government
is now engaged upon a series of stations dotted about the globe in such
a way that every part of the widely separated British Empire shall be in
constant touch with every other part by wireless telegraphy. In other
words, the range of the system has now become such that nothing further
is needed.

The British Admiralty has a few wires slung to posts on the top of the
offices in London, and those few wires enable touch to be maintained
with ships. As almost every intelligent newspaper reader in Great
Britain knows, the Germans were in the habit, during the war, of sending
news to the United States by wireless telegraphy, which news was always
picked up by the Admiralty installation and circulated to the British
newspapers, often to the amusement of their British readers.

The famous _Emden_, too, which had such a run of success until it
encountered the Australian cruiser _Sydney_, met its end entirely
through the intervention of wireless telegraphy.

These incidents give us a good idea of the usefulness of wireless in
naval warfare. In military work it is used chiefly in connection with
air-craft, but of that more will be said in another chapter.

[Illustration: TRANSMITTER. RECEIVER.

DIAGRAM SHOWING THE PRINCIPLE BY WHICH THE AERIALS ARE CONNECTED TO THE
APPARATUS.]



CHAPTER XXI

WIRELESS TELEGRAPHY IN WAR


The history of this wonderful invention has been described in the
preceding chapter. Now we will see how it is applied in warfare.

Let us take first its uses in connection with the Navy. The aerial wires
or antenna are stretched to the top of the highest mast of the vessel.
Where there are two masts they often span between the two. Ships which
have masts for no other reason are supplied with them for this special
purpose. In the case of submarines, the whole thing, mast and wires
included, is temporary and can be taken down or put up quickly and
easily at will.

The stations ashore are equipped much after the same manner as are the
ships, except that sometimes they are a little more elaborate, as they
may well be since they do not suffer from the same limitations. For
example, the well-known antenna over the Admiralty buildings in London
consists of three masts placed at the three corners of a triangle with
wires stretched between all three.

However these wires may be arranged and supported they are very
carefully insulated from their supports, for when sending they have to
be charged with current at a high voltage and need good insulation to
prevent its escape, while, in receiving, the currents induced in them
are so very faint that good insulation is required in order that there
may not be the slightest avoidable loss.

The function of these wires, it will be understood, is to form one plate
of a condenser, the earth being the other plate and the air in between
the "dielectric" or insulator.

In the case of ships "the earth" is represented by the hull of the
vessel. It makes a particularly good "earth" since it is in perfect
contact with a vast mass of salt water, and that again is in contact
with a vast area of the earth's surface. Salt water is a surprisingly
good conductor of electricity.

In land stations "earth" consists of a metal plate well buried in damp
ground. The whole question of conduction of electricity through the
earth is very perplexing. There seems to be resistance offered to the
current at the point where it enters the ground, but after that none at
all. Consequently the resistance between two earth plates a few yards
apart and between similar ones a thousand miles apart is about the same.
Though the earth is made up mainly of what, in small quantities, are
very bad conductors indeed, taking the earth as a whole it is an
exceedingly good conductor. That makes it all the more important that
where the current enters should be made as good a conductor as possible,
and the construction and location of the earth plates is therefore very
carefully considered so as to get the best results.

Wires, of course, connect the antenna to the earth, thereby forming what
is called an "oscillatory circuit." The ordinary electric circuit is a
complete path of wire or other good conductor around which the current
can flow in a continuous stream. An oscillatory circuit is one which is
incomplete, but the ends of which are so formed that they constitute the
two "plates" of a condenser. In that way, according to theory, the
circuit is completed between the two ends by a strain or distortion in
the "Ether" between them. A continuous current will not flow in such a
circuit, but an alternating, intermittent or oscillating current will
flow in it in many respects as if there were no gap at all but a
complete ring of wire.

At some convenient point in this oscillatory circuit are inserted the
wireless instruments, one set for sending and the other set for
receiving, either being brought into circuit at will by the simple
movement of a switch.

In small installations the central feature of the sending apparatus is
an Induction Coil operated by a suitable battery or by current from a
dynamo. Connected with it is a suitable spark gap consisting of two or
three metal balls well insulated and so arranged that the distance
between them can be delicately adjusted. This is generally done by a
screw arrangement with insulating handles, so that the operator can
safely adjust them while the current is on.

The current from the battery or dynamo to the coil is controlled by a
key similar to those used in ordinary telegraphy, the action being such
that on depressing the key the current flows and the coil pours forth a
torrent of sparks between the knobs of the spark-gap, but on letting the
key up again the sparks cease. Since the sparks send out etherial waves
which in turn affect the distant receiving apparatus it follows that a
signal is sent whenever the key is depressed. Moreover, if the key be
held down a short time a short signal is sent, but if it be kept
depressed for a little longer a long signal is sent, by which means
intelligible messages can be transmitted over vast distances.

Certain specified wave lengths are always used in wireless telegraphy.
That is to say, the waves are sent out at a certain rate so that they
follow each other at a certain distance apart. In other words, it is
necessary to be able to adjust the rate at which the currents will
oscillate between the antenna and earth. Every oscillatory circuit
possesses two properties which are characteristic of it. These two
properties are known as Capacity and Inductance. It is not necessary to
explain here what these terms mean precisely. It is quite sufficient
just to name them and to state that the rate at which oscillations take
place in such a circuit depends upon the combined effect of these two
properties. Consequently, if we can arrange things so that capacity or
inductance or both can be added to a circuit at will and in any quantity
within limits, we can within those limits obtain any rate of oscillation
which we desire and consequently send out the message-bearing waves at
any interval we like; in other words, we can adjust the wave-length at
will.

Fortunately, it is very easy to add these properties to an oscillatory
circuit in a very simple manner. A certain little instrument called a
"tuner" is connected up in the circuit and by the simple movement of a
few handles the desired result can be obtained quickly even by an
operator with but a moderate experience. He has certain graduated scales
to guide him, and he is only called upon to work according to a
prearranged rule in order to obtain any of the regulation wave-lengths.

As a matter of fact, the instruments are not directly inserted in the
antenna circuit, the circuit that is which is formed by the aerial
wires, the earth and the inter-connecting wires. Instead, the two sides
of the spark-gap are connected together so as to form a separate circuit
of their own, the local circuit as we might call it, and then the two
circuits, the antenna circuit and the local circuit, are connected
together by "induction."

A coil of wire is formed in each, and these two coils are wound together
so that currents in one winding induce similar currents in the other
winding, and by that means the oscillations set up by the coil in the
local circuit are transformed into similar oscillations in the antenna
circuit. This transformation involves certain losses, but it is found in
practice to be by far the most effective arrangement. Both the circuits
have to be tuned to the desired wave length, but that is done quite
easily by the operation of the handles in the tuner already referred to.

It is to this coupling together of tuned circuits that Marconi's most
famous patent relates. It is registered in the British Patent Office
under the number 7777, and hence is known as the "four sevens" patent.
It has been the subject of much litigation, which proves its
exceptional importance, and it is to the fact that the Marconi Company
have been able to sustain their rights under it that they owe their
commanding position to-day in the realm of wireless telegraphy.

The Receiving Apparatus also consists of a separate local circuit which
can be coupled when desired to the antenna circuit through a
transformer. The same simple tuning arrangement is made to affect this
circuit also, so that the "multiple tuner," as the instrument is called,
controls all the circuits both for sending and for receiving. The
oscillations caused in the antenna circuit by the action upon it of the
etherial waves flowing from the distant transmitting station pass
through one winding of the transformer and thereby induce similar
oscillations in the local receiving circuit which are made perceptible
by the receiving instrument.

Reference has already been made to the original form of receiving
apparatus called the Coherer. This, however, has been very largely
superseded by the Magnetic Detector of Marconi and the Crystal Detector,
both of which make the signals perceivable as buzzing sounds in the
telephone.

The magnetic detector owes its existence to the fact that oscillations
tend to destroy magnetism in iron. It is believed that every molecule of
iron is itself a tiny magnet. If that be so one would expect every piece
of iron to be a magnet, which we know it is not. We can always make a
piece of iron into a magnet by putting another magnet near it, but when
we take the other magnet away the iron loses its power, or to be
precise it _almost_ loses it. A piece of even the best and softest iron
having once been magnetized retains a little magnetic power which we
call "residual" magnetism.

All this is easily explained if we remember first that a heap of tiny
magnets lying higgledy-piggledy would in fact exhibit no magnetic power
outside the heap. If, however, we brought a powerful magnet near them it
would have the effect of pulling a lot of them into the same position,
of arranging them in fact so that instead of all more or less
neutralizing each other they could act together and help each other.
Then the heap would become magnetic. On removing the powerful magnet,
however, a lot of the little ones would be sure to fall down again into
their old places and so the heap would at once lose a large part of its
power, yet some would remain and so it would retain a certain amount of
"residual" magnetism. If, then, you were to give the table on which the
little magnets rest a good shake, the "higgledy-piggledyness" would be
restored and even the "residual" magnetism would vanish.

So we believe that the little molecules lie just anyhow, wherefore they
neutralize each other and the mass of iron is powerless. When another
magnet comes near, however, they are more or less pulled into the right
position and the iron becomes magnetized. When the magnet is removed the
magnetism which it produced is largely lost, and if last of all we give
the iron a smart blow with a hammer even the residual magnetism vanishes
too.

Now, oscillations taking place in the neighbourhood of a piece of iron
possessing residual magnetism have much the same effect as the blow of a
hammer. Probably because of its rapidity an oscillating current shakes
the molecules up and strews them about at random, entirely destroying
any orderly arrangement of them. And Marconi used that fact in detecting
oscillations.

Two little coils of wire are wound together, one inside the other.
Through the centre of the innermost there runs an endless band of soft
iron wire. Stretched on two rollers this band travels steadily along,
the motive power being clockwork, so that it is always entering the coil
at one end and leaving it at the other. As it travels it passes close to
two powerful steel magnets, so that as it enters the coil it is always
slightly magnetized. The oscillations are passed through one of the two
concentric coils, and their action is to remove suddenly the residual
magnetism in that part of the moving wire which is at the moment passing
through. That sudden demagnetization then affects the second of the
concentric coils, inducing currents in it, not of an oscillating nature
but of an ordinary intermittent kind which can make themselves audible
in a telephone which is connected with the coil.

This arrangement, then, causes the oscillations, which will not operate
a telephone, to produce other currents of a different nature which will.

The reason why oscillations have no effect in a telephone is no doubt
because they change so rapidly, at rates, as has been mentioned already,
of the order of a million per second. The telephone diaphragm, light
and delicate though it is, is far too gross and heavy to respond to such
rapidly changing impulses as that. In the magnetic detector the
difficulty is overcome by making them change the magnetic condition of
some iron wire which change in turn produces currents capable of
operating a telephone. The Crystal Detector achieves the same result in
another way.

There are certain substances, of which carborundum is a notable example,
which conduct electricity more readily in one direction than the other.
Most of these substances are crystalline in their nature, and hence the
detector in which they are used gets its name. Carborundum, by the way,
is a sort of artificial diamond produced in the electric furnace and
largely used as a grinding material in place of emery.

It is easy to see that by passing an oscillating current, which is a
very rapidly alternating current, through one of these one-direction
conductors one half of each oscillation is more or less stopped.
Oscillations, again, are surgings to and fro: the crystal tends to let
the "tos" go through and to stop the "fros." That does not quite explain
all that happens. It is not fully understood. The fact remains, however,
that by putting a crystal in series with the telephone the oscillations
become directly audible. The term "in series with" means that both
crystal and telephone are inserted in the local receiving circuit so
that the currents in that circuit pass through both in succession.

The resistance of the crystal being very great, a special telephone is
needed for use with it. It is quite an ordinary telephone, however,
except in that it is wound with a great many turns of very fine wire and
is therefore called a high-resistance telephone.

Whichever of these detectors be used, then, the operator sits, with his
telephone clipped on to his head, and with his tuner set for that wave
length at which his station is scheduled to work, listening for signals.
He may go for hours without being called up, and in the meantime he may
hear many signals intended for others. He knows they are not for him,
since every message is preceded by a code signal indicating to whom it
is addressed.

Under the conditions of warfare there is far more listening than there
is sending, but when a station wishes to send the operator just switches
over, cutting out his receiving apparatus and bringing his transmitting
instruments into operation, and, having adjusted his tuner for the wave
length of the station to which he desires to communicate, he flings out
his message.

In war-time, too, there is much listening for the signals of the enemy,
which is the reason why as few messages are sent out as possible. In
this case the man sits with his telephone on his head carefully changing
his tuner from time to time in the endeavour to catch any message in any
wave-length which may be travelling about. This searching the ether for
a chance message of the enemy must be at times a very wearisome job, but
it must be varied with very exciting intervals.

On aircraft it is clear that no earth connection is possible. The
antenna in that case usually hangs vertically down from the machine or
airship. Under these conditions the valuable effect of the earth
connection is of course lost. As will be remembered, the earth-connected
apparatus sends forth waves which cling more or less to the
neighbourhood of the earth's surface, while those from the non-earthed
apparatus as used by aircraft tend to fly in all directions. The latter
apparatus is in fact almost precisely similar to that which Hertz used
in his first experiments. Hence the range is comparatively poor under
these conditions, but it is good enough for very valuable work in
warfare. Communication between airman and artillery by this means has
revolutionized the handling of large guns in the field.

To save the airman from the accidental catching of his aerial wire in a
tree or on a building there is sometimes fitted a contrivance of the
nature of wire-cutters so that he can at any moment cut himself free
from it.

So far we have dealt almost exclusively with the naval and aerial use of
this wonderful invention. It is employed, though in a lesser degree, in
land warfare. In such cases the aerial may be merely a wire thrown on to
and caught up on a high tree. More elaborate devices are used, however,
such as a high telescopic tower similar to the tall fire-escape ladders
of the fire-brigades. Anyone who has seen the ladders rush up to a
burning building and commence to erect themselves almost before they
have stopped will realise how valuable such a machine must be for
forming a temporary and easily movable wireless antenna. The power which
causes the tall tower to extend itself erect in a few seconds is
compressed air carried in cylinders upon the machine, while the power
which takes it from place to place is a petrol motor, and since the
latter can be made to re-charge the storage cylinders it is clear that
in it we have a marvellously convenient adjunct to the wireless
apparatus.

But apart from such carefully prepared devices the men of the Royal
Engineers are past masters in the art of rigging up, according to the
conditions of the moment, all sorts of makeshift apparatus whereby
signalling over quite long ranges can be carried on by "wireless." Such
improvisations, could they be recorded, would constitute war inventions
of a high order.



CHAPTER XXII

MILITARY TELEGRAPHY


Telegraphy plays a very important part in warfare. The commander of even
a small unit cannot see all that his men are doing or suffering, but is
kept posted by telegraph or telephone, while communication between units
depends very largely indeed upon such means. Wireless telegraphy, in
land warfare, is largely devoted to communication between aircraft and
the artillery batteries with which they are working, and to avoid
interference with that important work telegraphy _by wire_ is employed
for most other purposes.

Right at the front this communication is kept up by means of that type
of instrument which the soldiers call a "buzzer," for the good and
sufficient reason that that is really what it does.

In view of the fact that soldiers speak of their home-land, for which
they are enduring all manner of risk and hardship, and to which they are
longing to return, by the contemptuous-sounding name of "Blighty," we
might expect that what they call a buzzer has nothing whatever to do
with making sound, but in this case the name describes the thing very
aptly. Its sole purpose and intent is to make buzzing sounds of either
long or short duration.

Perhaps the simplest way in which I can describe this useful and
interesting invention is by telling you how you can make one for
yourself. It is nothing more than an electric-bell mechanism connected
up in a certain way.

As most people know, an electric bell contains a magnet made of two
round pieces of iron placed parallel and yoked together at one end by
means of a third piece of iron, generally flat, while on to each round
piece is threaded a bobbin of insulated wire. The iron becomes a magnet
when, and only when, current flows through the wire.

Near the free ends of the round pieces, or the poles of the magnet, to
use the orthodox term, is placed another little piece of iron called the
armature, carried upon a light spring. When the current flows in the
wire the armature is pulled towards the poles against the force of the
spring, but when the current ceases the magnet lets go and the armature,
urged by the spring, swings back again.

Behind the armature is a little post through which passes a screw tipped
with platinum, and in operation this screw is advanced until its point
touches a small plate of platinum carried by the armature. Connection
for the current is made to this "contact screw" whence it passes to the
armature, through the spring to the wire upon the magnet, through that
and away. On completing the circuit, then, as when you push the button
at the front door, current flows and energizes the magnet. A moment
later, however, the armature moves, breaks the contact with the screw
and stops the current. Then the magnet lets go and the armature springs
back, making contact once more and setting the current flowing again.
These actions repeat themselves over and over again quite automatically,
and the hammer which is attached to the armature vibrates accordingly.

That is the ordinary familiar electric bell. Cut off the hammer and you
have a buzzer with which excellent telegraph signals can be sent.

So much for the sending apparatus. The receiving device is simply an
ordinary telephone receiver. There is sometimes a little confusion in
people's minds because of this. A telephone is used, but it is used as a
telegraph instrument. The sounds heard in it are not speech but long and
short buzzing sounds which, being interpreted according to the code of
Morse, deliver up their message.

Now the telephone, by which term is always meant the receiver (the
sending part of the telephone apparatus being a "microphone"), is one of
the most remarkable pieces of electrical apparatus which the mind of man
has ever conceived. It is astonishingly robust. With ordinary care you
cannot damage it. There is no need whatever to keep it wrapped in cotton
wool or even to keep it in a case. Without harm you can put it loose in
your pocket. Within reason you may even drop it a few times without
harm. Its cost is only a few shillings. Yet its sensitiveness is simply
astounding. It will detect the existence of currents so small that any
other type of instrument to deal with them has to be extremely delicate
and costly.

It consists of a magnet fitted into a little brass case with a little
piece of soft iron fixed on each pole, while each of these "pole-pieces"
is surrounded by a tiny coil of wire. The lid of the box is a disc of
thin sheet-iron, and things are so proportioned that the pole pieces
nearly but not quite touch this sheet-iron "diaphragm."

An outer cover, generally of ebonite, serves to catch the sound-waves
caused by any movement of the diaphragm and convey them to the ear.

The action of the permanent magnet tends to pull the diaphragm
inwards--to bulge it in slightly--so that it is in a state of very
unstable equilibrium. Because of this instability a very tiny current
flowing through the coils and either adding to or subtracting from the
strength of the magnet is sufficient either to draw it still closer or
to let it recede a little. Whether it approaches or recedes depends upon
the direction of the current through the coils and makes no difference
to the sound. The movement of the diaphragm is great or small according
as the current is strong or weak: any variation in the current causes a
perfectly corresponding movement in the diaphragm. Even those very small
and very complex changes in air-pressure which give us the sensation of
sound are very faithfully followed by this simple bit of sheet iron, so
that the sounds are faithfully reproduced for our benefit. At the
moment, however, we are not dealing with speech but with buzzing sounds,
which are very simple, being merely a rapid succession of "ticks."

The telephone, it must be remembered, takes no notice of a steady
current, except when it starts and stops. But each time that occurs it
gives a tick. Hence, if we start and stop a current very rapidly, or to
use another term, make it rapidly intermittent, we get a rapid
succession of ticks, and if rapid enough they form a humming, buzzing,
or singing sound. If very fast you can get a positive shriek. The
precise character of the sound depends entirely upon the rapidity of the
intermittency.

Now it is easy to see that the current passed through an electric-bell
mechanism is intermittent. It is the very nature of the apparatus to
make the current intermittent. It is by so doing that it works.
Therefore, if we pass the same current which works a bell through a
telephone we get a buzzing or humming sound according to the speed of
interruption.

The vibration of the armature itself also causes a humming sound of a
similar note or tone to that heard in the telephone, but it must be
clearly understood that these two sounds are quite different. One is the
result of mechanical motion, the other is the result of electrical
action producing motion in the diaphragm of the telephone. When you
listen in the telephone it is not that you hear the sound of the bell
mechanism, you hear another sound altogether, although, since both have
the same origin, both have the same note or tone.

Take any old bell, then, which you may happen to have or be able to
procure and an old telephone such as can be bought for a shilling or so
at a second-hand shop, and these together with a pocket-lamp battery can
be formed into a military field telegraph.

The way to connect these up is to run a wire from one of the copper
strips on the battery to one of the terminal screws on the bell, a
second wire from the other screw on the bell to one of the flexible
wires of the telephone, which may be a mile away if you like, a third
wire returning from the other flexible wire of the telephone back to the
battery. To send signals all you have to do is to touch the return wire
upon the second strip of the battery for short or long intervals,
thereby making the dot-and-dash signals. Or a simple form of key can
easily be contrived for the purpose.

Every time you complete the circuit the buzzer will buzz, in other
words, it will permit an intermittent current to pass round the circuit
and a buzzing or humming sound will be heard in the telephone, no matter
how far away it may be.

This arrangement, however, involves two wires between the two stations,
and in practice only one is usual. This could be arranged by running the
third wire from the telephone not back to the sending station but to a
peg driven into the earth, connecting the second pole of the battery in
like manner to an earth pin at the sending end. Thus the return wire
would be done away with and the earth utilized instead. To do that,
unfortunately, you would need to increase very greatly the power of your
battery, for although the path through the earth itself offers
practically no resistance at all to the current, the actual places where
the current passes to earth and from earth, especially if they be simply
temporary pegs driven into the ground, offer very considerable
resistance, so that in order to get enough current through the buzzer
to make it work would need a powerful battery. There is another way,
however, by which that difficulty can be overcome quite easily.

Probably all my readers know something of the induction or shocking
coil, wherein intermittent currents in one part of the coil induce
intermittent currents of a somewhat different kind in another part of
the coil. Few people realize, however, that the same effect can be
attained, within limits, in a single coil such as the winding upon the
magnet of an electric bell.

Watch a bell at work and you will notice a bright spark at the place
where the contact is made and broken. That spark is due to a sudden rush
of current which takes place in the coil when the original current is
stopped, in other words, when the contact is broken. It is as if the
coil gives a rather vicious "kick" every time the current is stopped.
There is not much electricity in this "kick" current, but it is very
forceful, and it is that force which makes it actually jump across the
gap after contact has been broken, thereby causing the spark.

Now we can capture most of that energy and make it go a long distance
through wire and through earth carrying our messages for us. To do this
we need to make a new connection on the bell at the place where the
spring is fixed. Then we can make two circuits. One is between the two
terminal screws of the buzzer, in which circuit we must include the
battery and the key. That circuit will be just as it would be if we were
fixing the buzzer to announce our visitors at the front door.

The second circuit is different: lead one wire from the new connection
just made and take it to a pin driven into the ground. If the ground is
just a shade moist a wire meat-skewer will answer admirably. Then lead a
second wire from that one of the two terminal screws which is connected
directly to the winding of the magnet (not to that one which is
connected to the contact screw) and lead it away to your distant
station.

At the other station connect the single wire to the telephone as before
and the other "end" of the telephone to a pin in the earth. You will
find that the "kicks" from the coil will traverse wire and earth-return
quite easily, while there will be no difficulty about working the bell,
for the small battery will do that quite well. In fact, after cutting
the hammer off and so converting a bell into a buzzer, I have got quite
good results with one-third of a pocket-lamp battery. The little flat
batteries so familiar to us all if divested of their outer covering will
be found to consist of three little dry cells any one of which is quite
capable of sending messages in the way described as far as any amateur
is likely to want to send.

To be able to send and receive at either end it is only necessary to
connect both telephones and both coils "in series." That is to say,
connect one end of the coil to the long wire and the other to one wire
of the telephone, the other wire of the telephone being connected to
earth. If this be done at both ends signals can be sent and received
both ways.

Many young readers, scouts, members of cadet corps and the like, will
find great pleasure and interest in constructing and working this
apparatus, besides which it shows precisely what the official "buzzer"
is like.

Although beautifully made, of course, the army instrument is essentially
just that and little more. It has an additional feature, however,
namely, a microphone, so that when desired it can be used as a speaking
telephone for transmitting verbal messages. It also has the bottom of
the case made of a brass plate so that earth pins are often unnecessary,
the case dumped down upon the ground being a good enough "earth."

Buzzers are not used for very long lines: forty miles is about the
limit, and usually the distances are very much less. That is because
long lines rather object to rapidly changing currents flowing through
them. Why, you say, what currents could change more rapidly than
telephone currents carrying speech, yet they go for hundreds of miles?
True, but in that case there are two wires, flow and return, twisted
together all the way, under which conditions they interact upon each
other in such a manner as to abolish the difficulty to which I am
referring. Buzzers and indeed all the telegraph circuits consist of one
wire and the earth, which is quite different.

Another objection to the buzzer is that it is apt to interfere with
others. For instance, if two buzzer sets are at work anywhere near each
other and the wires run parallel for a distance they will be able to
hear each other's signals as well as their own. If two such sets are
earthed near together the same thing happens, the signals of one are
picked up by the other, a very annoying state of affairs for the
operators.

Right at the front, however, amid the rough and tumble of the actual
fighting, the buzzer is supreme. The wire used is sometimes plain copper
enamelled: more often, however, it is a mixture of steel and copper
strands twisted together and covered with a strong insulating covering.
This is carried on reels in properly fitted carts which can advance at a
gallop, paying out the wire as they go. The inner end of the wire is
connected to the axle of the reel in such a way that a telegraphist in
the cart is in communication all the time with the starting-point, the
wheels of the cart providing him with an earth connection.

When laying these wires another interesting little device is often
used--an earth plate on the operator's heel. Thus, while carrying the
wire along, laying it as he goes, he can still be in communication with
the starting-point every time he puts his heel to the ground.

For the longer lines away back from the fighting the methods employed
are just the same as those of peace. "Sounder" instruments are used,
Wheatstone automatic machines, duplex and quadruplex systems, whereby
two and four messages are sent simultaneously over the same wire, indeed
all the contrivances and refinements of the home telegraph office are to
be found in the field telegraph offices. But it would hardly be fitting
to describe them here. Some information on the subject will be found in
"The Romance of Submarine Engineering," where their application to cable
telegraphy is dealt with.

A genuine speciality of warfare, however, is the methods by which
makeshift arrangements can be set up, such as sending telegraph messages
over a telephone wire without interfering with the latter.

Imagine that A and B are the two wires of a telephone circuit running
(for the sake of simplicity) from north to south. At the south end I
connect a telegraph set to both wires while you, we will imagine, do the
same at the north end. You and I can then signal to each other without
the telephone man hearing us at all. To him the two wires are flow and
return, to us they are both "flow," the earth being our return. Thus our
signals never reach his instruments at all. But when we each connect to
both his wires, do we not "short-circuit" or connect them to each other,
thereby destroying his circuit? No, we are too cunning for that. We
first connect the two wires A and B together with a coil of closely
wound wire, having, in scientific language, much "inductance," and
telephone currents shun a coil of that sort. Then we make our connection
to the centre of that coil so that our currents go to A through half the
coil and to B through the other half. This enables us to use the
apparatus without interfering with the other fellow at all. For this, by
the way, we must use ordinary telegraph instruments. We cannot employ a
buzzer, for these coils which we use to obstruct the passage of the
other man's telephone currents would also obstruct the changing currents
from a buzzer. The slow, steady currents of the ordinary telegraph pass
quite easily, however.

Again, suppose you and I want to communicate by buzzer and there is
already a wire laid passing both of us but in use already for ordinary
telegraphy. We only need to add a "condenser" to our apparatus and we
can manage all right. As a matter of fact, the service instruments
generally have condensers partly for this very purpose. Each of us then
connects his instrument to the wire and to earth, after which we can
signal to each other while the telegraphist is unaware of the fact. The
reason that is possible is the reverse of what we saw just now. There we
had a coil which obstructed buzzer or telephone currents but passed
ordinary telegraph currents. Here we use condensers which will pass our
buzzer currents but not the ordinary telegraph currents.

Thus the soldier telegraphist is up to many dodges whereby he can save
time or save material, both of which may be precious. As in bridge
building and other branches, he needs to be quick to adapt himself to
circumstances, to utilize to the full any opportunities which may
present themselves. But his principles are quite simple and do not
differ in any way from those of peace. It is only in applying them that
the differences arise.



CHAPTER XXIII

HOW WAR INVENTIONS GROW


The inventor of one of the devices described later on in this book
modestly claims that he did not invent it but it invented itself. What
he means is that he worked step by step, from simple beginnings, each
step when complete suggesting the next. To put it another way, many
inventions grow in the inventor's mind, sometimes from unpromising
beginnings, the most unlikely start often resulting in the most
successful ending.

Who has not heard of the "tanks" which made such a name for themselves
when they suddenly appeared in Northern France? The British
Commander-in-Chief simply mentioned that a new type of armoured car had
come into use with good results, but the newspaper men set the whole
non-Teutonic world laughing with droll stories of huge monsters
suggestive of prehistoric animals which suddenly began to crawl through
the slime and mud of the battle-field, pouring death and destruction
upon the astounded Germans.

How they came to be called tanks no one seems to know clearly but that
is how they will be known for all time. It has been suggested that they
were so named because tank is one of the things which they certainly
are not, the intention being thereby to add to the mystification of the
enemy. That is by the way, however, for we are more concerned with the
things than with their name.

Their precise origin is wrapped in mystery but we have it on excellent
authority that they grew out of the peaceful "tractor," originally
intended to drag a plough to and fro across a field in the service of
the farmer. An illustration of one of these interesting machines will be
seen in this book which will well repay a little study.

It consists of a steel frame or platform upon which is mounted a
four-cylinder petrol engine with a reservoir above to carry the supply
of fuel and with a radiator in front to cool the water which keeps the
engine from becoming too hot. Towards the back of the vehicle is what is
called by engineers a worm-gear, the function of which is to reduce the
one thousand revolutions per minute of the engine to somewhere near the
slow speed required of the wheels of the tractor.

This worm-gear is simply a wheel with suitable teeth on its edge in
conjunction with a screw so made that its thread can engage comfortably
with the teeth. This latter, because of the wriggling appearance which
it presents when it is revolving is called a worm, which name it gives
to the whole apparatus. Both wheel and worm are mounted in bearings
which form part of a case enclosing the whole so that dirt is excluded
while, the case being filled with oil, ample lubrication is assured.
The shafts of both wheel and worm emerge through holes in the case.

It will easily be seen that each single turn of the worm will propel the
wheel one tooth, so that if the wheel have fifty teeth, for example, the
worm will turn fifty times to the wheel's once. Thus a great reduction
in speed is attainable with this device and what is equally valuable, a
great increase of power also results. Thus a small engine, working at a
high speed, is able by means such as this to pull very heavy loads at a
slow speed.

It is evident, however, that the reduction necessary in this case cannot
be attained even by a worm-gear, for there are other wheels visible
which show that ordinary tooth gearing is also employed to reduce the
speed even further before it is applied to driving the tractor along.
Practically all the other gear which we see in the picture, above the
platform, consists of the controlling apparatus.

The object with a screw-like appearance just behind the engine is not
really a screw but is a flexible coupling joining the engine to the
worm-gear, its "flexibility" enabling the two to work sweetly together
even though by chance they may get just a little out of line with each
other.

But by far the most interesting part of the machine is that which is
underneath the frame. At one end we see a pair of ordinary-looking
wheels and between them the gear for swinging them to right or left for
steering purposes, but even they are somewhat unusual, since they will
be seen to have flanges or rims round the edge for the purpose of biting
into the earth, so that they may be able to guide the machine the
better in soft ground.

The back wheels, however, are quite peculiar, for there is a pair on
each side and round each pair is a chain somewhat after the fashion of a
huge bicycle chain. The links of this chain are made of tough steel and
they are two feet wide, so that each chain forms a broad track upon
which the machine moves. The links of this track-chain will be seen to
be tooth-shaped so that they grip or bite deeply into the yielding
ground. The teeth, moreover, are shaped like those of a saw and they are
so placed as best to help the tractor forward.

Between the two chain-wheels will be noticed a row of smaller wheels and
it is these which largely support the weight of the machine, the chains
forming tracks upon which they run.

The wheels actually turned by the power of the engine are the
chain-wheels, and their action is such as to keep on laying down and
then taking up again two broad firm tracks along which, at the same
time, they keep propelling the other wheels which carry the weight
above. The effect, really, is just as if the machine had a pair of
driving wheels two feet wide and of enormous diameter, of such diameter,
in fact, that the part in contact with the ground is almost flat. Thus
there is always a broad bearing surface to prevent sinking in soft
earth, while the tooth-like shape of the links gives a firm hold even
under very adverse conditions.

This form of construction has been used for some few years now under the
name of "caterpillar" or "centipede" traction. A glance at the picture
will explain those names, particularly if the chain-driven part of the
vehicle be imagined to be a little longer than it is in the particular
machine shown.

The idea of armouring a vehicle with bullet-proof plates is also a
fairly old conception. Armoured trains were used again and again during
the South African War, and armoured motor-cars became familiar to most
people. In the case of cars, however, the armour could only be very
light and the guns carried were limited practically to a single
machine-gun and some rifles. Moreover, the operations of a car are very
largely confined to such places as are blessed with good roads or smooth
plains. An armoured car of the older type would have cut a poor figure
amid the shell-holes and mine-craters of Northern France. It would have
had to keep to the roads and so it was little used.

But the idea of an armoured vehicle was good and a good idea is never
entirely lost. Sooner or later some genius puts it to good use. Thus the
idea of an armoured vehicle came to be associated with the idea
represented in the centipede tractor and the result was the tank.

Why not armour a large centipede, said someone? Make it very big and
strong. It will trample down the barb-wire entanglements as if they were
grass. If made long enough and rightly balanced it will pass over the
trenches like a moving bridge. Nothing but a direct hit from a heavy gun
will do it much harm. For, observe, the mechanism can be entirely
covered up, all the vital parts can be well protected, and the chain
tracks can be so strong as to be almost undamageable.

[Illustration: _By permission of_ _Messrs. Foster and Co._

THE PARENT OF THE TANK.

Here we see an innocent agricultural tractor with caterpillar hind
wheels. It is out of such a machine that the idea of the formidable tank
was evolved.]

Thus we get a glimpse of the growth of this simple peaceful agricultural
machine into one of the most striking mechanical achievements of the
Great War.

Another thing which seems to have grown more or less of itself is the
bomb or grenade. Before the time of modern accurate fire-arms
hand-grenades were quite a recognized weapon. The "Grenadier" Guards owe
their title to this fact and carry the design of a bursting grenade upon
their uniforms. Yet until a few years ago everyone thought that such
things were done with for ever: that with modern rifles soldiers would
seldom get near enough together to use grenades and that if they did the
bayonet would be the weapon to be used.

When, however, the Germans were driven back at the battle of the Marne
and found themselves compelled to entrench in order to avoid further
disaster, it soon became evident that neither rifle nor bayonet nor both
together entirely filled the needs of the infantryman.

Since the Allies were not powerful enough to drive the Germans from
their trenches forthwith, they, too, had to entrench. Gradually the
trenches drew nearer and nearer together and at the same time skill in
entrenching increased. Thus a time soon arrived when both rifle and
bayonet were largely useless for purposes of offence. Then the
hand-grenade came into its own again, for the men could throw it from
the depths of their own trench high into the air in the hope that it
would fall into the trenches of the enemy. The call for these quickly
produced the supply. There is little need to describe them here, for who
among us has not intimate friends who used them again and again? This
much may be said, however. They were little hollow balls of cast iron,
sometimes chequered so that when they burst they flew into many
fragments. Inside was a charge of explosive with a suitable fuse or
firing mechanism. Some were fixed to the end of a stick for convenience
in throwing, while others were simply handled like a cricket-ball.

They serve to show us, however, how an old idea may under fresh
conditions be revived into what is practically a new invention.

Another example of the same sort is the revival of chain mail. Who, but
a few years ago, would have thought it possible that modern soldiers
would go to battle sheathed in shirts consisting of little metal plates
cunningly connected by wire links and so overlapping each other as to
form a perfect shield for all the more vital parts of the body? To what
extent these were worn I do not know, for the British soldier is a very
shy fellow in some ways and there are few who would not be a trifle
ashamed to let their comrades see them thus garbed. They would feel that
it was a confession of fear, and however afraid an Englishman may be he
will never admit it. He is really a pious fraud, for the more he is
really afraid inwardly the more courageously will he act just to hide
his fear.

Since, however, the bullet-proof helmet is worn officially nowadays
there seems no reason whatever why the bullet-proof waistcoat should
not be adopted officially too. It is very light and very flexible and it
is claimed that it is quite effectual in stopping rifle and machine-gun
bullets.

Thus we see in what different ways inventions grow. Some are warlike
from first to last, like the gun and the torpedo, but we find a vast
range of peaceful things growing into implements of warfare, as the
farmer's tractor has been developed into the tank, while not less
interesting are the old ideas revived and adapted to modern needs,
exemplified by the hand-grenade and the chain armour.



CHAPTER XXIV

AEROPLANES


Of all the great inventions perhaps the most striking because of the
suddenness with which they have come upon us are those relating to the
navigation of the air. Until a few years ago "to fly" was taken to
typify the impossible. Now we see men flying every day and there is
scarcely anyone who has not had a friend or relative in the Flying
Corps.

Recent experience, too, has shown that this one invention has
revolutionized warfare in several important departments, particularly in
the use of very heavy long-range artillery. Huge guns, hidden in a
hollow or behind a hill, have been set to throw shells on to an unseen
target, while a man in an aeroplane above watches the result and signals
back by wireless. Thus by the aid of aircraft the power of artillery has
been immensely increased.

Again, aircraft have superseded cavalry for reconnaissance purposes,
that is to say, for finding out the enemy's strength and preparedness.
Only a few years ago a General who needed information as to his foe
would send forward a screen of cavalrymen who would cautiously creep
forward until, judging by what they could see and by what sort of a
reception they got, they were able to form some idea of the foe's
arrangements. Nowadays, however, the airmen sail over his head and take
photographs of him and his positions. A careful commander to-day not
only screens his men and his guns from view along the land but he also
tries his best to make them invisible from above. And, speaking of
inventions, the soldiers have shown a degree of ingenuity in making
themselves and their guns invisible which almost merits a volume to
itself.

The airman, therefore, goes up and sails over the enemy. He may be
simply observing for some particular unit of artillery, or he may be
sent to find out things generally--nothing in particular, but anything
which seems likely to be of use. He looks out intently and carefully,
moreover he not only looks with his own eyes: as has just been
mentioned, he takes photographs, which can be developed on his return
and studied minutely at leisure. He may, or may not, according to
circumstances, send back reports of an urgent nature by wireless
telegraphy.

In some cases these duties are all carried out by one man, but in others
there are two: one the pilot who looks after the working of the machine,
and the other the observer whose whole attention can thus be devoted to
scrutinizing the enemy.

Of course, when aeroplanes go on scouting expeditions like this they are
apt to be attacked by the enemy both by anti-aircraft guns and also by
other aeroplanes. The former can only be met by high speed and the
steering of a somewhat erratic course so as to confuse the gunners and
prevent them from taking good aim.

The other aeroplanes, however, must be met by actual fighting. The only
way to defeat them is to go for them and attack them, a machine-gun
being the most usual weapon.

Besides those who go up for definite scouting operations or to "spot,"
as it is termed, for the artillery, there are other machines whose sole
duty is fighting. These go up for the purpose of driving off those
machines of the enemy which may come prying, or to keep the ground, so
to speak, for the scouting machines and enable them to do their work
unmolested.

Then there are, of course, still others whose function is to carry out
bombing expeditions.

All these different duties call for different types of machine, but I do
not propose to go into the differences here since changes are so rapid
in this particular field that only the general principles remain
unchanged for any length of time. What has just been hinted, however, as
to the different kinds of work which the aeroplane is called upon to do
will enable the reader to see why different kinds of machines are
needed.

So far we have only spoken of aeroplanes. There is a kind of machine
sometimes called a hydroplane but which we are gradually getting to call
a sea-plane. The latter term is much to be preferred, since the former
is also in use to denote a special kind of high-speed boat.

Now a sea-plane only differs from an aeroplane in that it has floats
instead of wheels. The aeroplane has wheels to enable it to alight upon
and arise from the ground: the sea-plane has floats by which it can
alight upon the water and arise from the water also.

In some instances this float idea is made so pronounced a feature of the
machine that it becomes a flying boat.

Sea-planes are therefore really only aeroplanes specially adapted for a
certain purpose. They are really just as much aeroplanes as those
machines which go by that name. It is somewhat unfortunate, therefore,
that a separate term is used to describe them. But there it is: names
grow in a very curious way, not always in a logical way, and a name
having once stuck to a thing in the mind of the public it is very
difficult to make any alteration.

Aeroplanes, then, may be said to include a subdivision known as
sea-planes, and for the rest of this chapter what is said of aeroplanes
will apply to sea-planes also.

Without doubt, these are the fastest vehicles in existence. Many of them
can exceed a speed of a hundred miles an hour. Consequently, the pilot
lives while he is aloft in the equivalent of a furious gale, and it
would seem as if that must produce such a degree of cold as to be almost
unendurable. Moreover, it appears that this cold is almost as bad in
summer as in winter, for the temperature high up in the air is much the
same all the year round. The consequent muffling up with thick clothes
and gloves, while it mitigates the cold, must add greatly to the pilot's
difficulties in managing his machine. The protection for his eyes and
ears which is made necessary by the same conditions must likewise add to
his difficulties or at any rate to his discomfort. On the other hand,
the effect of gliding at a very high speed over a perfectly smooth
track, for that is in effect what it is, is very exhilarating, which to
some extent compensates for the other drawbacks.

Moreover, the handling of such a machine in the air, particularly if a
fight is included in the programme, appeals strongly to the sporting
instincts of young men, so much so that during the War, in spite of the
dangers and hardships, and the continual loss of life, there was never a
dearth of men anxious to become pilots.

Owing to these considerations, too, it follows that the best aviators
are to be found in those lands where the people are most devoted to
sports. Hence, as we have it on excellent authority, the young men of
Great Britain and the United States, with their love of adventure and
their strong sporting instincts, make better men in the air than the
Germans.

But really we are more concerned here with the machines than with the
men, so let us get back to our subject.

The aeroplane consists of one or more "planes" or surfaces which, on
being held at a certain slant and then pushed forward rise or remain
supported in the air. Therefore the plane or planes need to be
supplemented by first a tail and horizontal rudder to hold them at the
correct slant, and an engine and propeller to drive them forward.

It is not necessary, here, to go over the history of the aeroplane, as
that has been told so often. It is not of much interest, moreover,
except to those who are particularly concerned with small details of
construction, for in a general way the machine of to-day is very little
different from one pictured by Sir George Cayley a hundred years ago. It
is only the perfecting of the details which has transformed a dream into
a very real thing.

So we will look only at the construction of the aeroplane in a general
way, to do which we must first consider why it flies at all. It is due
to the well-established law that action is always accompanied by a
reaction equally strong and in the opposite direction. When a gun is
fired the explosion not only drives the shell forward but equally drives
the gun itself backward. The backward energy of the recoil is precisely
equal to the forward energy of the shell. The two are equal but in
opposite directions. In like manner a rocket ascends because the hot
gases from the paper cylinder blow forcibly downwards, thereby producing
an equal reaction upwards.

Now the plane of a flying machine is held with its forward edge a little
higher than its rear edge, so that as it is pushed along it tends to
catch the air and throw it downwards. Hence the reaction tends to lift
the plane upwards. When the machine starts the reaction is not
sufficient to overcome gravity, which is trying to hold the machine down
upon the ground, but as the speed increases and the air is thrust down
with more and more violence the point is ultimately reached when the
reaction is able to overcome gravity and the machine ascends.

When a sufficient height is reached, the pilot alters the position of
his horizontal rudder or "elevator" so as to make the position of the
plane more flat, with the result that it throws the air downwards to a
less extent, and the reaction is thereby reduced until it is only just
sufficient to keep the machine at the same height. To descend, the
position of the plane is made still flatter, the reaction is reduced
still more and gravity has its way once again, bringing the machine to
earth.

In other words, the machine acts under the influence of two forces: the
downward pull of gravity and the upward reaction due to the action of
the machine in throwing the air downward. The former never varies, the
latter can be varied by the pilot at will: he can increase it by
increasing the speed or by increasing the tilt of his plane or planes:
he can reduce it by diminishing the speed or the tilt. Since generally
speaking the speed of his engine will remain constant, he rises, remains
at the same height or falls, at will, by the simple manipulation of the
elevator through which he can change the tilt or inclination.

Most machines have a fixed tail as well as a horizontal rudder or
elevator, the same being so set that it tends to keep the plane in a
certain normal inclination, the elevator being called in to increase
that or diminish it as may be required.

In addition to the elevator there is also another rudder of the ordinary
kind, such as every ship and boat has, for guiding the machine to right
or left. The elevator steers up and down, the rudder steers to either
hand.

Provision is also made for balancing the machine. This is sometimes in
the form of two small planes hinged to the main plane, one at either
end, connected together and to a controlling lever by wires, so that by
their use the pilot can steer the right-hand side of his machine upwards
and the left-hand downward, or vice versa, if through any cause he finds
a tendency to capsize.

In some machines the same effect is produced not by separate planes but
by pulling the main plane itself somewhat out of shape, but precisely
the same principle is involved.

The planes are usually made with a slight curve in them, so that they
may the better catch the air and "scoop" it downwards, so to speak. They
usually consist of fabric specially made for the purpose, stretched upon
a light wooden framework. The whole framework is usually of wood with
metal fittings frequently made of aluminium for the sake of lightness.

The engines have been mentioned in another chapter. The propeller which
is almost invariably fixed directly upon the shaft of the engine has two
blades only and not three as is usual with those of ships. Precisely why
this should be so is not clear, but experience shows that two-bladed
propellers are preferable for this work. They are made of wood, several
layers being glued together under pressure, the resulting log being then
carved out to the required shape. This makes a stronger thing than it
would be if cut out of a single piece of wood.

All parts, engine, elevator, rudder and balancing arrangement, are
controlled by very simple means from the pilot's seat.

In monoplanes there is but one main plane, resembling a pair of bird's
wings. Or if we care to look upon it as two planes, one each side of the
"body," then we must call it a pair. Since the name "mono" indicates one
it is best to think of it as one plane although it may be in two parts.
The biplane has, as its name implies, two planes, but in that case there
can be no doubt, since they are placed one above the other. Machines
have been made with three planes and even with as many as five, but
monoplanes and biplanes appear to hold the field.

It is not possible for an aeroplane to be in any sense armoured for
protection against bullets: for defence the pilot has to depend upon his
own cunning man[oe]uvres combined with the fast speed at which he can
move. For offensive purposes he usually has a machine gun mounted right
in front of him with which he can pour a stream of bullets into an
opponent or even, by flying low, he can attack a body of infantry. It is
recorded that one German prisoner during the war, speaking of the daring
of the British pilots in thus attacking men on foot, exclaimed, "They
will pull the caps off our heads next."

Some of the aeroplanes have their propeller behind the pilot and some
have it in front. The latter, to distinguish them, are called "Tractor"
machines, since in their case the propeller pulls them along. Now it is
easy to see that a difficulty arises in such cases through the best
position for the gun being such that it throws its bullets right on to
the propeller. But that has been overcome in a most simple yet ingenious
way. The gun is itself operated by the engine with the result that a
bullet can only be shot forth during those intervals when neither blade
of the propeller is in the way. The propeller is moving so fast that it
cannot be seen and the bullets are flying out in a continuous rattle,
yet every bullet passes between the blades and not one ever touches.

It is easy to see that when an aeroplane is manned by a single man, as
is often the case, he must have his hands very full indeed, what with
the machine itself and the gun as well. In fact, he often has to leave
the machine for a short time to look after itself while he busies
himself with the gun.

Now there we see a sign of the wonderful work which has been done in the
course of but a few years in the perfecting of the aeroplane, the result
of a series of improvements in detail which make but a dreary story if
related but which make all the difference between the risky, uncertain
machine of a few years ago and the safe, reliable machine of to-day.
Modern machines are inherently stable. The older ones had the elements
of stability in them but they were so crudely proportioned that these
inherent qualities did not have a chance to come into play.

If one drops a flat card edgewise from a height it seems as if it ought
to fall straight down to the ground. Yet we all know from experience
that it seldom does anything of the kind. Instead, it assumes a position
somewhere near horizontal and then descends in a series of swoops from
side to side. There we see the principle at work which, in a
well-designed aeroplane, causes inherent stability. The explanation is
as follows.

The aeroplane is sustained in the air through the upward pressure of the
air resisting the downward pull of gravity. That has been fully
explained already. Now gravity, as we all know, acts upon every part of
a body whether it be an aeroplane or anything else. But for practical
purposes, we may regard its action as concentrated at one particular
point in that body, called the "centre of gravity." Likewise, the upward
pressure of the air acts upon the whole of the under surface of the
plane or planes, yet we may regard it as concentrated at a certain point
called the "centre of pressure." Further, we all know from experience
that a pendulum or other suspended body is only still when its centre of
gravity is exactly under the point of suspension. If we move it to
either side it will swing back again.

In just the same way, the only position in which an aeroplane will
remain steady is that in which the centre of gravity is exactly under
the point of suspension or, in other words, the centre of pressure. For
the centre of pressure in the aeroplane is precisely similar to the
point of suspension of a pendulum.

Let us, then, picture to ourselves an aeroplane flying along on a
horizontal course with this happy state of things prevailing. Something
we will suppose occurs to upset it with the result that it begins to
dive downwards. It is then in the position of sliding downhill and
instantly its speed increases in consequence. That increase of speed
causes the air to press a little more strongly than it did before upon
the front edge of the planes. In other words, the centre of pressure
shifts forward a little, with the result that the centre of gravity is
then a little to the rear of the centre of pressure.

A moment's reflection will show that with the centre of pressure (or
point of suspension) in advance of the centre of gravity there is a
tendency for the machine to turn upwards again, or, in other words, to
right itself.

If, on the other hand, the initial upset causes it to shoot upwards the
speed instantly falls off and the centre of pressure retreats, turning
the machine downwards once more. And the same principle applies whatever
the disturbance may be. Instantly and automatically a turning force
comes into play which tends to check and ultimately to correct what has
gone wrong.

This principle explains the behaviour of the card dropped from an
upstairs window and, no doubt, as has been said, it operated also in the
early flying machines, but in their case other factors caused disturbing
elements with which the self-righting tendency was not strong enough to
cope. As time went on, however, experience taught the makers how to
avoid these disturbing factors until at last the self-righting tendency
was able to act effectively, thus producing the aeroplane which is
inherently stable and which will, for short periods at all events, fly
safely without attention from its pilot.

Each little improvement in this direction was an invention. Of course,
there were certain men whose names stand out prominently in the history
of the aeroplane, notable among whom are the Wright brothers, but the
final result is due to innumerable inventions, many of them by unknown
men.

But perhaps someone will say, how can you possibly talk about final
results in a matter which is still in its infancy?

The answer to that is that so far as the safe, "flyable" machine is
concerned, it has arrived. Little now remains to be done in that
direction. Further improvements there will, of course, be, but the great
fundamental problems of flight have been solved.



CHAPTER XXV

THE AERIAL LIFEBOAT


Balloons had not long been invented when the idea arose of a device by
means of which an aeronaut who found himself in difficulties might be
able to reach the ground in safety. In other words, the need was felt
for something which should play towards the balloon the part which the
lifeboat does to the ship.

The original idea of a parachute was even older than that, since we are
told of a man away back in the seventeenth century who amused the King
of Siam by jumping from a height and steadying his descent by means of a
couple of umbrellas. It was not, however, until the very end of the
eighteenth century or the beginning of the nineteenth that descents were
made from really considerable heights from balloons.

The usual arrangement then was to have the parachute hanging at full
length fastened below the basket, or tied to one side of the balloon in
such a manner that it could be detached by cutting the cords that held
it up. When the parachute was carried below the balloon basket the man
was already in the cradle or seat of the parachute ready to be dropped,
but when the seat was tied to the side of the car of the balloon the
aeronaut, when he wished to make a descent, first got from the car into
the seat, and, casting himself adrift from the car, swung out from under
the centre of the balloon so that when he was hanging clear another man
in the balloon cut the cords or pulled a slip-knot which set the
parachute free. There were different ways of doing this and when a man
was by himself he had to get into the sling of the parachute and, on
finding himself clear of everything, he would give a tug to a cord which
would release a catch holding up the parachute and allow it to drop to
earth.

The parachute, at the very first, was but a simple affair, being little
more than a circular sheet of cotton or similar fabric, but it was very
soon found necessary to make it _a bag_ or it would not properly hold
the air. Cords were attached at regular intervals all around the edge of
this bag, these cords being gathered together and attached to the edge
of a basket which carried the man. Sometimes only a sling was used, or a
simple light seat after the fashion of the "bosun's chair" upon which a
sailor is sometimes hauled to the top of an unclimbable mast, or a
steeplejack to the top of a chimney.

Thus, when it was dropped, the weight of the man, pulling upon all the
cords simultaneously, drew down the edge of the bag, which, catching the
air in its fall, acted as a powerful brake and reduced the rate of
falling to such an extent that if all went well the man alighted in
safety if not comfort.

As has already been remarked in another chapter, air, which seems to us
sometimes to be so exceedingly light as to have practically no weight
at all, really has weight and also the property which we call inertia,
by virtue of which things at rest prefer to stay at rest.

Now when this open air-bag, of considerable area, is pulled downwards it
causes a very considerable disturbance in the air. As it descends the
air inside and beneath it is first pushed downwards and compressed a
little, then it commences to move outwards, towards the edge, round
which it finally escapes to fill the slight vacuum in the space just
above the descending parachute. All this the air objects to do because
of its inertia. The parachute has to force it to act thus and in that
way it uses up some of the force of gravity which all the time is
pulling the man earthwards. In other words, that force, instead of
dragging the man downwards at such a speed as to dash him to pieces, is
so far employed in churning up the air that what is left only brings him
down quite slowly and ends with just a gentle bump. That is the
scientific explanation of what happens, although expressed in somewhat
homely language.

To anyone who thinks of this matter it will be clear that a relatively
heavy weight like a man, suspended from a parachute, is like a very
delicately poised pendulum, and consequently it is not surprising to
hear that the early parachutes oscillated very considerably from side to
side, so much so, indeed, that this oscillation became a decided danger,
for before the proper shape of the air-bag was found out they sometimes
skidded and even turned inside out. It was found, however, at quite an
early stage that this instability could be to some extent cured by
making a hole right in the centre or crown of the parachute through
which the air compressed inside could blow upwards in a powerful jet. At
first sight it seems as if this would much weaken the parachute and
cause it to descend too quickly, but quite a large hole can be safely
made, and to make such a hole is only the same thing as slightly
reducing the area and that can be easily remedied by slightly increasing
the diameter.

Reading of this many years ago, I have often been puzzled as to why the
presence of the hole should have this steadying effect, the explanation
given in the old scientific textbook from which I learnt it being
obviously very unsatisfactory. Of recent years, however, this subject of
parachutes has been very deeply studied by an eminent engineer of
London, Mr. E. R. Calthrop, the inventor of the "Guardian Angel"
parachute to which these remarks are leading up, and he has hit upon
what is undoubtedly the explanation. He says that the big jet of air
shooting upwards through the crown of the parachute forms in effect a
rudder which steers the parachute in a straight downward course, just as
the rudder guides a boat upon the surface of the water.

It is quite possible that thus far the impression conveyed to the
reader's mind is that the parachute and its use are very simple,
straightforward matters. One may be inclined to think that it is only
necessary to get a circular sheet of fabric, to fasten the cords to it,
to connect them to a suitable seat and then to descend from any height
at any time in perfect safety. If you make a model from a flat sheet of
cotton, then one made like a bag, and drop them with little weights
attached from the top window of your house you will see what funny
things the air can do. After having tried these little ones, you will
begin to suspect that the big parachute is full of waywardness: and, as
a matter of fact, until recent years, it has been very largely a
delusion and a snare. By its refusal to act and open at the right moment
it has sacrificed many lives. Although apparently so simple, there were
conditions existing and forces at work which for a century or more had
never been properly considered and investigated, and it is only now that
we have arrived at a parachute whose certainty of action and general
trustworthiness entitle it to be called the "lifeboat of the air."

The troubles with the older parachutes were two. First, although often
it opened quite quickly, and carried its load as perfectly as could be
desired, it sometimes had the habit of delaying its opening, and unless
the fall were from a very great height it was unsafe to take the risk,
indeed, it sometimes refused to open at all, and the poor parachutist
suffered a fearful death. It had to be carried in a more or less
folded-up state. Often it was hung up by its centre to the side of a
balloon, when it was very like a shut-up umbrella. Consequently the
power of opening quickly and certainly was of the first importance, and
the lack of that power and the uncertainty of its action were a very
serious defect. It has always suffered from an ill reputation as to
reliability.

The second fault lay with the cords. They would persist in getting
entangled. Everyone knows how a dozen cords hanging near together will
get entangled with each other on the slightest provocation. Such cords
if blown about by a strong wind would be much worse even than when
still, and if, as must often be the case with parachutes, they be coiled
up, we all know from our own experience that some of them would be
almost sure to get knotted and tangled together when, in a sudden
emergency, the attempt was made to pull them all out of their coils in a
second or two. Just picture to yourself what it means: a dozen coiled
cords all close together, themselves all coiled up in loops, suddenly
pulled. Something awkward appears almost inevitable. And the result of
even one rope going awry may be fatal, for it may prevent the parachute
opening out fully, probably giving it a "lop-sided" form incapable of
gripping the air effectually and consequently allowing the unfortunate
man to fall with a velocity which means certain death. This second cause
of failure to open, through entanglement of cordage, has happened in a
number of cases, with fatal results.

So much for the faults of the old primitive parachute. Now let us
consider for a moment the urgent need for a parachute which is free from
such faults. The man who goes up in a balloon on a Saturday afternoon
feels so sure of his "craft" that he thinks he needs no "lifeboat," yet
men in ordinary free balloons have been killed for want of them. The
spectators at country fairs no longer appreciate a parachute descent as
a great and extraordinary spectacle. But in warfare, with kite balloons
by the dozen, with dirigible balloons by the score and aeroplanes by the
hundred, the call for parachutes is urgent and irresistible. At all
events, Mr. Calthrop found an irresistible call to devote years of close
study, unceasing toil and considerable sums of money to the task of
perfecting an improved parachute which would always open and open
quickly, and whose cords would never get entangled. He has the
satisfaction of knowing that by so doing he has provided an appliance
that in the air is as reliable as a lifeboat is at sea, and that at all
times, and from every kind of aircraft, can be depended upon in case of
accident to save the lives of gallant airmen who but for his work would
be dashed to death. The Great War has taught us to regard life somewhat
cheaply. For years we were more concerned with taking life than with
saving it, yet surely to save the life of one's own men is equivalent to
taking the lives of one's opponents, so that even from the point of view
of warfare the saving of life may be a help towards victory. This is
particularly so when the lives saved are those of the choicest spirits,
and among the most highly trained. It has been reckoned that to make a
fully-trained pilot costs as much as £1500, so that to save but a few,
even in their preparatory nights on the training-grounds where so many
accidents happen, makes quite an appreciable difference in the cost of a
war, without considering the main question of the men's lives.

Many inventions arise through a man thinking of an idea and then seeking
and finding some application for it. Elsewhere in this book, I give
examples of such cases. Here we have an instance of the opposite, for
Mr. Calthrop found his thoughts strongly directed in this direction by
the death of a personal friend, the Hon. C. S. Rolls, one of the early
martyrs in the cause of aviation, not to mention others who shared the
same risks and in some cases the same fate. His interest thus aroused,
he first studied all the records which could be found relating to
parachute accidents, so as to ascertain, if possible, what were the
causes of failure. Then he commenced a long series of experiments with a
view to removing these causes. Improvement after improvement was tried,
unexpected difficulties were discovered and grappled with, the
kinematograph was called in to record the movements of the falling
objects, a task for which it is far better fitted than the human eye,
and after years of this there emerged the finished parachute, automatic
in its action, perfectly reliable and a true safeguard, which I am about
to describe.

The parachute's body consists of the finest quality silk carefully cut
into gussets of such a shape that when sewn together somewhat after the
manner of the cover of an umbrella, they form a shallow bag, parabolic
in section, of that particular shape which the material would assume
naturally were it perfectly elastic when enclosing its resisting body of
compressed air.

At intervals round the edge are fastened twenty-four V-shaped tapes.
These are only a few feet long and the lower end of each V-shaped pair
is attached to a long main tape. There are twelve of these main tapes,
and their lower ends unite in a metal disc from which is suspended the
sling and harness by which the man is supported.

[Illustration: THE "GUARDIAN ANGEL" PARACHUTE.

(1) Shows the airman in the harness by which he is attached to the
parachute. By means of the star-shaped buckle he can instantly release
himself. (2) Shows the parachute two seconds after the airman has jumped
from the aeroplane. In (3) he is seen nearing the ground.

(_By permission of E. R. Calthrop, Esq._)]

So the twenty-four short tapes form twelve V's to the points of which
are attached the twelve long tapes which support the man. The reason why
tapes are used in this particular parachute and not cords will be
referred to later.

In the crown of the silk body there is the usual hole for the purpose of
forming the air-rudder to steady the parachute in its descent.

And now we can consider the first great feature of this wonderful
invention and ask ourselves these questions: "By what means is it made
to open?" "What makes it more reliable than others?"

To answer that we must first see why the others sometimes refused to
open. In whatever way an ordinary parachute may be packed it must, when
coming into use, assume the state of a shut umbrella with a hole in the
top.

In this condition it is assumed that as it falls the air will find a way
in through the lower end and will blow the parachute open in precisely
the same way that a strong wind will sometimes blow out the folds of an
umbrella.

But, as a matter of fact, the loose folds of a parachute, when the edge
of the gussets is gathered in, are sure to overlap and enfold each other
more or less. Thus, when in the shut-umbrella state, it sometimes
happens that air which is inside can escape upwards through the hole
more easily than fresh air can get in from below. The parachute, in such
a state, is, let us imagine, falling rapidly through the air. The
result is just the same as if it were still and the air were rushing
upwards past it. And the upward rush past the top hole tends to _suck
air out_ through the hole faster than fresh air can find a way in at the
bottom.

This is the principle of the ejector, which engineers have put to many
uses. For example, the vacuum brakes employed on many large railways owe
all their power to stop a train to a vacuum caused by an ejector. There
is a short tube or nozzle, placed in the centre of another tube through
which steam blows. The action of the steam in the outer tube as it
rushes past the end of the inner tube drags after it the air which is in
the inner tube so effectively as to produce quite a good vacuum. And in
precisely the same way, the upward rush of air past the parachute, or
what is just the same, the falling of the parachute through stationary
air, can suck the air from inside the latter and create a vacuum in it
if the gussets gathered together at the mouth unfortunately overlap one
another and are thus locked together by the pressure of the air striving
to get in. Thus, instead of the downward fall causing the ordinary
parachute to open, as in most cases it will do quite well, the fall
under these particular conditions actually binds its folds together and
prevents it from opening. It is true this does not often happen, but the
risk is _always_ present at every drop, and this unreliability has cost
the lives of brave men and women, and the knowledge of this constant
risk has led others to write down the parachute a failure, by reason of
its known unreliability to open instantly. Even when it does open the
depth it falls before it opens is so variable, by reason of the fight
between vacuum and pressure, that it may be one hundred feet one time
and one thousand feet next time with the same parachute.

Now the "Guardian Angel" is designed so that those conditions cannot
occur. Its silken covering is first laid out on the ground and into the
centre is introduced a beautifully-designed disc of aluminium, somewhat
like a large inverted saucer, of exceeding lightness but of ample
strength for what it has to do. Then the silk body is pleated and folded
back over the upper part of this launching-disc and gradually packed so
that it occupies but a very small space upon the upper surface of the
disc. It is so folded that its edge comes in the topmost layer and also
in such a manner that on the tapes being pulled the silk unfolds easily
and regularly, flowing down as it were over the edge of the disc almost
as water flows if allowed to fall from a tap upon the centre of an
inverted saucer. After the folding is complete another aluminium disc is
placed above the packed silk body which shields it from the enormous air
pressure when it is being released from an aeroplane flying at top
speed. The upper and lower fabric covers are then superimposed and
sealed and the "Guardian Angel" parachute is ready for use.

The tapes, likewise, are folded up, in a special way upon the bottom
cover, which is sprung over the bottom of the disc. The bottom cover
with the tapes upon it, is pulled away by the weight of the airman as he
makes his jump to safety, and the tapes are so arranged that a pull
upon them causes them to draw out steadily and smoothly, almost like
water falling from a height.

If we regard the silk as forming a shallow bag inverted, we may say that
it is folded upon the disc inside out and the function of the disc is to
cause it to spread and enclose a wide column of air as it is pulled from
its folds. To commence with it is nothing more than so much folded-up
silk, but from the first moment of action it becomes a bag with a
wide-open mouth, for its open mouth cannot be smaller than the disc.
Therefore, from the first instant it begins to grip the air and the
ejector action never gets a chance to commence. The pressure of air
inside is from the very commencement of the fall greater than that of
the surrounding air. Moreover, the disc covers the hole until the
parachute is actually open, thereby making ejector action doubly
impossible.

The widely-opened mouth of the air-bag (I cannot help repeating that
term for it is so expressive) swallows up more and more air as the thing
falls rapidly, with the result that the air inside is instantly
compressed and the increasing pressure as the silk is more and more
fully drawn out causes it to expand until the whole is fully extended
like a huge umbrella. The instant compression of the enclosed column of
air is what causes it _always_ to open automatically.

When once it is pointed out it is easy to see what a difference the
presence of this disc makes. It is so simple that it cannot fail to act
and having once produced that open mouth all the rest is due to the
action of natural forces which can be absolutely relied upon. The
ordinary parachute with its hopeless irregularities has, in fact, been
converted into a machine whose action can _never_ fail.

The disc is fastened to the balloon or aeroplane and is left behind when
the parachute falls, having done its work.

And now let us consider the tapes. As has already been remarked, a
series of coiled cords cannot be relied upon to pull out straight
without possibility of entanglement, but a tape, if folded to and fro
like a Chinese cracker, will invariably do so. So packed tapes have been
substituted for coiled corded rigging, with the certainty that they
cannot be entangled in the fiercest air current.

And now we come to another interesting feature. The man is not suspended
directly from the small disc to which the tapes are attached but by a
non-spinning sling which contains a shock absorber. This latter consists
of a number of strands of rubber and it is owing to its action that the
aviator who trusts his life to the parachute suffers little or no shock;
even when the instant opening of the parachute begins to arrest his
fall. And not only does it save him from shock, but it also avoids the
possibility of too great a stress coming suddenly upon the parachute or
its rigging of tapes.

The aviator himself is attached to the parachute through the
shock-absorber sling, by means of a harness which he wears constantly
throughout his flight, so that in the event of trouble he only has to
jump overboard and the parachute automatically does the rest. This
harness consists of two light but strong aluminium tubular rings
through which he places his arms, combined with a series of straps which
can be so adjusted that the stress of carrying him comes upon those
parts of his body best adapted to bear it.

This improved parachute is the only one which is capable of being used
instantly and without preparation for descent from an aeroplane flying
at top speed. It is easy to see that it is one thing to drop from a
stationary or nearly stationary balloon and quite another to dive from
an aeroplane at one hundred miles per hour. The latter is equivalent to
suddenly trusting oneself to a parachute _during the strongest gale_. It
has been found, by experiment, however, that high speed is no bar to the
use of this parachute since it only causes the parachute to open a
little more quickly than usual, which means that it can be used with
safety from an even lower height.

Under the worst conditions this wonderful parachute can be relied upon
always to open and carry its load at a height of only one hundred feet,
and its use is safe in all circumstances when dropped from two hundred
feet above the ground. After it has once got into operation and taken
charge of affairs, so to speak, the man descends at the rate of only
fifteen feet per second, which is just about the same as dropping from a
height of a little over three feet. In other words, he will arrive on
the ground with no worse bump than you would get by jumping off the
dining-room table.

But suppose that there were a wind blowing: would not the parachute come
down in a slanting direction and then drag the man along? Or may he not
alight upon a tree or the roof of a house, only to be pulled off again
and flung headlong? Quite true he might, were not proper provision made
for such occurrences. Embodied in the harness is a lock which can be
instantly undone, by a simple movement of a lever in the hand, and by
its aid the man on touching earth or on alighting upon anything solid
can release himself instantly, after which the parachute can sail away
whither it will, but he will be safe and sound.

What Mr. Calthrop has accomplished by the invention of his "Guardian
Angel" parachute may be summarised briefly by saying that he has reduced
the minimum height from which a parachute could be dropped from two
thousand to two hundred feet, and that he has made it possible to launch
a parachute, with the certainty of safety, from any kind of aircraft
flying at the slowest or highest speed of which they are capable.

       *       *       *       *       *

You are only a boy now, but when in years to come you are quite old and
have grey hair you may become a Member of the Air Board and--who
knows--it may become your duty to decide that this great invention shall
be always used on the training grounds to save the lives of the young
men, not yet born, who are then learning to fly. During the War, one was
killed every day, 365 in a year, many of whom might have been saved had
more "Guardian Angels" been in use.



INDEX


  Acetone, 36, 57, 58
  Acetylene, 58
  Aeroplanes, types of, 285, 286
  Air-raft equipment, 89
  Alcohols, 49, 50, 51, 52, 55, 139
  Aluminium, 157
  Anchors for floating bridges, 80
  Anti-aircraft guns, 119
  _Aquitania_, s.s., 197
  Armourer, 17
  Austrian heavy mortars, 111, 114, 117

  Bamboo, bridges made of, 87
  Basic steel, 101
  Becquerel, H., 40
  Benzene, 35
  Bessemer, Sir Henry, 93, 98, 99, 100, 102
  Blast-furnace, 94, 95
  Boilers in warships, 176
  Breech-block of guns, 131, 132
  "Brennan" torpedo, 219

  Calthrop, E. R., 300, 311
  Canet, Gustave, 129
  Canvas boats, 86
  Carbolic acid, 35
  Carbon, 28, 50, 94, 98
  Carbon in steel, 106
  Carbon monoxide, 95
  Carriages of guns, 116
  Cast iron, 96, 97
  Catamaran bridge, 90, 91
  Caustic soda, 22, 23, 24
  Chloride of lime, 23
  Chlorine, 18, 19, 21, 23, 52
  Chloroform, 59
  Clerk-Maxwell, Professor J., 243
  Coal dust explodes, 29
  Coal tar, 34
  Contact-firing mines, 65
  Copper, 147
  Cordite, 36
  Cotton explosives, 32, 33
  Countermining, 63, 73
  Crucible steel, 104
  Curie, Madame, 41

  Detonator, 37
  Diastase, 55
  Diesel engine, 178, 236
  _Dreadnought_, H.M.S., 194
  Driving-band on shells, 142
  Dynamite, 31

  Electricity, positive and negative, 20, 21
  Electrodes, 19
  Electrolysis of salt, 18, 19
  Electrolyte, 19
  Electrons, 42
  Electroscope, 43
  "Elia" mines, 70
  Ethane, 51
  Ether, 58, 59
  Explosion, force of, 30

  Field guns, 108, 114
  Flotilla leaders, 189
  Fractional distillation, 35, 57
  French field artillery, 108
  Froude, William, 203
  Fulminate of mercury, 37

  Glycerine, 25
  Gravity, action of upon shells, 122, 123, 124
  "Guardian Angel" parachute, 300
  Gun-cotton, 32, 33
  Gunpowder, 27, 30
  Gyroscope, uses of, 216, 234

  Helium, 42
  Hertzian waves, 243
  High explosives, 36, 138
  High-explosive shells, 137
  High-speed steel, 105
  Hop-pole bridges, 88
  Horse artillery, 108, 114
  Howitzers, 111, 114, 115
  Hydrostatic valve, 68, 217
  Hydroxyl, 52, 53

  "Interference" of waves, 241, 248
  _Invincible_, H.M.S., 196
  Ionogens, 20
  Ions of common salt, 19
  Iron ore, 93

  Kieselguhr, 32

  Ladysmith, guns at, 109
  Launching a ship, 211
  "Limit" gauges, 140
  Line-of-battle ships, 191
  _Lion_, H.M.S., 197
  Lyddite, 35

  Machine guns, 115
  Magnetic detector, 257
  Malt, 55
  Marconi, 248
  Methane, 51
  Methylated spirit, 54
  Mine, submarine, 63 _et seq._
  Mine, subterranean, 61
  Mortars, 111, 112, 113, 114, 118

  Naval guns, 112, 120 _et seq._
  Naval shells, 136, 137
  Nitrate of potassium, 30
  Nitro-benzene, 35
  Nitro-glycerine, 26, 31, 32
  Nitrogen, action of, 26, 30

  Observation mines, 65
  Oil fuel, 177
  _Olympic_, s.s., 197
  Organic substances, 26
  _Orion_, H.M.S., 193

  Parachutes, 297
  Paraffins, 51
  Periscope, 225, 233
  Petrol engine, 181, 182
  Phenol, 35
  Picric acid, 35
  Pig iron, 95, 97
  Poison gas, 23
  Pontoons for bridging, 77
  Propellants, 36, 125, 138

  Radio-activity, 41
  Radium, 39 _et seq._
  Rays from radium, 41, 42
  Reeds, bridges made of, 85
  _Repulse_, H.M.S., 192
  Rheumatism and radium, 47
  Rifling in guns, 143
  Rolling mills, 98, 139

  Salt and explosives, 18
  Saltpetre, 27, 29, 30
  Scott, Sir Percy, 109
  Sea-planes, 287
  Shell-steel, 146
  Shrapnel shells, 137, 144, 145
  Siemens steel, 102, 103
  Sights for guns, 133
  Smokeless powder, 31
  Soap, 25
  Sodium, 18, 22
  Soluble seal used in mines, 72
  Spinning action of shells, 142
  Stability of aeroplanes, 293
  Steam-engines, 170
  Steel for guns, 126
  Sulphuric acid, 31, 32, 150
  Suspension bridges, 83

  "Tanks," 276
  Telephone used in telegraphy, 266
  Tin, 152, 153
  T.N.T., 35
  Toluene, 35
  Torpedo boats, 184
  Trajectory, 122
  Trench mortars, 118
  Trestle bridges, 80, 83
  Tri-nitro-benzene, 35
  Tri-nitro-phenol, 35
  Tri-nitro-toluene, 35
  Tungsten, 105, 153
  "Tuning" wireless telegraph apparatus, 255
  Turbine, steam, 17

  Uranium, 41

  "Whitehead" torpedo, 215
  Wire-wound guns, 128
  Wolfram, 153
  Wood spirit, 57
  Wrought iron, 97
  _Wyoming_, U.S. battleship, 195

  X-rays, 42, 43

  Zeppelin _v._ aeroplane, 46
  Zinc, 149, 150, 151


PRINTED BY WILLIAM BRENDON AND SON, LTD., PLYMOUTH, ENGLAND. 1917


_Great Classics for Little Children_


THE CHILDREN'S ODYSSEY

TOLD FOR LITTLE CHILDREN

BY PROF. A. J. CHURCH, M.A.

_With Fourteen Illustrations. Extra Crown 8vo, 5s._

"A really charming volume in all respects. No writer has done work of
this kind so well since Kingsley first set the fashion in his
masterpiece, _The Heroes_."--_Guardian._

"The stories could not be told more simply and directly, or in a way
better fitted to delight and interest children, than they are in this
charming book. We are delighted to see the book embellished with
Flaxman's exquisite illustrations. Greatly daring ... they have been
coloured in simple colours, like those of classical wall paintings. The
effect is quite excellent."--_Spectator._


THE CHILDREN'S ILIAD

TOLD FOR LITTLE CHILDREN

BY PROF. A. J. CHURCH, M.A.

_With Fourteen Illustrations. Extra Crown 8vo, 5s._

"What need nowadays to praise Prof. Church's skill in presenting
classical stories to young readers? This is a capital example of the
cultured, simple style. A delightful gift-book."--_Athenæum._

"Prof. Church has written as good a book as can ever be produced for
English children from the literary treasures of Greece. The
illustrations are worthy of the writing."--_Sheffield Independent._

"With delightful simplicity of style Prof. Church retells the story of
the Siege of Troy so that it ceases to be 'history,' and becomes an
engrossing narrative. The handsome volume has a dozen excellent
illustrations."--_Dundee Courier._


THE CHILDREN'S ÆNEID

TOLD FOR LITTLE CHILDREN

BY PROF. A. J. CHURCH, M.A.

_With Fourteen Illustrations in Colours. Extra Crown 8vo, 5s._

"Professor Church has probably done more than any other man living to
bring the classics of Greece and Rome within the comprehension of young
folks. He has a simple style that must be the envy of writers for
children."--_Dundee Advertiser._

"A delightful gift-book."--_Athenæum._

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


THE ROMANCE OF ANIMAL ARTS & CRAFTS

DESCRIBING THE WONDERFUL INTELLIGENCE OF ANIMALS REVEALED IN THEIR WORK
AS MASONS, PAPER MAKERS, RAFT & DIVING-BELL BUILDERS, MINERS, TAILORS,
ENGINEERS OF ROADS & BRIDGES, &C. &C.

BY H. COUPIN, D.Sc., & JOHN LEA, B.A. (CANTAB.)

_With Thirty Illustrations. Extra Crown 8vo., 5s._

"Will carry most readers, young and old, from one surprise to
another."--_Glasgow Herald._

"A charming subject, well set forth, and dramatically
illustrated."--_Athenæum._

"It seems like pure romance to read of the curious ways of Nature's
craftsmen, but it is quite a true tale that is set forth in this
plentifully illustrated book."--_Evening Citizen._


THE ROMANCE OF INSECT LIFE

DESCRIBING THE CURIOUS & INTERESTING IN THE INSECT WORLD

BY EDMUND SELOUS

Author of "The Romance of the Animal World," _&c._

_With Sixteen Illustrations. Extra Crown 8vo, 5s._

"An entertaining volume, one more of a series which seeks with much
success to describe the wonders of nature and science in simple,
attractive form."--_Graphic._

"Offers most interesting descriptions of the strange and curious
inhabitants of the insect world, sure to excite inquiry and to foster
observation. There are ants white and yellow, locusts and cicadas, bees
and butterflies, spiders and beetles, scorpions and cockroaches--and
especially ants--with a really scientific investigation of their
wonderful habits not in dry detail, but in free and charming exposition
and narrative. An admirable book to put in the hands of a boy or girl
with a turn for natural science--and whether or not."--_Educational
Times._


THE ROMANCE OF THE ANIMAL WORLD

DESCRIBING THE CURIOUS AND INTERESTING IN NATURAL HISTORY

BY EDMUND SELOUS

_With Sixteen full-page Illustrations. Extra Crown 8vo, 5s._

"Mr. Selous takes a wide range in Nature; he has seen many wonders which
he relates. Open the book where we will we find something
astonishing."--_Spectator._

"It is in truth a most fascinating book, as full of incidents and as
various in interest as any other work of imagination, and, beyond the
pleasure in the reading there is the satisfaction of knowing that one is
in the hands of a genuine authority on some of the most picturesque
subjects that natural history affords. Mr. Selous' method is strong,
safe, and sound. The volume has numerous illustrations of a high order
of workmanship and a handsome binding of striking design."--_School
Government Chronicle._

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ELECTRICITY

DESCRIBING IN NON-TECHNICAL LANGUAGE WHAT IS KNOWN ABOUT ELECTRICITY &
MANY OF ITS INTERESTING APPLICATIONS

BY CHARLES R. GIBSON, A.I.E.E.

AUTHOR OF "ELECTRICITY OF TO-DAY," ETC.

_Extra Crown 8vo. With 34 Illustrations and 11 Diagrams. 5s._

"Everywhere Mr. Charles R. Gibson makes admirable use of simple
analogies which bespeak the practised lecturer, and bring the matter
home without technical detail. The attention is further sustained by a
series of surprises. The description of electric units, the volt, the
ohm, and especially the ampere, is better than we have found in more
pretentious works."--_Academy._

"Mr. Gibson's style is very unlike the ordinary text-book. It is fresh,
and is non-technical. Its facts are strictly scientific, however, and
thoroughly up to date. If we wish to gain a thorough knowledge of
electricity pleasantly and without too much trouble on our own part, we
will read Mr. Gibson's 'romance.'"--_Expository Times._

"A book which the merest tyro totally unacquainted with elementary
electrical principles can understand, and should therefore especially
appeal to the lay reader. Especial interest attaches to the chapter on
wireless telegraphy, a subject which is apt to 'floor' the uninitiated.
The author reduces the subject to its simplest aspect, and describes the
fundamental principles underlying the action of the coherer in language
so simple that anyone can grasp them."--_Electricity._


THE ROMANCE OF THE SHIP

THE STORY OF HER ORIGIN AND EVOLUTION FROM THE EARLIEST TIMES

BY E. KEBLE CHATTERTON, B.A. OXON.

AUTHOR OF "SAILING SHIPS AND THEIR STORY," ETC. ETC.

_With 34 Illustrations. Price 5s._

"One of the most instructive and intelligent treatises on sea-life that
it has yet been our lot to peruse."--_Syren and Shipping._

"There is not a doubt about this volume being the best of its kind yet
published."--_Dundee Courier._

"Absorbingly interesting and highly instructive."--_Liverpool Daily
Post._


THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ASTRONOMY

BY HECTOR MACPHERSON, JUNIOR

_With 32 Illustrations & Diagrams. Extra Crown 8vo. Price 5s._

"We can conceive no book better adapted than this handsomely got up and
beautifully illustrated volume to attract the young, and even older
people to the study of the sublimest of sciences."--_Edinburgh News._

"Described in popular language, yet with a thoroughness which will give
the reader a surprisingly complete grasp of the subject."--_Christian._

"An ideal book for presentation, as indeed all Messrs. Seeley's Romance
books are."--_Eastern Morning News._

"An excellent compendium of the most interesting facts in astronomy,
told in popular language. Great care has evidently been taken to secure
accuracy. The illustrations are exceedingly good."--_The Athenæum._

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


Stories by Prof. A. J. Church

"The Headmaster of Eton (Dr. the Hon. E. Lyttelton) advised his hearers,
in a recent speech at the Royal Albert Institute, to read Professor A.
J. Church's "Stories from Homer," some of which, he said, he had read to
Eton boys after a hard school day, and at an age when they were not in
the least desirous of learning, but were anxious to go to tea. The
stories were so brilliantly told, however, that those young Etonians
were entranced by them, and they actually begged of him to go on, being
quite prepared to sacrifice their tea time."

_Profusely illustrated. Extra Crown 8vo, 5s. each_

  The Children's Æneid
  The Children's Iliad
  The Children's Odyssey
  The Faery Queen and her Knight
  The Crusaders
  Greek Story and Song
  Stories from Homer
  Stories from Virgil
  The Crown of Pine
  Stories from Greek Tragedians
  Stories of the East from Herodotus
  Story of the Persian War
  Stories from Livy
  Roman Life in the Days of Cicero
  With the King at Oxford
  Count of Saxon Shore
  The Hammer
  Story of the Iliad
  Story of the Odyssey
  Stories from Greek Comedians
  Heroes of Chivalry and Romance
  Helmet and Spear
  Stories of Charlemagne

_Extra Crown 8vo, illustrated, and other sizes_

3_s._ 6_d._

  Last Days of Jerusalem
  The Burning of Rome
  The Fall of Athens
  Stories from English History
  Patriot & Hero

2_s._ 6_d._

  The Chantry Priest of Barnet
  Heroes of Eastern Romance
  Three Greek Children
  To the Lions
  A Young Macedonian

2_s._

  Heroes of Eastern Romance

1_s._ 6_d._

  Heroes and Kings
  Greek Gulliver
  Nicias
  Story of the Iliad and Æneid
  To the Lions

1_s._

  Story of the Iliad
  Story of the Odyssey
  Story of the Iliad and Æneid

6_d._

  Last Days of Jerusalem
  Story of the Iliad
  Story of the Odyssey
  Stories from Virgil

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


A Catalogue of Books for Young People, Published by Seeley, Service & Co
Limited, 38 Great Russell Street, London

_Some of the Contents_

  Adventure, The Library of              12
  Bedford Library, The                    2
  Church, Stories by Professor            3
  Giberne, Books by Miss                  6
  Heroes of the World Library, The        8
  Marshall, Stories by Miss Beatrice      9
  Marshall, Stories by Mrs.               9
  Missionary Biographies                 10
  Olive Library, The                     10
  Pink Library, The                      11
  Prince's Library, The                  11
  Romance, The Library of                13
  Royal Library, The                     12
  Russell Series, The                    12
  Scarlet Library, The                   14
  Science for Children                   14
  Sunday Echoes                           2
  Wonder Library, The                    16

_The Publishers will be pleased to send post free their complete
Catalogue or their Illustrated Miniature Catalogue on receipt of a
post-card_

SEELEY, SERVICE & CO. LIMITED

       *       *       *       *       *


CATALOGUE OF BOOKS

_Arranged alphabetically under the names of Authors and Series_

AGUILAR, GRACE.

    THE DAYS OF BRUCE. With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. (SCARLET
    LIBRARY.)

ANDERSEN, HANS.

    FAIRY TALES. With Illustrations. 1s. 6d., 2s., and 3s. 6d. (SCARLET
    AND PRINCE'S LIBRARIES.)

ALCOTT, L. M.

    LITTLE WOMEN AND GOOD WIVES. With Illustrations. 2s. (SCARLET
    LIBRARY.) Also LITTLE WOMEN, Extra crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.; and GOOD
    WIVES, Extra crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

ARABIAN NIGHTS' ENTERTAINMENTS. With Illustrations, 1s. 6d. (PINK
LIBRARY); 2s. (ROYAL & SCARLET LIBRARIES); 3s. 6d. (PRINCE'S LIBRARY).

BALLANTYNE, R. M.

    THE DOG CRUSOE AND HIS MASTER. With Illustrations by H. M. BROCK,
    R.I. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. and 2s. 6d.

BEDFORD LIBRARY FOR BOYS AND GIRLS, THE. A Series of books describing
the Adventures, Bravery, and Resource of Soldiers, Sailors, and others
in all Parts of the World. Sq. Crown 8vo, with many Illustrations in
Colour, 3s. 6d.

    DARING DEEDS OF FAMOUS PIRATES. By Lieut. E. KEBLE CHATTERTON,
    R.N.V.R., Author of "Sailing Ships and their Story," &c. &c.

    DARING DEEDS OF HUNTERS AND TRAPPERS. By ERNEST YOUNG, B.Sc.,
    F.R.G.S., Author of "The King of the Yellow Robe," &c. &c.

BERTHET, E.

    THE WILD MAN OF THE WOODS. With Illustrations, 1s. 6d.

BLAKE, M. M.

    THE SIEGE OF NORWICH CASTLE. With Illustrations, 5s.

BOISRAGON, Major ALAN M. Late Royal Irish Fusiliers.

    JACK SCARLETT, Sandhurst Cadet. With Coloured Illustrations. Extra
    crown 8vo, 5s.

BROCK, Mrs. CAREY.

    DAME WYNTON'S HOME. A Story Illustrative of the Lord's Prayer. With
    Eight Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MY FATHER'S HAND, and other Stories. Crown 8vo, 2s.

    SUNDAY ECHOES IN WEEKDAY HOURS. A Series of Illustrative Tales.
    Seven Vols. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d. each.

    I. The Collects.
   II. The Church Catechism.
  III. Journeyings of the Israelites.
   IV. Scripture Characters.
    V. The Epistles and Gospels.
   VI. The Parables.
  VII. The Miracles.

    WORKING AND WAITING. Crown 8vo, 5s.

BROWN LINNET.

    THE KIDNAPPING OF ETTIE, and other Tales. With Sixteen
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

BUNYAN, JOHN.

    THE PILGRIM'S PROGRESS. With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s.
    (SCARLET LIBRARY).

CARTER, Miss J. R. M.

    DIANA POLWARTH, ROYALIST. A Story of the Life of a Girl in
    Commonwealth Days. With Eight Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

CHARLESWORTH, Miss.

    ENGLAND'S YEOMEN. Crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    OLIVER OF THE MILL. With Eight Illustrations. Cr. 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    MINISTERING CHILDREN. 1. Olive Library. Crown 8vo, cloth gilt, 2s.
    6d. 2. Scarlet Library. Crown 8vo, cloth, 2s. 3. With 4
    Illustrations. Cloth, 1s. 6d.

    MINISTERING CHILDREN: A SEQUEL. With Illustrations. Cloth, 1s. 6d.
    Also with Eight Illustrations. Cloth, 2s. and 2s. 6d.

    THE BROKEN LOOKING-GLASS. Crown 8vo, 1s.

    THE OLD LOOKING-GLASS AND THE BROKEN LOOKING-GLASS; or, Mrs. Dorothy
    Cope's Recollections of Service. In one volume. With Eight
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

CHATTERTON, E. KEBLE.

    THE ROMANCE OF THE SHIP. With 33 Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    THE ROMANCE OF PIRACY. Many Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

CHURCH, Professor ALFRED J.

    "The Headmaster of Eton (Dr. the Hon. E. Lyttelton) advised his
    hearers, in a recent speech at the Royal Albert Institute, to read
    Professor A. J. Church's 'Stories from Homer,' some of which, he
    said, he had read to Eton boys after a hard school day, and at an
    age when they were not in the least desirous of learning, but were
    anxious to go to tea. The stories were so brilliantly told, however,
    that those young Etonians were entranced by them, and they actually
    begged of him to go on, being quite prepared to sacrifice their tea
    time."

    THE CHILDREN'S ÆNEID. Told for Little Children. With Twelve
    Illustrations in Colour. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE CHILDREN'S ILIAD. Told for Little Children. With Twelve
    Illustrations in Colour. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE CHILDREN'S ODYSSEY. Told for Little Children. With Twelve
    Illustrations in Colour. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE CROWN OF PINE. A Story of Corinth and the Isthmian Games. With
    Illustration in Colour by GEORGE MORROW. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    THE COUNT OF THE SAXON SHORE. A Tale of the Departure of the Romans
    from Britain. With Sixteen Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE FAERY QUEEN AND HER KNIGHTS. Stories from Spenser. With Eight
    Illustrations in Colour. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES OF CHARLEMAGNE AND THE TWELVE PEERS OF FRANCE. With Eight
    Illustrations in Colour. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE CRUSADERS. A Story of the War for the Holy Sepulchre. With Eight
    Illustrations in Colour. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES FROM THE GREEK TRAGEDIANS. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo,
    5s.

    GREEK STORY. With 16 Illustrations in Colour. Crn. 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES FROM THE GREEK COMEDIANS. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE HAMMER. A Story of Maccabean Times. With Illustrations. Crown
    8vo, 5s.

    THE STORY OF THE PERSIAN WAR, from Herodotus. With Coloured
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    HEROES OF CHIVALRY AND ROMANCE. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES OF THE EAST, from Herodotus. Coloured Illustrations. Crown
    8vo, 5s.

    HELMET AND SPEAR. Stories from the Wars of the Greeks and Romans.
    With Eight Illustrations by G. MORROW. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE STORY OF THE ILIAD. With Coloured Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.
    Also Thin Paper Edition, cloth, 2s. nett; leather, 3s. nett. Cheap
    Edition, 6d. nett; also cloth, 1s.

    ROMAN LIFE IN THE DAYS OF CICERO. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES FROM HOMER. Coloured Illustrations. Crn. 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES FROM LIVY. Coloured Illustrations. Crn. 8vo, 5s.

    STORY OF THE ODYSSEY. With Coloured Illustrations. 5s. Also Thin
    Paper Edition, cloth, 2s. nett; leather, 3s. nett. Cheap Edition,
    6d. nett. Also cloth, 1s.

    STORIES FROM VIRGIL. With Coloured Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.
    Cheap edition, sewed, 6d. nett.

    WITH THE KING AT OXFORD. A Story of the Great Rebellion. With
    Coloured Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.


    Crown 8vo, 3/6 each.

    THE FALL OF ATHENS. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    THE BURNING OF ROME. A Story of Nero's Days. With Sixteen
    Illustrations. Cheaper Edition. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    THE LAST DAYS OF JERUSALEM, from Josephus. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d. Also a
    Cheap Edition. Sewed, 6d.

    STORIES FROM ENGLISH HISTORY. With many Illustrations. Cheaper
    Edition. Revised. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    PATRIOT AND HERO. With Illustration. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.


    Extra crown 8vo, 2/6 each.

    TO THE LIONS. A Tale of the Early Christians. With Coloured
    Frontispiece and other Illustrations. 2s. 6d.

    HEROES OF EASTERN ROMANCE. With Coloured Frontispiece and Eight
    other Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. (ROYAL LIBRARY); 2s. 6d.

    A YOUNG MACEDONIAN IN THE ARMY OF ALEXANDER THE GREAT. With
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    THE CHANTRY PRIEST. With Illustrations. 2s. 6d.

    THREE GREEK CHILDREN. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.


    Crown 8vo, 1/6 each.

    A GREEK GULLIVER. Illustrated. Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    HEROES AND KINGS. Stories from the Greek. Illus. 1s. 6d.

    THE STORIES OF THE ILIAD AND THE ÆNEID. With Illustrations. 16mo,
    sewed, 1s.; cloth, 1s. 6d. Also without Illustrations, cloth, 1s.

    TO THE LIONS. A Tale of the Early Christians. With Illustrations.
    Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

CODY, Rev. H. A.

    ON TRAIL AND RAPID. By Dog-sled and Canoe. A Story of Bishop
    Bompas's Life among the Red Indians and Esquimo. Told for Boys and
    Girls. With Twenty-six Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    APOSTLE OF THE NORTH, AN. Memoirs of Bishop Bompas. With 42
    Illustrations and a Map. 7s. 6d. nett. _New and Cheaper Edition._
    With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s. nett. (CROWN LIBRARY.)

COOLIDGE, SUSAN.

    WHAT KATY DID AT HOME AND AT SCHOOL. Illustrations in Colour by H.
    M. BROCK, R.I. Crown 8vo, 2s. (SCARLET LIBRARY.)

    WHAT KATY DID AT HOME. Extra crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

COUPIN, H., D.Sc., and J. LEA, M.A.

    THE ROMANCE OF ANIMAL ARTS AND CRAFTS. With Twenty-five
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

COWPER, F.

    CAEDWALLA: or, The Saxons in the Isle of Wight. With Illustrations.
    Extra crown 8vo, 3s. 6d. (PRINCE'S LIBRARY.)

    THE ISLAND OF THE ENGLISH. A Story of Napoleon's Days. With
    Illustrations by GEORGE MORROW. Crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    THE CAPTAIN OF THE WIGHT. With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s.
    6d.

CRAIK, Mrs.

    JOHN HALIFAX. Illustrated. Extra cr. 8vo, 2s. (SCARLET LIBY.)

CURREY, Commander E. HAMILTON, R.N.

    IAN HARDY, NAVAL CADET. Coloured Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    IAN HARDY, MIDSHIPMAN. A stirring story for boys. With Coloured
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    IAN HARDY, SENIOR MIDSHIPMAN. With Col. Illus., 5s.

DAVIDSON, N. J., B.A.

    A KNIGHT-ERRANT AND HIS DOUGHTY DEEDS. The Story of Amadis of Gaul.
    Col. Illus. by H. M. BROCK, R.I. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE ROMANCE OF THE SPANISH MAIN. Ex. crown 8vo. With many
    Illustrations, 5s.

    THINGS SEEN IN OXFORD. Cloth, 2s. nett; leather, 3s. nett and 5s.
    nett.

DAWSON, Rev. Canon E. C.

    HEROINES OF MISSIONARY ADVENTURE. With Twenty-four Illustrations.
    Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    LION-HEARTED. Bishop Hannington's Life Retold for Boys and Girls.
    Illustrated. Crown 8vo, 3s., 2s. 6d. (OLIVE LIBRARY), and 1s. 6d.

    IN THE DAYS OF THE DRAGONS. Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MISSIONARY HEROINES IN MANY LANDS. Ex. cr. 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MISSIONARY HEROINES OF THE CROSS. With Illus., 2s. 6d.

DEFOE, DANIEL.

    ROBINSON CRUSOE. With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. and 3s.
    6d. (SCARLET AND PRINCE'S LIBRARIES.)

ELLIOTT, Miss.

    COPSLEY ANNALS PRESERVED IN PROVERBS. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo,
    3s. 6d.

    MRS. BLACKETT. Her Story. Fcap. 8vo, 1s.

ELLIOT, Prof. G. F. SCOTT, M.A., B.Sc., F.R.G.S., F.L.S.

    THE ROMANCE OF PLANT LIFE. Describing the curious and interesting in
    the Plant World. With 34 Illustrations. Ex. crown 8vo, 5s.

        "Popularly written by a man of great scientific
        accomplishments." THE OUTLOOK.

THE ROMANCE OF SAVAGE LIFE. With Forty-five Illustrations. Extra crown
8vo, 5s.

THE ROMANCE OF EARLY BRITISH LIFE: From the Earliest Times to the Coming
of the Danes. With 30 Illustrations. Ex. crown 8vo, 5s.

EVERETT-GREEN, EVELYN.

    A PAIR OF ORIGINALS. With Coloured Frontispiece and Eight other
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. & 2s. 6d.

FIELD, Rev. CLAUD, M.A.

    HEROES OF MISSIONARY ENTERPRISE. With many Illustrations. Extra
    crown 8vo, 5s.

    MISSIONARY CRUSADERS. With many Illustrations and a Frontispiece in
    Colour, 2s. 6d.

GARDINER, LINDA.

    SYLVIA IN FLOWERLAND. With 16 Illustrations Cr. 8vo, 3s. 6d.

GAYE, SELINA.

    COMING; or, The Golden Year. A Tale. Third Edition. With Eight
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE GREAT WORLD'S FARM. Some Account of Nature's Crops and How they
    are Grown. With a Preface by Professor BOULGER, and Sixteen
    Illustrations. Second Edition. Crown 8vo, 5s.

GIBERNE, AGNES.

    THE ROMANCE OF THE MIGHTY DEEP. With Illustrations. 5s.

        "Most fascinating."--DAILY NEWS.

    AMONG THE STARS; or, Wonderful Things in the Sky. With Coloured
    Illustrations. Eighth Thousand. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    DUTIES AND DUTIES. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE CURATE'S HOME. Crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    THE OCEAN OF AIR. Meteorology for Beginners. Illustrated. Crown 8vo,
    5s.

    THE STARRY SKIES. First Lessons on Astronomy. With Illustrations.
    Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    SUN, MOON, AND STARS. Astronomy for Beginners. With a Preface by
    Professor PRITCHARD. With Coloured Illustrations. Twenty-sixth
    Thousand. Revised and Enlarged. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE WORLD'S FOUNDATIONS. Geology for Beginners. With Illustrations.
    Crown 8vo, 5s.

    BESIDE THE WATERS OF COMFORT. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

GIBSON, CHARLES R., F.R.S.E.

    OUR GOOD SLAVE ELECTRICITY. With many Illustrations. Extra crown
    8vo, 3s. 6d.

    THE GREAT BALL ON WHICH WE LIVE. With Coloured Frontispiece and many
    other Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    THE STARS AND THEIR MYSTERIES. With a Coloured Frontispiece and 19
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    ROMANCE OF SCIENTIFIC DISCOVERY. Illustrated. 5s.

    HEROES OF THE SCIENTIFIC WORLD. An Account of the Lives and
    Achievements of Scientists of all ages. With 16 Illustrations. 5s.

    AUTOBIOGRAPHY OF AN ELECTRON. Long 8vo. 3s. 6d. nett.

    THE WONDERS OF ELECTRICITY. With Eight illustrations. Extra crown
    8vo, 2s.

    THE WONDERS OF MODERN MANUFACTURE. Illustrated. 2s.

    WIRELESS TELEGRAPHY. Many Illustrations. 2s. nett.

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ELECTRICITY. Describing in non-technical
    language what is known about electricity and many of its interesting
    applications. With Forty-one Illustrations. Ex. crown 8vo, 5s.

    "Admirable ... clear, concise."--THE GRAPHIC.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN PHOTOGRAPHY. The Discovery and its Application.
With many Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MANUFACTURE. With Twenty-four Illustrations and
Sixteen Diagrams. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

HOW TELEGRAPHS AND TELEPHONES WORK. Explained in non-technical language.
With many Diagrams. Crown 8vo, 1s. 6d. nett.

GILLIAT, EDWARD, M.A. Formerly Master at Harrow School.

    FOREST OUTLAWS. With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    HEROES OF MODERN CRUSADES. 24 Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    IN LINCOLN GREEN. Illustrated. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE KING'S REEVE. Illustrated by SYDNEY HALL. 3s. 6d.

    WOLF'S HEAD. With Eight Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN SIEGES. 16 Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    HEROES OF THE ELIZABETHAN AGE. 16 Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    HEROES OF MODERN AFRICA. 16 Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 5s.

    HEROES OF MODERN INDIA. With many Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo,
    5s.

    HEROES OF THE INDIAN MUTINY. With many Illustrations. Extra crown
    8vo, 5s.

    STORIES OF ELIZABETHAN HEROES. With Coloured and other
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    STORIES OF GREAT SIEGES. With Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    STORIES OF INDIAN HEROES. With Illus. Ex. cr. 8vo, 2s. 6d.

GOLDEN RECITER, THE. _See_ RECITERS, THE GOLDEN.

GREW, EDWIN, M. A. (Oxon.).

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN GEOLOGY. A popular account in non-technical
    language. With Twenty-four Illustrations. Ex. crown 8vo, 5s.

GRIMM'S FAIRY TALES. With Illustrations. Extra cr. 8vo, 2s. and 3s. 6d.
(SCARLET AND PRINCE'S LIBRARIES); also PINK LIBRARY, 1s. 6d.

       *       *       *       *       *

HEROES OF THE WORLD LIBRARY

Each Volume lavishly Illustrated. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    HEROES OF THE INDIAN MUTINY. By the Rev. EDWARD GILLIAT.

    HEROES OF THE SCIENTIFIC WORLD. By C. R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    HEROES OF MODERN AFRICA. By Rev. EDWARD GILLIAT.

    HEROES OF MISSIONARY ENTERPRISE. By Rev. CLAUD FIELD, M.A.

    HEROES OF PIONEERING. By Rev. EDGAR SANDERSON, M.A.

    HEROINES OF MISSIONARY ADVENTURE. By Rev. CANON DAWSON, M.A.

    HEROES OF MODERN CRUSADES. By Rev. EDWARD GILLIAT.

    HEROES OF MODERN INDIA. By Rev. E. GILLIAT.

    HEROES OF THE ELIZABETHAN AGE. By Rev. E. GILLIAT.

HUGHES, THOMAS.

    TOM BROWN'S SCHOOLDAYS. With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. and
    2s. 6d. (SCARLET AND OLIVE LIBRARIES.)

HYRST, H. W. G. Extra crown 8vo, price 5s.

    ADVENTURES IN THE GREAT DESERTS. With 16 Illustrations.

    ADVENTURES IN THE GREAT FORESTS. With 16 Illustrations.

    ADVENTURES AMONG WILD BEASTS. With 24 Illustrations.

    ADVENTURES IN THE ARCTIC REGIONS. With 16 Illustrations.

    ADVENTURES AMONG RED INDIANS. With 16 Illustrations.

    STORIES OF RED INDIAN ADVENTURE. With Coloured and other
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    STORIES OF POLAR ADVENTURE. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

KINGSLEY, CHARLES.

    WESTWARD HO! With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 2s. & 2s. 6d.
    (SCARLET AND OLIVE LIBRARIES.)

KNIGHT-ERRANT AND HIS DOUGHTY DEEDS. The story of Amadis of Gaul. Edited
by N. J. DAVIDSON, B.A. With Eight Coloured Illustrations by H. M.
BROCK, R.I. Sq. ex. crown 8vo, 5s.

LAMB, CHARLES and MARY.

    TALES FROM SHAKESPEARE. With Illustrations. Ex. crown 8vo, 2s.
    (SCARLET LIBRARY.)

LAMBERT, Rev. JOHN, M.A., D.D.

    THE ROMANCE OF MISSIONARY HEROISM. True Stories of the Intrepid
    Bravery and Stirring Adventures of Missionaries in all Parts of the
    World. With Thirty-nine Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    MISSIONARY HEROES IN ASIA. Illustrated. Cr. 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MISSIONARY HEROES IN AFRICA. Illustrated. Cr. 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MISSIONARY HEROES IN OCEANIA. Illustrated. Cr. 8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MISSIONARY HEROES OF NORTH AND SOUTH AMERICA. Illustrated. Crown
    8vo, 1s. 6d.

    MISSIONARY KNIGHTS OF THE CROSS. With many Illustrations and a
    Frontispiece in Colour. 2s. 6d.

LEA, JOHN, M.A. (Oxon.)

    THE ROMANCE OF ANIMAL ARTS AND CRAFTS. _See_ COUPIN.

    THE ROMANCE OF BIRD LIFE. With Twenty-six Illustrations. 5s.

    WONDERS OF BIRD LIFE. Extra crown 8vo, 2s.

LEYLAND, J.

    FOR THE HONOUR OF THE FLAG. A Story of our Sea Fights with the
    Dutch. With Illustrations by LANCELOT SPEED. Crown 8vo, 5s.

MACPHERSON, HECTOR, Jun.

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ASTRONOMY. With Twenty-four Illustrations.
    Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    WONDERS OF MODERN ASTRONOMY. Ex. crown 8vo, 2s.

MARRYAT, Captain.

    MASTERMAN READY. With Illustrations by H. M. BROCK, R.I. 2s.
    (SCARLET LIBRARY.)

MARSHALL, BEATRICE.

    HIS MOST DEAR LADYE. A Story of the Days of the Countess of
    Pembroke, Sir Philip Sidney's Sister. Illustrated. Extra crown 8vo,
    5s.

    THE SIEGE OF YORK. A Story of the Days of Thomas, Lorde Fairfax.
    With Eight Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    AN OLD LONDON NOSEGAY. Gathered from the Day-Book of Mistress
    Lovejoy Young. With Eight Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    OLD BLACKFRIARS. In the Days of Van Dyck. A Story. With Eight
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE QUEEN'S KNIGHT-ERRANT. A Story of the Days of Sir Walter
    Raleigh. With Eight Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

MARSHALL, EMMA.


    Crown 8vo, 5/-

    IN COLSTON'S DAYS. A Story of Old Bristol. With Illustrations. Crown
    8vo, 5s.

    IN FOUR REIGNS. The Recollections of Althea Allingham, 1785-1842.
    With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    IN THE CHOIR OF WESTMINSTER ABBEY. A Story of Henry Purcell's Days.
    With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s. and at 3s. 6d.

    IN THE EAST COUNTRY WITH SIR THOMAS BROWNE, KNIGHT. With
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    A HAUNT OF ANCIENT PEACE. Memories of Mr. Nicholas Ferrar's House at
    Little Gidding. With Illustrations by T. HAMILTON CRAWFORD. Crown
    8vo, 5s.

    KENSINGTON PALACE. In the Days of Mary II. With Illustrations. Crown
    8vo, 3s. 6d. and 5s.

    THE MASTER OF THE MUSICIANS. A Story of Handel's Day. With
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s. and at 3s. 6d.

    THE PARSON'S DAUGHTER, and How she was Painted by Mr. Romney. With
    Eight Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s. and at 3s. 6d.

    PENSHURST CASTLE. In the Days of Sir Philip Sidney. With
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d., 5s. CHEAP EDITION. Demy 8vo, 6d.

    WINCHESTER MEADS. In the Days of Bishop Ken. With Illustrations.
    Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d., 5s. CHEAP EDITION. Demy 8vo, 6d.

    UNDER SALISBURY SPIRE. In the Days of George Herbert. With
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d., 5s. CHEAP EDITION. 6d.

    UNDER THE DOME OF ST PAUL'S. In the Days of Sir Christopher Wren.
    With Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.


    Crown 8vo, 5/-

    UNDER THE MENDIPS. A Tale of the Times of Hannah More. With
    Illustrations. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    CONSTANTIA CAREW. Crown 8vo, 5s.


    Crown 8vo, 3/6

    CASTLE MEADOW. A Story of Norwich a Hundred Years Ago.

    AN ESCAPE FROM THE TOWER.

    LIFE'S AFTERMATH.

    NOW-A-DAYS.

    ON THE BANKS OF THE OUSE.

    WINIFREDE'S JOURNAL.


    Extra crown 8vo, 2/6

    THE OLD GATEWAY.

    MILLICENT LEGH.

    VIOLET DOUGLAS.

    HELEN'S DIARY.


    Crown 8vo, 1/6

    BROTHERS AND SISTERS.

    BROOK SILVERSTONE.


    1/-

    THE FIRST LIGHT ON THE EDDYSTONE.

       *       *       *       *       *

MISSIONARY BIOGRAPHIES. With many Illustrations and a Frontispiece in
Colour. Price, 2s. 6d. Extra crown 8vo.

    1. A HERO OF THE AFGHAN FRONTIER. Being the Life of Dr. T. L.
    Pennell, of Bannu, told for Boys and Girls. By A. M. PENNELL, M.B.,
    B.S. (Lond.), B.Sc.

    2. MISSIONARY CRUSADERS. By CLAUDE FIELD, M.A., sometime C.M.S.
    Missionary in the Punjab.

    3. JUDSON, THE HERO OF BURMA. The Life of Judson told for Boys and
    Girls. By JESSE PAGE, F.R.G.S.

    4. ON TRAIL AND RAPID BY DOGSLED AND CANOE. By the Rev. H. A. CODY,
    M.A.

    5. MISSIONARY KNIGHTS OF THE CROSS. By Rev. J. G. LAMBERT.

    6. MISSIONARY HEROINES OF THE CROSS. By CANON DAWSON.

       *       *       *       *       *

THE OLIVE LIBRARY. Stories by well-known Authors. Extra crown 8vo. With
Coloured and other Illustrations, 2s. 6d. each.


ANDERSEN, HANS.

    FAIRY TALES.

R. M. BALLANTYNE.

    THE DOG CRUSOE.

CHARLESWORTH, Miss.

    MINISTERING CHILDREN.

    A SEQUEL TO MINISTERING CHILDREN.

    ENGLAND'S YEOMEN.

    OLIVER OF THE MILL.

CHURCH, Prof. A. J.

    THE CHANTRY PRIEST.

    HEROES OF EASTERN ROMANCE.

    A YOUNG MACEDONIAN.

    THREE GREEK CHILDREN.

    TO THE LIONS. A Tale of the Early Christians.

DAWSON, Rev. Canon E. C.

    LION-HEARTED. The Story of Bishop Hannington's Life told for Boys
    and Girls.

EVERETT-GREEN, EVELYN

    A PAIR OF ORIGINALS.

HUGHES, T.

    TOM BROWN'S SCHOOLDAYS.

KINGSLEY, CHAS.

    WESTWARD HO!

MARSHALL, Mrs.

    THE OLD GATEWAY.

    HELEN'S DIARY.

    BROTHERS AND SISTERS.

    VIOLET DOUGLAS.

    MILLICENT LEGH.

MULOCK, Miss.

    JOHN HALIFAX.

STOWE, Mrs. BEECHER.

    UNCLE TOM'S CABIN.

WILBERFORCE, Bishop.

    AGATHOS, THE ROCKY ISLAND, and other Sunday Stories.

PHILIP, JAMES C., D.Sc., Ph.D.

    THE ROMANCE OF MODERN CHEMISTRY. With Twenty-nine Illustrations.
    Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

       *       *       *       *       *

THE PINK LIBRARY. Stories by well-known Authors. Crown 8vo. With many
Illustrations, 1s. 6d.


CHURCH, Prof. A. J.

    To the Lions.

    The Greek Gulliver.

MARSHALL, Mrs.

    Brothers & Sisters.

    Brook Silvertone.

CHARLESWORTH, Miss.

    Ministering Children.

    The Sequel to Ministering Children.

    The Old & the Broken Looking-Glass.

DAWSON, Canon E. C.

    Lion-Hearted.

    Missionary Heroines in many Lands.

LAMBERT, Rev. J. G.

    Missionary Heroes of N. & S. America.

    Missionary Heroes in Asia.

    Missionary Heroes in Oceania.

    Missionary Heroes in Africa.

WILBERFORCE, Bishop.

    Agathos & The Rocky Island.

ALCOTT, L. M.

    Little Women. Good Wives.

BERTHE, T. E.

    The Wild Man of the Woods.

SEELEY, E.

    The World before the Flood.

ANDERSEN, HANS.

    Fairy Tales and Stories.

GRIMM, The Brothers.

    Fairy Tales and Stories.

COOLIDGE, SUSAN.

    What Katy did at Home

_BY VARIOUS AUTHORS_

    The Life of a Bear.

    Only a Dog.

    The Life of an Elephant

    The Arabian Nights.

       *       *       *       *       *

THE PRINCE'S LIBRARY. With Coloured Frontispiece and other
Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    PATRIOT & HERO. By Prof. A. J. CHURCH.

    CRANFORD. By Mrs. GASKELL.

    THE VICAR OF WAKEFIELD. By OLIVER GOLDSMITH.

    THE ARABIAN NIGHTS' ENTERTAINMENTS.

    ANDERSEN'S FAIRY TALES.

    GRIMM'S FAIRY TALES.

    THE WOLF'S HEAD. By the Rev. E. GILLIAT.

    THE LAST OF THE WHITE COATS. By G. I. WHITHAM.

    DIANA POLWARTH, ROYALIST. By J. R. M. CARTER.

    THE FALL OF ATHENS. By Professor A. J. CHURCH.

    THE KING'S REEVE. By the Rev. E. GILLIAT.

    THE CABIN ON THE BEACH. By M. E. WINCHESTER.

    THE CAPTAIN OF THE WIGHT. By FRANK COWPER.

    CAEDWALLA. By FRANK COWPER.

    ROBINSON CRUSOE. By DANIEL DEFOE.

RECITER, THE GOLDEN. A volume of Recitations & Readings in Prose & Verse
selected from the works of RUDYARD KIPLING, R. L. STEVENSON, CONAN
DOYLE, MAURICE HEWLETT, CHRISTINA ROSSETTI, THOMAS HARDY, AUSTIN DOBSON,
A. W. PINERO, &c., &c. With an Introduction by CAIRNS JAMES, Professor
of Elocution at the Royal College of Music and the Guildhall School of
Music. Extra crown 8vo, 704 pp., 3s. 6d. Also Thin Paper Edition for the
Pocket, with gilt edges. Small crown 8vo, 5s.

    "An admirable collection in prose and verse."--THE SPECTATOR.

RECITER, THE GOLDEN HUMOROUS. Edited, and with an Introduction by CAIRNS
JAMES, Professor of Elocution at the Royal College of Music. Recitations
and Readings selected from the writings of F. ANSTEY, J. M. BARRIE, S.
R. CROCKETT, MAJOR DRURY, JEROME K. JEROME, BARRY PAIN, A. W. PINERO,
OWEN SEAMAN, G. B. SHAW, &c. Over 700 pages, extra crown 8vo, cloth, 3s.
6d. Also a Thin Paper Edition, with gilt edges, small crown 8vo, 5s.

ROBINSON, Commander C. N.

    FOR THE HONOUR OF THE FLAG. A Story of our Sea Fights with the
    Dutch. With Illustrations by LANCELOT SPEED. Crown 8vo, 5s.

SANDERSON, Rev. E.

    HEROES OF PIONEERING. True Stories of the Intrepid Bravery and
    Stirring Adventures of Pioneers in all Parts of the World. With
    Sixteen Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

    STORIES OF GREAT PIONEERS. With Coloured and other Illustrations.
    Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

       *       *       *       *       *

ROYAL LIBRARY FOR BOYS AND GIRLS, THE. A Series of handsome Gift Books
by Celebrated Authors. Illustrated by H. M. BROCK, LANCELOT SPEED, and
other well-known artists. Ex. crown 8vo, 2s. each.

    1. A PAIR OF ORIGINALS. By EVELYN EVERETT-GREEN.

    2. JOHN HALIFAX. By Miss MULOCK.

    3. UNCLE TOM'S CABIN. By H. BEECHER-STOWE.

    4. WESTWARD HO! By CHARLES KINGSLEY.

    5. ROBINSON CRUSOE. By DANIEL DEFOE.

    6. TOM BROWN'S SCHOOL-DAYS. By THOMAS HUGHES.

    7. GRIMM'S FAIRY TALES. A New Translation.

    8. THE ARABIAN NIGHTS' ENTERTAINMENTS.

    9. ANDERSEN'S FAIRY TALES.

    10. WHAT KATY DID AT HOME AND AT SCHOOL. By SUSAN COOLIDGE.

    11. HEROES OF EASTERN ROMANCE. By Prof. A. J. CHURCH.

    12. LION HEARTED. By the Rev. Canon E. C. DAWSON.

    13. THE ADVENTURES OF A CAVALIER. By G. I. WHITHAM.

       *       *       *       *       *

THE LIBRARY OF ADVENTURE

With many Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s. each.

    "Delightful books of adventure, beautifully printed and tastefully
    got up."--EDUCATIONAL TIMES.

ADVENTURES OF MISSIONARY EXPLORERS. By R. M. A. IBBOTSON.

ADVENTURES IN SOUTHERN SEAS. By RICHARD STEAD, B.A.

ADVENTURES AMONG TRAPPERS & HUNTERS. By E. YOUNG, B.Sc.

ADVENTURES IN THE ARCTIC REGIONS. By H. W. G. HYRST.

ADVENTURES AMONG WILD BEASTS. By H. W. G. HYRST.

ADVENTURES ON THE HIGH SEAS. By R. STEAD, B.A.

ADVENTURES IN THE GREAT DESERTS. By H. W. G. HYRST.

ADVENTURES ON THE GREAT RIVERS. By RICHARD STEAD.

ADVENTURES IN THE GREAT FORESTS. By H. W. G. HYRST.

ADVENTURES ON THE HIGH MOUNTAINS. By R. STEAD.

ADVENTURES AMONG RED INDIANS. By H. W. G. HYRST.

       *       *       *       *       *

RUSSELL SERIES FOR BOYS & GIRLS, THE. Coloured and other Illustrations.
Extra crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    STORIES OF POLAR ADVENTURE. By H. W. G. HYRST.

    STORIES OF GREAT PIONEERS. By EDGAR SANDERSON, M.A.

    STORIES OF ELIZABETHAN HEROES. By the Rev. E. GILLIAT.

    STORIES OF RED INDIAN ADVENTURE. By H. W. G. HYRST.

    STORIES OF INDIAN HEROES. By E. GILLIAT, M.A.

    STORIES OF GREAT SIEGES. By E. GILLIAT, M.A.

       *       *       *       *       *

THE LIBRARY OF ROMANCE

Fully Illustrated. Bound in blue, scarlet, and gold.

Extra crown 8vo, 5s. each.

    "Splendid volumes."--THE OUTLOOK.

    "Gift books whose value it would be difficult to
    overestimate."--STANDARD.

THE ROMANCE OF THE SPANISH MAIN. By N. J. DAVIDSON, B.A. (Oxon.)

THE ROMANCE OF PIRACY. By E. KEBLE CHATTERTON, B.A. (Oxon.). With many
Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF SCIENTIFIC DISCOVERY. By CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

THE ROMANCE OF SUBMARINE ENGINEERING. By THOMAS W. CORBIN.

THE ROMANCE OF AERONAUTICS. By CHARLES C. TURNER.

THE ROMANCE OF THE SHIP. The story of its origin and evolution. By E.
KEBLE CHATTERTON. With Thirty-three Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ASTRONOMY. By HECTOR MACPHERSON, Jun. With
Twenty-four Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN CHEMISTRY. By J. C. PHILIP, D.Sc., Assistant
Professor of Chemistry, South Kensington.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MANUFACTURE. By C. R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

THE ROMANCE OF EARLY BRITISH LIFE. By Prof. G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A.,
B.Sc. With 30 Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN GEOLOGY. By E. S. GREW, M.A. (Oxon.).

THE ROMANCE OF BIRD LIFE. By JOHN LEA, M.A.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN PHOTOGRAPHY. Its Discovery and its Application. By
C. R. GIBSON, A.I.E.E. With 63 Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN SIEGES. By the REV. E. GILLIAT. With 24
Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF SAVAGE LIFE. By Professor G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A.,
B.Sc., _&c._ With 45 Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF THE WORLD'S FISHERIES. By SIDNEY WRIGHT. With 24
Illustrations.

THE ROMANCE OF ANIMAL ARTS & CRAFTS. By H. COUPIN, D.Sc., and J. LEA,
M.A. With 24 Illustrations.

    "Extremely fascinating."--LIVERPOOL COURIER.

THE ROMANCE OF EARLY EXPLORATION. By A. WILLIAMS, B.A., F.R.G.S. With 16
Illustrations.

    "We cannot imagine a book that a boy would appreciate more than
    this."--DAILY TELEGRAPH.

THE ROMANCE OF MISSIONARY HEROISM. By JOHN C. LAMBERT, B.A., D.D. With
39 Illustrations.

    "About 350 pages of the most thrilling missionary lives ever
    collected in one volume."--METHODIST TIMES.

THE ROMANCE OF PLANT LIFE. By Prof. G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, B.A. (Cantab.),
B.Sc. (Edin.). With 34 Illustrations.

    "Besides being entertaining, instructive and educative."--LIVERPOOL
    COURIER.

THE ROMANCE OF POLAR EXPLORATION. By G. FIRTH SCOTT. With 24
Illustrations. "Thrillingly interesting."--LIVERPOOL COURIER.

THE ROMANCE OF INSECT LIFE. By EDMUND SELOUS.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MECHANISM. By A. WILLIAMS.

    "Genuinely fascinating. Mr. Williams is an old favourite."--L'POOL
    COURIER.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ELECTRICITY. By C. R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E. Revised
Edition.

    "Admirable ... clear and concise."--THE GRAPHIC.

THE ROMANCE OF THE ANIMAL WORLD. By EDMUND SELOUS.

    "A very fascinating book."--GRAPHIC.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN EXPLORATION. By A. WILLIAMS.

    "A mine of Information and stirring incident."--SCOTSMAN.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN INVENTION. By A. WILLIAMS. Revised Edition.

    "An ideal gift book for boys, fascinatingly interesting."--QUEEN.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ENGINEERING. By A. WILLIAMS.

    "An absorbing work with its graphic descriptions."--STANDARD.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN LOCOMOTION. By A. WILLIAMS.

    "Crisply written, brimful of incident not less than instruction.
    Should be as welcome as a Ballantyne story or a Mayne Reid
    romance."--GLASGOW HERALD.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MINING. By A. WILLIAMS.

    "Boys will revel in this volume."--CITY PRESS.

THE ROMANCE OF THE MIGHTY DEEP. By AGNES GIBERNE.

    "Most fascinating."--DAILY NEWS.

       *       *       *       *       *

SCARLET LIBRARY, THE ILLUSTRATED. Large crown 8vo, cloth, gilt. With
Eight original Illustrations by H. M. BROCK, LANCELOT SPEED, and other
leading Artists. Price 2s. per volume.

    THE PILGRIM'S PROGRESS.

    THE WIDE, WIDE WORLD.

    UNCLE TOM'S CABIN.

    BEN HUR. GEN. LEW WALLACE.

    WESTWARD HO! KINGSLEY.

    JOHN HALIFAX. By Mrs. CRAIK.

    ROBINSON CRUSOE. DEFOE.

    LITTLE WOMEN and GOOD WIVES.

    THE HISTORY OF HENRY ESMOND. By W. M. THACKERAY.

    THE SWISS FAMILY ROBINSON.

    GRIMM'S FAIRY TALES.

    POE'S TALES OF MYSTERY AND IMAGINATION.

    DON QUIXOTE. By CERVANTES.

    GULLIVER'S TRAVELS. SWIFT.

    THE DAYS OF BRUCE.

    TOM BROWN'S SCHOOLDAYS.

    TALES FROM SHAKESPEARE. LAMB.

    HANS ANDERSEN'S FAIRY TALES.

    THE ARABIAN NIGHTS' ENTERTAINMENTS.

    THE SCALP HUNTERS. By Captain MAYNE REID.

    MINISTERING CHILDREN.

    MINISTERING CHILDREN. A Sequel.

    THE DOG CRUSOE. BALLANTYNE.

    MASTERMAN READY. MARRYAT.

    WHAT KATY DID AT HOME AND AT SCHOOL. By SUSAN COOLIDGE.

    THE OLD GATEWAY. E. MARSHALL.

    MILLICENT LEGH. E. MARSHALL.

    VICAR OF WAKEFIELD.

       *       *       *       *       *

SCIENCE FOR CHILDREN

OUR GOOD SLAVE ELECTRICITY. By CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E. With many
Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

THE GREAT BALL ON WHICH WE LIVE. By CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E. With
Coloured Frontispiece and many other Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s.
6d.

THE STARS AND THEIR MYSTERIES. With Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 3s.
6d.

SCOTT, G. FIRTH.

    THE ROMANCE OF POLAR EXPLORATION. Illustrated Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

        "Thrillingly interesting, excellently illustrated."--LIVERPOOL
        COURIER.

SEELEY, A.

    THIS GREAT GLOBE. First Lessons in Geography. 1s. 6d.

SEELEY, M.

    THE WORLD BEFORE THE FLOOD. Stories from the Best Book. With
    Illustrations by G. P. JACOMB HOOD. Crown 8vo, 1s. and 1s. 6d.

SELOUS, E.

    THE ROMANCE OF THE ANIMAL WORLD. Illustrated. Ex. crown 8vo, 5s.

        "A very fascinating book."--GRAPHIC.

THE ROMANCE OF INSECT LIFE. Illustrated. Ex. cr. 8vo., 5s.

        "Mr. Selous, the well-known naturalist, writes in purely
        informal style."--THE GLOBE.

    WONDERS OF ANIMAL LIFE. Extra crown 8vo, 2s.

WICKS, M.

    TO MARS VIA THE MOON. An Astronomical Story. With Eight
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 5s.

WILBERFORCE, Bishop S.

    AGATHOS. With Illustrations. Fcap. 8vo, sewed, 6d.; cloth, 1s.

    AGATHOS, THE ROCKY ISLAND, and other Sunday Stories. With Sixteen
    Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo, 1s. 6d., 2s. 6d.

    THE ROCKY ISLAND AND OTHER SIMILITUDES. With Illustrations. Fcap.
    8vo, sewed, 6d.; cloth, 1s.

WINCHESTER, M. E.

    ADRIFT IN A GREAT CITY. Illustrated. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    A CITY VIOLET. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    THE CABIN ON THE BEACH. Illustrated. Crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

    A NEST OF SKYLARKS. 5s.

    A NEST OF SPARROWS. Crown 8vo, 5s.

    A WAYSIDE SNOWDROP. Crown 8vo, 2s. 6d.

    CHIRPS FOR THE CHICKS. 2s. 6d.

WILLIAMS, ARCHIBALD, B.A. (Oxon.), F.R.G.S.


THE ROMANCE OF EARLY EXPLORATION. Illustrated. 5s.

        "A companion volume to 'The Romance of Modern Exploration,' and
    if possible, more full of Romance."--EVENING STANDARD.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN EXPLORATION. Illustrated. 5s.

        "A mine of information and stirring incident."--SCOTSMAN.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MECHANISM. Illustrated. 5s.

        "Mr. Williams is an old favourite; a genuinely fascinating
    book."--LIVERPOOL COURIER.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN INVENTION. With 24 Illustrations.

        "An ideal gift book for boys, fascinatingly
    interesting."--QUEEN.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN ENGINEERING. Illustrated.

        "An absorbing work with its graphic descriptions."--STANDARD.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN LOCOMOTION. Illustrated.

        "Crisply written and brimful of incident."--GLASGOW HERALD.

THE ROMANCE OF MODERN MINING. With 24 Illustrations.

        "Boys will revel in this volume."--CITY PRESS.

THE WONDERS OF MODERN ENGINEERING. Ex. crown 8vo, 2s.


WHITHAM, G. I.

    THE LAST OF THE WHITE COATS. A Story of Cavaliers and Roundheads.
    Illustrated in colour by OSCAR WILSON. Ex. crown 8vo, 3s. 6d.

       *       *       *       *       *

THE WONDER LIBRARY

With Eight Illustrations. Extra crown 8vo. Price 2s.

    WONDERS OF ANIMAL LIFE. EDMUND SELOUS.

    THE WONDERS OF MODERN MANUFACTURE. By C. R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    THE WONDERS OF SAVAGE LIFE. By Professor G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A.,
    B.Sc.

    THE WONDERS OF ASTRONOMY. By HECTOR MACPHERSON, Junr., M.A.

    THE WONDERS OF INVENTION. By A. Williams, B.A. Revised and brought
    up to date by T. W. CORBIN.

    THE WONDERS OF MODERN CHEMISTRY. By JAMES C. PHILIP, D.Sc.

    THE WONDERS OF ELECTRICITY. By CHARLES R. GIBSON, F.R.S.E.

    THE WONDERS OF ANIMAL INGENUITY. By H. COUPIN, D.Sc., and JOHN LEA,
    M.A.

    THE WONDERS OF MECHANICAL INGENUITY. By ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS, B.A.,
    F.R.G.S.

    THE WONDERS OF ASIATIC EXPLORATION. By ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS, B.A.,
    F.R.G.S.

    THE WONDERS OF THE PLANT WORLD. By G. F. SCOTT ELLIOT, M.A., B.Sc.,
    F.L.S., &c.

    THE WONDERS OF MODERN RAILWAYS. By ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS, B.A.,
    F.R.G.S.

    THE WONDERS OF THE INSECT WORLD. By E. SELOUS.

    THE WONDERS OF MODERN ENGINEERING. By ARCHIBALD WILLIAMS, B.A.
    (Oxon.)

    THE WONDERS OF BIRD LIFE. By JOHN LEA, M.A.

       *       *       *       *       *

WRIGHT, SIDNEY.

    THE ROMANCE OF THE WORLD'S FISHERIES. With many Illustrations. Extra
    crown 8vo, 5s.

YOUNG, ERNEST.

    ADVENTURES AMONG TRAPPERS AND HUNTERS. With Sixteen Illustrations.
    Ex. crown 8vo, 5s.



       *       *       *       *       *



Transcriber's note:

The following changes have been made to the text:

Page 3: added missingopen quotation mark: ("=It is no exaggeration to say
that Commander Currey bears worthily the mantle of Kingston and Captain
Marryat.=")

Page 3: added missing open quotation mark ("By writing this series the
author is doing national service, ...")

Page 66: added missing word "on" (Needless to say, that ship went on no
more excursions.)

Page 77: changed "bridginv" to "bridging" ( ... certain engineering
"field companies," and "bridging trains," ...)

Page 147: changed "Chili" to "Chile" ( ... notably in the United States,
Chile and Spain.)

Page 156: changed "alumimium" to "aluminium" (Alumina, too, is oxide of
aluminium.)

Page 187: changed comma to period at end of sentence (... if the mild
steel ordinarily employed for shipbuilding were used.)

Page 188: Deleted spurious comma following "experience" (... as
experience shows, a very considerable degree of safety.)

Page 236: changed "nutil" to "until" ( ... which is stored in large
accumulator batteries until required ...)

Page 237: added missing period ( ... by long spells of duty in this
unhealthy atmosphere.)

Page 307: changed "aliminium" to "aluminium" ( ... another aluminium
disc ...)





*** End of this LibraryBlog Digital Book "The Romance of War Inventions - A Description of Warships, Guns, Tanks, Rifles, Bombs, and Other Instruments and Munitions of Warfare, How They Were Invented & How They Are Employed" ***

Copyright 2023 LibraryBlog. All rights reserved.



Home